Understanding ICT Standardization LoResWeb 20190416

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 276

UNDERSTANDING ICT

STANDARDIZATION:
PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Dr. habil. Nizar Abdelkafi Prof. Raffaele Bolla


Cees J.M. Lanting Dr. Alejandro Rodriguez-Ascaso
Marina Thuns Dr. Michelle Wetterwald
UNDERSTANDING ICT
STANDARDIZATION:
PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Dr. habil. Nizar Abdelkafi


Prof. Raffaele Bolla
Cees J.M. Lanting
Dr. Alejandro Rodriguez-Ascaso
Marina Thuns
Dr. Michelle Wetterwald
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

This publication does not constitute an official or agreed position of ETSI, nor of its Members. The views
expressed are entirely those of the authors. ETSI declines all responsibility for any errors and any loss or
damage resulting from use of the contents of this publication. ETSI also declines responsibility for any
infringement of any third party's Intellectual Property Rights (IPR), but will be pleased to acknowledge any
IPR and correct any infringement of which it is advised.
The European Commission support for the production of this publication does not constitute endorsement
of the contents which reflects the views only of the authors, and the Commission cannot be held responsible
for any use which may be made of the information contained therein.

© ETSI 2018. All rights reserved.


Reuse and reproduction in whole is permitted for non-commercial purposes provided the copy is complete
and unchanged with acknowledgement of the source (including this copyright statement). For any other
purposes, ETSI's permission shall be required.

The present document may include trademarks and/or tradenames which are asserted and/or registered
by their owners. ETSI claims no ownership of these except for any which are indicated as being the
property of ETSI, and conveys no right to use or reproduce any trademark and/or tradename. Mention
of those trademarks in the present document does not constitute an endorsement by ETSI of products,
services or organizations associated with those trademarks.

ETSI
650 Route des Lucioles
F-06921 Sophia Antipolis Cedex
FRANCE
Tel.: +33 4 92 94 42 00 Fax: +33 4 93 65 47 16
Siret N° 348 623 562 00017 - NAF 742 C
Association à but non lucratif enregistrée à la Sous-Préfecture de Grasse (06) N° W061004871

ISBN:  (PDF version)


UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

PREFACE

W
ith the support of the European Commission, ETSI has run a project to develop teaching materials
to facilitate education on ICT (Information and Communication Technology) standardization,
and to raise the knowledge level of ICT standardization-related topics among lecturers and
students, in particular in the fields of engineering, business administration and law, in higher education. For
this purpose, ETSI recruited a group of experts from different sectors, including standards organizations,
academia and consulting companies. All of the experts have been actively involved in current standardization
production and/or research, within the area of ICT.
To advance education about ICT standardization, the attractiveness of the topic among lecturers and
students should be improved. Comprehensive and up-to-date teaching materials constitute a major
way to convey the value and raise awareness of standardization. To provide high value for teachers and
students, our main objective was to create a textbook and accompanying teaching/learning materials for
standardization education that are tailored to the requirements and challenges of the ICT sector.
This project started by identifying best practices in education about standardization of ICT, the learning
objectives and most appropriate teaching methods and tools. For this reason, the group of experts, who
co-authored this textbook, carried out an intensive desktop research, and more than 25 interviews with
leading international experts in standards education. The analysis of the information generated led to the
design of the textbook structure and the accompanying learning material, including slides, visualizations,
quizzes and case studies.
Readers of this book are not required to have any previous knowledge about standardization. They
are introduced firstly to the key concepts of standards and standardization, different elements of the
ecosystem and how they interact, as well as the procedures required for the production of standardization
documents. Then, readers are taken to the next level by addressing aspects related to standardization
such as innovation, strategy, business, and economics.
The contents of the book can be read in different ways. It can be read from cover to cover in a linear
way, or readers may only focus on the specific chapters they are interested in. This is supported by the
modular structure of the textbook, making the single chapters self-contained units that can be studied
independently of other chapters. Each chapter begins with a list of learning objectives and key messages
about what they will be learning in that particular chapter. For lecturers, this could be regarded as “meta-
contents” to help decide which chapter of the book suits better the module or topic they are teaching.
The teaching resources comprise this textbook, which conveys the main theoretical knowledge. The text
is enriched with examples from real standardization practice to illustrate the key theoretical concepts.
Furthermore, the book includes case studies, where the ‘case’ can be a standardization document, an
event or action, or a company that implemented a particular practice that is related to standardization. Each
case study is intended to make readers reflect on a subset of the book’s learning objectives and messages,
and it could be potentially used by lecturers as a building block for further learning activities more tailored
to their particular teaching needs. Case studies also enable students to better see the application of the
concepts learned and allow a classroom environment that promotes group discussion and interaction
among students. Finally, each chapter includes a quiz to be used as a self-assessment learning activity.
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Furthermore, each book chapter includes a glossary and list of abbreviations, which are useful in any
learning context and indispensable in order to better understand and recall standardization knowledge.
Finally, chapters have their corresponding summary and references.
Alongside the textbook, the project has produced a set of slides that are intended to serve as complementary
teaching materials in face-to-face teaching sessions.
In addition to its use in undergraduate and Masters courses, the book consists of advanced topics that
can serve as a starting point for graduates and PhD students interested in standardization research. The
book also serves as guide or a checklist for experts already active in standardization activities by providing
them with arguments for the justification and improvements of standards activities from a management
point of view.
This book has been intended to reach all potentially interested readers, including those with disabilities.
Hence, ETSI, the authors, and the publisher have committed themselves to ensure the accessibility of the
book and its contents. For all interested parties there is also an electronic version of the textbook as well as
the accompanying slides that can be downloaded for free from the ETSI website (www.etsi.org).
With the hope that all readers enjoy the learning process by using the textbook and the teaching materials,
ETSI and the group of authors would welcome any comments and feedback that aims at improving the
current materials. In addition, the authors would like to thank all contributors to this piece of work.

Dr. habil. Nizar Abdelkafi


Prof. Raffaele Bolla
Cees J.M. Lanting
Dr. Alejandro Rodriguez-Ascaso
Marina Thuns
Dr. Michelle Wetterwald
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

TABLE OF CONTENTS

FOREWORD ...................................................................................................................................... 1

1 INTRODUCTION ........................................................................................................................... 2

2 INTRODUCTION TO STANDARDS .................................................................................................. 4


2.1 BASICS OF STANDARDIZATION ........................................................................................... 5
2.1.1 INTRODUCTION .................................................................................................................. 5
2.1.2 STANDARDS IN EVERYDAY LIFE ........................................................................................... 7
2.1.3 FORMAL STANDARDS ....................................................................................................... 12
2.2 BENEFITS AND RISKS OF STANDARDIZATION .................................................................... 15
2.2.1 BENEFITS ....................................................................................................................... 15
2.2.2 RISKS ............................................................................................................................ 20
2.3 STANDARDIZATION LANDSCAPE ....................................................................................... 23
2.4 THE STANDARDIZATION PROCESS AT A GLANCE ................................................................ 32
2.4.1 STANDARD–DEVELOPMENT PROCESS ............................................................................... 32
2.4.2 MAIN CHARACTERISTICS OF A STANDARD ......................................................................... 36
2.5 USING STANDARDS ......................................................................................................... 38
2.5.1 SELECTING RELEVANT SDOS ............................................................................................. 38
2.5.2 IDENTIFYING SDO DOCUMENTS ......................................................................................... 40
2.5.3 UNDERSTANDING THE DOCUMENTS’ STRUCTURE AND FORMALISM ..................................... 41
2.6 SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 45
2.7 QUIZ ............................................................................................................................... 46
2.8 GLOSSARY ...................................................................................................................... 49
2.9 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS .................................................................................................. 50
2.10 REFERENCES .................................................................................................................. 51

3 THE STANDARDS ECOSYSTEM .................................................................................................. 53


3.1 TYPES OF ORGANIZATIONS AND STANDARDIZATION DOCUMENTS ...................................... 54
3.1.1 RECOGNIZED SDOS .......................................................................................................... 54
3.1.2 FORMAL STANDARDS ....................................................................................................... 55
3.1.3 DE FACTO STANDARDS .................................................................................................... 57
3.1.4 PUBLIC AND PRIVATE ORGANIZATIONS ............................................................................... 58
3.1.5 OPEN STANDARDS ........................................................................................................... 58
3.1.6 CLASSIFICATION OF ICT STANDARDIZATION DOCUMENTS .................................................. 60
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

3.2 NATIONAL, REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL STANDARDIZATION: COOPERATION AND


COORDINATION ............................................................................................................... 62
3.2.1 NATIONAL, REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL SDOS AND STANDARDS .................................... 62
3.2.2 COOPERATION AND COORDINATION AMONG DIFFERENT LEVELS OF STANDARDIZATION ......... 62
3.3 ADOPTION/TRANSPOSITION OF STANDARDS ..................................................................... 70
3.3.1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................ 70
3.3.2 ADOPTION OF A DE FACTO OR INDUSTRIAL CONSORTIUM STANDARD .................................. 70
3.3.3 EXTENSION OF STANDARDS BY MARKETING ORGANIZATIONS .............................................. 74
3.3.4 ADOPTION INTO/FROM REGULATIONS ................................................................................ 74
3.4 TYPES OF DOCUMENTS PRODUCED BY SDOS .................................................................. 79
3.4.1 NORMATIVE DOCUMENTS ................................................................................................. 79
3.4.2 INFORMATIVE DOCUMENTS .............................................................................................. 80
3.4.3 DOCUMENTS SPECIFIC TO CERTAIN ORGANIZATIONS .......................................................... 80
3.5 NAMING CONVENTIONS FOR STANDARDIZATION DOCUMENTS ........................................... 81
3.6 CASE STUDY: THE REVISION OF A NATIONAL STANDARD ABOUT TELECARE, FROM THE ICT
ACCESSIBILITY PERSPECTIVE ........................................................................................... 84
3.7 SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 87
3.8 QUIZ ............................................................................................................................... 88
3.9 GLOSSARY ...................................................................................................................... 93
3.10 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS .................................................................................................. 94
3.11 REFERENCES ................................................................................................................. 96

4 THE PRODUCTION OF STANDARDS .......................................................................................... 100


4.1 INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................. 101
4.2 THE STANDARDIZATION SCENE ...................................................................................... 101
4.2.1 INTRODUCTION .............................................................................................................. 101
4.2.2 CODE OF GOOD PRACTICE FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OF INTERNATIONAL STANDARDS ......... 102
4.2.3 CRITERIA FOR PRODUCING GOOD STANDARDS ................................................................. 106
4.2.4 THE PROCESS OF PRODUCING STANDARDS ..................................................................... 107
4.2.5 ORGANIZATION OF AN SDO ............................................................................................. 115
4.3 ROLES AND COMPETENCIES OF A STANDARDIZATION EXPERT ......................................... 124
4.3.1 INTRODUCTION .............................................................................................................. 124
4.3.2 ROLES OF PROFESSIONALS INVOLVED IN THE STANDARDS DEVELOPMENT PROCESS .......... 124
4.3.3 COMPETENCIES OF A STANDARDIZATION EXPERT ............................................................. 128
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

4.4 ACTIVITIES OF A STANDARDIZATION EXPERT ................................................................... 131


4.4.1 INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................. 131
4.4.2 DURING WORKING GROUP MEETINGS ............................................................................. 131
4.4.3 BETWEEN STANDARDIZATION MEETINGS ......................................................................... 133
4.4.4 INSIDE THE EXPERT’S CORPORATE COMPANY ................................................................. 133
4.4.5 AS A NATIONAL DELEGATE ............................................................................................. 136
4.5 CASE STUDY: THE 3RD GENERATION PARTNERSHIP PROJECT (3GPP) ............................... 137
4.6 SUMMARY ..................................................................................................................... 138
4.7 QUIZ ............................................................................................................................. 139
4.8 GLOSSARY .................................................................................................................... 141
4.9 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS ................................................................................................ 141
4.10 REFERENCES ............................................................................................................... 143

5 STANDARDIZATION AND INNOVATION ..................................................................................... 146


5.1 INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................. 147
5.2 INTERDEPENDENCIES BETWEEN STANDARDIZATION AND INNOVATION ............................. 148
5.2.1 INTRODUCTION TO INNOVATION ...................................................................................... 148
5.2.2 STANDARDS AS AN ENABLER FOR INNOVATION-DRIVEN GROWTH ..................................... 149
5.2.3 STANDARDIZATION AND THE TECHNOLOGY LIFE CYCLE ..................................................... 153
5.3 RESEARCH AND STANDARDIZATION ................................................................................ 156
5.3.1 TRADITIONAL VS. RECURSIVE RESEARCH EXPLOITATION .................................................... 156
5.3.2 STANDARDIZATION AS A COOPERATIVE PROCESS TO SUPPORT THE EXPLOITATION OF
RESEARCH RESULTS ...................................................................................................... 157
5.3.3 A MODEL FOR THE INTEGRATION OF STANDARDIZATION IN RESEARCH ............................... 158
5.4 FORMAL STANDARDIZATION: A DRIVER FOR INNOVATION ................................................. 160
5.4.1 EFFICIENT AND TARGET-ORIENTED INNOVATION ............................................................... 160
5.4.2 DIFFERENTIATION .......................................................................................................... 161
5.4.3 EXCEEDING THE REQUIREMENTS OF STANDARDS ............................................................ 162
5.4.4 BUSINESS MODEL INNOVATION ....................................................................................... 163
5.4.5 INNOVATION IMPULSES .................................................................................................. 164
5.4.6 INNOVATION COMMUNICATION ....................................................................................... 165
5.4.7 ABSORPTION OF INNOVATION ......................................................................................... 166
5.5 SUMMARY ..................................................................................................................... 167
5.6 QUIZ ............................................................................................................................. 169
5.7 GLOSSARY .................................................................................................................... 171
5.8 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS ................................................................................................ 171
5.9 REFERENCES ................................................................................................................ 172
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

6 A STRATEGIC PERSPECTIVE ON STANDARDIZATION ................................................................ 174


6.1 INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................. 174
6.2 DIFFERENT STRATEGIES FOR PARTICIPATION .................................................................. 175
6.2.1 ORGANIZATIONAL STRATEGIES ........................................................................................ 175
6.2.2 TECHNICAL FOCUS ........................................................................................................ 175
6.2.3 LOCATIONS AND RELATIONS AMONG SDOS ...................................................................... 176
6.2.4 TECHNOLOGY STRATEGIES ............................................................................................. 178
6.3 CONDITIONS AND EXTERNAL INFLUENCES ...................................................................... 179
6.3.1 MANAGING THE RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN STANDARDIZATION AND MARKETS ...................... 179
6.3.2 MANAGING COOPERATION .............................................................................................. 180
6.3.3 MANAGING SYNCHRONIZATION ....................................................................................... 180
6.3.4 VOTING AND VOTING RULES ............................................................................................ 181
6.3.5 "BACKDOOR POLICY" ..................................................................................................... 182
6.3.6 STANDARDS PORTFOLIO MANAGEMENT / TECHNOLOGY DEVELOPMENT ............................ 182
6.3.7 MANAGING PHASES OF STANDARDIZATION ..................................................................... 183
6.3.8 OTHER ACTIVITIES .......................................................................................................... 183
6.4 COMMUNICATION WITHIN STANDARDIZATION ACTIVITIES ................................................ 184
6.5 CHOOSING YOUR STANDARD(S) ...................................................................................... 184
6.5.1 THE STANDARDIZATION PROCESS FROM AN IMPLEMENTATION PERSPECTIVE ..................... 184
6.5.2 WHAT TO TAKE INTO CONSIDERATION .............................................................................. 184
6.5.3 WHAT IF A SUITABLE SET OF STANDARDS OR SPECIFICATIONS CANNOT BE FOUND? ........... 186
6.6 SUMMARY ..................................................................................................................... 186
6.7 QUIZ ............................................................................................................................. 187
6.8 GLOSSARY .................................................................................................................... 189
6.9 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS ................................................................................................ 189
6.10 REFERENCES ................................................................................................................ 189

7 A BUSINESS PERSPECTIVE: IPR AND STANDARDIZATION ........................................................ 190


7.1 INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................. 191
7.2 IPR AND SDO-SUPPORTED STANDARDIZATION: TWO VALUABLE INSTRUMENTS ................ 191
7.2.1 BASICS OF IPR .............................................................................................................. 191
7.2.2 COMMITTEE STANDARDS .............................................................................................. 192
7.2.3 PATENTS ...................................................................................................................... 197
7.2.4 SECRECY ...................................................................................................................... 198
7.2.5 THE INTERPLAY BETWEEN STANDARDIZATION AND IPR ..................................................... 198
7.3 A DECISION-MAKING TOOL: IPR VS. STANDARDIZATION ................................................... 200
7.3.1 THE BASIC PROCESS ...................................................................................................... 200
7.3.2 THE DECISION TREE: AN OVERVIEW ................................................................................. 200
7.3.3 DECISION CRITERIA ........................................................................................................ 202
7.3.4 USING THE TREE FOR DECISION MAKING .......................................................................... 203
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

7.4 CASE STUDIES: TO STANDARDIZE OR TO PATENT? .......................................................... 205


7.4.1 CASE STUDY: SECURE DATA GMBH - IT SECURITY SOFTWARE, INFRASTRUCTURE AND
CONSULTING ................................................................................................................. 205
7.4.2 CASE STUDY: LOCATOR GMBH - EMBEDDED LOCATION PLATFORM SERVICES AND DEVICES 206
7.5 SUMMARY .................................................................................................................... 208
7.6 QUIZ ............................................................................................................................. 209
7.7 GLOSSARY .................................................................................................................... 211
7.8 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS ................................................................................................ 212
7.9 REFERENCES ................................................................................................................ 212

8 AN ECONOMIC PERSPECTIVE ON STANDARDIZATION .............................................................. 214


8.1 INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................. 215
8.2 THE ECONOMIC CONTRIBUTION OF STANDARDS ............................................................. 216
8.2.1 CONTRIBUTION OF STANDARDS TO THE GDP .................................................................... 216
8.2.2 COSTS OF STANDARDIZATION AND STANDARDS FROM THE COMPANY’S PERSPECTIVE ....... 218
8.3 THE ECONOMIC EFFECTS OF STANDARDIZATION ............................................................. 219
8.3.1 COMPATIBILITY/INTERFACE STANDARDS .......................................................................... 219
8.3.2 MINIMUM QUALITY/SAFETY STANDARDS .......................................................................... 222
8.3.3 VARIETY-REDUCING STANDARDS ..................................................................................... 224
8.3.4 INFORMATION/MEASUREMENT STANDARDS ..................................................................... 225
8.3.5 SUMMARY ..................................................................................................................... 226
8.4 PUBLIC PROCUREMENT AND STANDARDIZATION ............................................................. 227
8.5 SUMMARY ..................................................................................................................... 229
8.6 QUIZ ............................................................................................................................. 230
8.7 GLOSSARY .................................................................................................................... 233
8.8 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS ................................................................................................ 234
8.9 REFERENCES ................................................................................................................ 234

9 CONCLUSION ........................................................................................................................... 237

ABOUT THE AUTHORS .................................................................................................................. 238

ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS ................................................................................................................ 241

ANSWERS TO QUIZ QUESTIONS ................................................................................................... 242


UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

FOREWORD

S
tep into any ETSI committee meeting, and you will encounter individuals with a wealth of professional
experience, both in their technical areas, and in standardization processes. They acquired their
technical knowledge through education, training and life-long learning. But where did they get their
standardization skills? It is unlikely they received much formal education or training in standardization,
beyond attending short courses run by standardization bodies, such as our ETSI Seminar.
However, standardization is not merely a technical subject. Standardization has become a key business
process in the ICT industry. In our industry we talk of networked innovation and platform technologies.
Software is modular and increasingly open source, while common components are found in many disparate
products. Furthermore, companies make extensive use of patent protection for their innovations. In this
environment, the path to commercial success for ICT products and services is often through standardization.
Standardization enables common components, provides the platform technologies, unlocks a global
market with all the attendant economies of scale. Standards essential patents may also release the value
in protected innovations. This business-oriented view of the importance of standardization is not widely
recognized, and hence it is often missing from our business and legal education.
To try to remedy this situation and prepare a new generation of standards professionals, ETSI, with the
support of the European Commission and the EFTA Secretariat, has commissioned the development of
teaching materials for a comprehensive education course on ICT standardization. This material could be
used in a standards-focused module in engineering and scientific education. Parts of it could also be used
in business and legal education. It could also be integrated into in-company training courses. The material,
a textbook and a comprehensive set of slides, will be available from the ETSI website free of charge, and
is designed to be adapted by lecturers and teachers according to their specific needs.
The teaching material has been developed by a team composed of researchers, lecturers and standards
professionals. Indeed, some team members fulfil all three roles. This work expresses their independent
professional opinion and does not form an official ETSI teaching on the subject of standardization. This
teaching material is being trialled in universities and we expect its usage to grow. Please provide us with
feedback as we plan to update it over the coming years. But mostly, I encourage you to use it, learn from
it, teach others and share your knowledge of this important aspect of our ICT industry.

Luis Jorge Romero


Director General
ETSI

1
CHAPTER 1 - Introduction

1 INTRODUCTION

S
tandards support our everyday life much more than we may think. Actually, we owe much of the
progress in our modern life to standardization. Without standards, our life would not be as organized
as it is today. We would have difficulties in doing basic things that we now take for granted. Imagine
if the times or the track width of trains were not standardized, or imagine if we were not able to use our
mobile devices once we are out of the reach of our operators’ networks, for instance abroad.
Thousands of years ago, society recognized the importance of standardized measurements. Weight and
distance, or length, cannot be measured without a common reference system agreed upon by people
and institutions, in other words a system that is standardized. With technological progress, the need for
standardization grows. The rapid progress in the area of information and communication technology (ICT)
could not be achieved without the advances in standardization. Standardization and standards boost
progress and create a basis, upon which technology can evolve.
Though important, ICT standardization and its methods remain a topic that is not easily accessible. It
seems that this field is becoming increasingly limited to the expert and remains mysterious to the non-
expert. So far, there is research published in the area, but there is no textbook that makes the topic easy to
digest by the interested student. We believe that standardization, in particular in the area of ICT, deserves
more attention. The principles of ICT standardization should be taught in class in order to convey essential
knowledge to students about such an important field.
This textbook is an attempt to make ICT standardization accessible and understandable to students.
It covers the essentials that are required to get a good overview of the field. The book is organized in
chapters that are self-contained, although it would be advantageous to read the book from cover to cover.
The second chapter provides a high-level overview of the scope and process of standardization, while
introducing the main subjects that are covered in detail in subsequent chapters. It is a synthesis of the
basic concepts mainly expressed in a simple and example-based way.
In Chapter 3, readers are introduced to the key concepts that will guide them through the tricky landscape
of standardization. In particular, they will learn about Standards Development Organizations (SDOs), and
the mechanisms that support their cooperation and coordination.
Chapter 4 addresses several topics related to the development of high-quality formal standards. The
process of producing standards is described in detail and illustrated with several examples. As standards
are written by standardization experts, the chapter describes their roles in the standardization process
as well as the technical and personal skills that enable them to carry out their daily tasks. Chapter 4 also
describes the main activities and responsibilities of the standardization experts and how they interact with
their peers, inside the standardization group and within their own organizations.

2
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

To be successful in a competitive marketplace, companies need to be innovative. They have to constantly


look for new opportunities for innovation. Chapter 5 deals with the interdependencies between innovation
and standardization. Whereas innovation is understood as the result of a creative process, standards rather
represent stability and identification of common grounds. Those aspects are—at least at a first glance—
not necessarily conducive to innovation. Standards are the result of many years of knowledge gathering
and structuring. As such, standards represent an important source of codified knowledge. Although they
are crucial to the company’s success, many companies do not see the relationships between standards/
standardization and innovation. Chapter 5 will, in particular, focus on the so-called innovation potentials in
standardization, in other words the aspects that make standardization conducive to innovation.
Chapter 6 looks at participation in standardization from the perspective of an organization interested in
getting involved, looking both at strategic and technical aspects. The chapter also deals with the operation
of standardization efforts and organizations, including voting, and the impact of external influences. The
chapter concludes with information regarding how to select standards and specifications for a given
application.
Decisions related to Intellectual Property Rights (IPR) have a significant impact on a company’s business
success. Given a new technology, companies can choose from a menu of possible options: either go
for patenting, do standardization, implement a mixed strategy or keep their technologies secret. To be
successful in the market, companies have to make the right decisions in order to capture the value of
their innovations: to patent, to standardize, or to pursue a mixed strategy? Chapter 7 tackles this issue by
introducing a decision tree that helps an informed decision be made, once a new product or technology
is created.
Chapter 8 provides an in-depth analysis of the economic contribution of standards. Standards are an
important instrument in the diffusion of new technologies and technological know-how and contribute
significantly to economic growth. Although our world is strongly reliant on standards, their real effects on
the economy are less obvious. Like patents, standards are carriers of codified knowledge and can provide
companies with state-of-the-art knowledge. This chapter also analyses the role of standards in public
procurement. Governments use standards in the context of public procurement to improve transparency
and guarantee a high quality of public services. Companies who are willing to apply for public tenders need
to comply with the indicated standards. Thus, the government can indirectly encourage the adoption of
standards by companies, and therefore support the innovative strength and technological progress of a
nation.

3
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

2 INTRODUCTION TO STANDARDS

This chapter aims to provide a high-level overview of the scope and process of standardization, while
at the same time introducing the main subjects that will be covered in greater depth and detail in the
following chapters.
It is an initial introduction to the basic concepts of the book by using examples. The chapter can
also be used standalone for providing the fundamental knowledge on standardization to a general
audience.
This chapter has the following objectives:
a) to identify what standards are, what they are not, and how they impact everyday life;
b) to explain what benefits standards bring and what undesired drawbacks they may imply;
c) to introduce the complex international standardization landscape, where multiple organizations
operate and collaborate to create standards;
d) to briefly explain the structure of the standards development process;
e) to provide hints about the use of standards; i.e., how to select relevant standards and how to
go through standards documents.

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
■ Students should grasp how standards—generally defined as "widely agreed ways of doing
things"—are needed to guarantee the interoperability of "things", which is essential to the
functioning of our technological world;
■ Students should understand the role of Standards Development Organizations and how their
structured approach to standards development benefits innovation, trade and society; they
should also realize that ill-conceived usage of standards and the standards development
process has its drawbacks;
■ Students should get a glimpse of major SDOs active in the ICT sector;
■ Students should understand the main basic concepts of the SDOs’ processes and the
characteristics of the main deliverables.

4
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

2.1 BASICS OF STANDARDIZATION

2.1.1 INTRODUCTION
The online Cambridge dictionary provides the following definitions for the term "standard": "a pattern or
model that is generally accepted" (example, "This program is an industry standard for computers") and "a
level of quality" (example, "This piece of work is below standard/is not up to standard."). As we will see in
the next part of this chapter, both definitions may apply to the specific purpose of our work.

DEFINITION
For the time being, we will primarily stick to the first definition, which, in an even more general and
informal way, can be expressed as such: a "standard" is "a widely agreed way of doing something".
Depending on the specific area of application, "doing something" may be replaced by, for example,
"designing a product", "building a process", "implementing a procedure", or "delivering a service".

Clearly, "standard", i.e., "largely agreed and common" ways of doing things provide many benefits; our
technological world simply would not work, or, at least, it would be harder and more uncomfortable to
make it work without "standards". In fact, let us think about how we, computer users, would be in difficulty
if each computer maker used a different way of arranging keys on a keyboard, or if each producer of
computer peripherals used its own specific connectors or, even, its own protocol1 (Figure 2.1). On the
one hand, we, as users, would be confined to choosing from a restricted selection of compatible devices
and, on the other hand, computer and peripheral makers would be forced to pre-select, by design, the
counterparts they want to interoperate with.

Figure 2.1: Technologies would not work without standards.

1 Here, "protocol" means the set of messages that two devices (in this case, a PC and a connected peripheral) need to exchange to interoperate. The protocol
defines the messages to be exchanged to perform a certain action (for instance, to send a document from a PC to a printer), their logical content and format, as
well as their sequence.

5
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

Looking at the examples above, which, as described in Section 2.1.2, could be extended to a wide variety
of other fields, it is evident how a common and agreed "way of doing things" is largely beneficial to all
players in a business sector.
Such convergence towards common and agreed-upon solutions can happen with two different processes,
which can be a first criterion to classify "standards". Indeed, we may distinguish between two main different
types of standards, according to the way they are born: "de facto standards" and "formal standards".
A "de facto standard", also known as "standard in actuality", arises when a winning solution is widely and
independently adopted by different industries within a market segment and products developed on such a
basis are widely accepted by customers.

EXAMPLE
Some examples of "de facto standards" are:
■ The most widely used keyboard layout (QWERTY) dates back to 1864, when it was patented by
Christopher Sholes. The later Dvorak version (1936, by August Dvorak) was intended to increase
typing speed, but owing to the already consolidated position of QWERTY, was not as successful
(though natively supported by most modern operating systems).
■ HD DVD (High Definition Digital Versatile Disc) and Blu-ray Disc are two digital optical formats for
new-generation DVDs suitable for high-definition content.

Figure 2.2: De facto standard

6
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Differing from "de facto standards", "formal standards" are produced by Standards Development
Organizations (SDOs).
SDOs are organizations whose statutory purpose is to develop standards and that put in place formal well-
defined procedures to guarantee a fair development process.
Figure 2.3 shows just a few examples of SDOs, which include, for instance, ISO (International Organization
for Standardization), IEC (International Electrotechnical Commission), ETSI (European Telecommunications
Standards Institute), and ITU (International Telecommunication Union). More examples of SDOs and a
description of their objectives and operations are provided in Section 2.1.3 and later sections.

Figure 2.3: Examples of SDOs

De facto standards can become formal standards, if and when they are published by a SDO. Examples of
these standards are HTML (HyperText Markup Language), developed in the early ‘90s by Tim Berners-Lee
at CERN in Geneva, Switzerland, and constantly maintained by the World Wide Web Consortium (W3C),
and PDF (Portable Document Format), created by Adobe Systems in 1993 and later formally standardized
by ISO (ISO 32000, ISO 19005-1:2005).

2.1.2 STANDARDS IN EVERYDAY LIFE


Formal and de facto standards affect our everyday life, as many technologies, products and services are
based on established standards. Later in this section, we provide a few remarkable examples that highlight
the strong link between our everyday life and standards. We also quote some of the most prominent SDOs.
Note, however, that more detailed information about these organizations’ scope and history can be found
in Section 2.3 and in Chapter 3.

7
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

EXAMPLE
Example 1 – Smartphone browsing.
One of the actions that we do most frequently today is surf the Internet, especially by making use of mobile
devices such as smartphones. Figure 2.4 highlights some of the technological components that enable
a smartphone user to browse the Web in the same way as through a wired desktop computer. If we
look at the number of different devices (such as smartphones, mobile and wireless network equipment,
and servers) and software modules (communication protocols, browsers, and web server applications)
involved that have to interoperate to support this familiar scenario, despite being produced by different
vendors, the importance of a shared and interoperable technical approach is clear. In fact, as shown
in Figure 2.4, there are many formal standards that provide the basic reference design rules for the
implementation of the main components that populate this scenario. Some of these standards are related
to the user equipment regarding its hardware characteristics, also taking into account safety issues. Other
standards cover connectivity among user devices and mobile and wireless networks as well as the overall
functionality of the same networks. Lastly, a number of other standards are related to the functionality of
the Internet and the protocols to support web browsing.
Smartphone producers can refer to ETSI and CEN-CENELEC standards for radio and telecommunication
terminal equipment, which set essential requirements for safety and health, electromagnetic compatibility
and the efficient use of the radio spectrum.
As far as mobile network interfaces and functionality are concerned, smartphone makers and mobile
network equipment makers and operators will likely refer to the 3rd Generation Partnership Project
(3GPP), which constitutes the leading organization for the development of globally accepted solutions.
3GPP is the SDO that defined the widely popular "third generation" UMTS and "fourth generation"
LTE protocols to support data exchange over a mobile network. Similarly, to support data connectivity
through wireless area networks, smartphone makers and equipment makers can refer to the widely used
Wi-Fi and Bluetooth technologies, which are standardized by the IEEE and the Bluetooth Special Interest
Group (SIG), respectively.
Compatibility and interworking issues are particularly challenging in the Internet environment, where a
complex infrastructure needs to support information exchange among a wide range of heterogeneous
devices and software applications. For this reason, despite the continuously evolving nature of Internet
technologies, there is a need to establish common rules that ensure interoperability2.
The main contributor to the definition of standard solutions for the operation of the Internet is the IETF,
whose self-imposed mission (IETF, 2018) is "to make the Internet work better by producing high quality,
relevant technical documents that influence the way people design, use, and manage the Internet".
IETF standards cover the basic functionality of the Internet, including, among others, node addressing3
and naming4, data traffic routing5, traffic management6, and network security. Major IETF contributions
include Internet Protocol "version 4" and "version 6" (IPv4 and IPv6), OSPF (Open Shortest Path First)
and BGP (Border Gateway Protocol) routing protocols, and the IPsec (IP Security Architecture). As a
complement to IETF standards, the World Wide Web Consortium (W3C), defines protocols for web
functionality; W3C develops standards for languages widely used to build web pages, such as HTML
(HyperText Markup Language) and XML (eXtensible Markup Language), which foster the interoperability
of different platforms on the Internet.

8
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Lastly, always with the aim of ensuring interoperability, standard activities also apply to tools for developing
web content and applications. One notable example is ECMA and ISO collaboration to develop a standard
scripting language that is the base for the popular JavaScript technology, used to build interactive web
pages and provide online software applications.

Wireless area
networks
IEEE standards for WiFi and
Bluetooth standard

TM

Internet
W3C standards for hypertext
Mobile network protocols and language
and services IETF standards for internet
protocols
3GPP standards for mobile
MMS
networks and services
SMS

Applications
ECMA and ISO standards for
scripting language
(Java)

User terminal
ETSI standards for radio
terminal equipment
ETSI and CEN/CENELEC
standards for safety

Figure 2.4: Standardization enabling smartphone web browsing.

2 For our purposes, we can define "interoperability" as the ability of different devices or software applications to exchange data and use the information that has
been exchanged. This implies that interoperable devices or software applications share common protocols (as defined in Section 2.1.1).
3 To give an example, we can say that each Internet device (such as a desktop or laptop computer, server, scanner, printer, modem, router, smartphone, tablet or
smart TV) is assigned an address (called an IP address) that uniquely identifies the device within its network. Every message transmitted over an internet network
contains a "source IP address" (i.e. the IP address of the device that generated the message) and a "destination IP address" (i.e. the address of the destination
device) and the network infrastructure is responsible for getting the message from its source to its destination.
4 An Internet device can be assigned a device Internet name (such as www.etsi.org), which uniquely identifies the device within its network. The Internet
infrastructure includes specific mechanisms for the name resolution service, i.e., to remap the device name into the relevant IP address. This mechanism lets us
surf the Internet by using an easy-to-remember string instead of an alphanumeric IP address to identify our target device.
5 By routing we mean the set of mechanisms used within the Internet infrastructure to determine what path a message has to follow through the network to get to
its final destination, identified by the "destination IP address".
6 Traffic management aims to optimize the performance of the Internet network. It may include provisions to classify and prioritize traffic, so as to guarantee that
the portion of traffic that belongs to a certain class complies with determined performances (for instance, having a fixed maximum network transit delay).

9
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

Example 2 – Using a Personal Computer.


Unlike the example described above, a stand-alone PC appears to be a relatively "simple" and self-
contained object that each manufacturer could build using its own proprietary technology. Yet, in this case
as well, a design approach based on common standards has many benefits. It allows basic components
from different providers to be used interchangeably, to simplify connectivity with external peripherals and
networks, and to guarantee its users a safe and environmentally compatible product. As a matter of fact,
a 2010 paper (Biddle & al., 2010) identifies 251 technical interoperability standards implemented in a
laptop computer, and estimates an actual total number (including aspects of quality, safety, performance,
measurement, environment, accessibility, design process, manufacturing process and electromagnetic
compatibility) that might well be over 500. Out of the 251 identified standards, "202 (80%) were developed
by SDOs and 49 (20%) by individual companies" (Biddle & al., 2010). Figure 2.5 shows only a few of the
standards that may be involved. They include JEDEC for building hardware components; INCITS and
VESA’s standards for memory, storage and display components; and PCI to interconnect heterogeneous
cards; mechanical, physical, and software interfaces to plug and connect peripherals and networks,
such as IEEE’s Wi-Fi and Ethernet; the IETF’s protocol stack; HDMI for audio/video peripherals and USB
for a wide range of devices; and basic software tools such as compilers for ISO C/C++ programming
languages. This gives an idea of the complexity of the standardization environment in a product that has
become part of everyday life. Most likely, however, with the advancement oftechnology in recent years,
the figures presented may have significantly increased.

Figure 2.5: PC-related standards.

10
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Example 3– Switching on a light.


A simple action like switching on a light bulb actually involves a complex system to produce and dispatch
electrical energy. Such a system is segmented into areas such as generation, high-voltage and long-
distance transport/transmission of energy, and medium- and low-voltage distribution to end users, which
belong to different administrative domains. For instance, the owners of the generators are usually different
from the transmission line operators and distributors. All the listed players must interoperate to guarantee
the balance of the whole system, in other words to balance energy demand and production, and must
guarantee the availability of their own infrastructure, as whatever failure in the generation-transmission-
distribution chain would cause a disruption of the service provided to clients. Furthermore, the clients
themselves, who may also be small energy producers when they inject self-generated renewable energy
into the network, may contribute to the stability of the whole system, by both limiting their energy intake
from the network or injecting excess production into the network, according to the infrastructure actual
needs.
Another critical aspect of energy infrastructures lies, of course, in safety and environmental issues. It is
essential to ensure that the deployment and operation of both the generation-transmission-distribution
infrastructure and the equipment on customer premises are not harmful to individuals and the environment.
The need to manage all the above-listed issues has made the electric ecosystem one of the most subject
to standardization; standards cover many aspects, from the definition of architectures and protocols for
system and service monitoring and management to the safety rules for installation of electrical supply and
appliances in buildings (Figure 2.6). The main SDOs involved are IEC and CEN-CENELEC; with the latter
specifically focusing on Europe.
Work to standardize the electricity system is nowadays even more fervent, as it needs to cope with the
envisaged evolution towards the so-called Smart Electricity Grid. The Smart Grid consists, basically,
of the widespread usage of Information and Communication Technology (ICT) for the implementation
of new real-time automated control mechanisms to improve the reliability, efficiency and environmental
sustainability of the electricity system. Such evolution, which requires a deep reconsideration of the
design and operation of current and more traditional energy systems, has triggered various joint initiatives
among SDOs traditionally involved in the electricity and ICT sectors; one of the most valuable examples,
at European level, is constituted by the joint ETSI and CEN-CENELEC Smart Grid Coordination Group
(CEN-CENELEC, 2018).

11
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

CEN-CENELEC and ETSI standards for Smart Grids

IEC and CEN-CENELEC standards IEC and CENELEC standards for IEC standards for electrical
for Generation System (e.g. electrical Transmission and installations for buildings;
architectures, protocols and distribution (e.g. architectures, IEC and CENELEC standards
technologies for system protocols and technologies for for architectures, protocols
monitoring and maintenance, monitoring and maintenance of and technologies for
power quality control, grid assets, monitoring power flows metering and flexible
stability, balance demand and and quality, system management of customers
production) reconfiguration in case of faults, (demand/response)
operate distributed energy
sources)

Figure 2.6: Power generation, transmission, distribution and utilization components.

2.1.3 FORMAL STANDARDS


The focus of the next parts of this chapter is on "formal standards", with the aim of describing their
main characteristics. Therefore, in the following and unless otherwise explicitly stated, when referring to
"standards" we mean "formal standards".

DEFINITION
A standard defines requirements, specifications, guidelines or characteristics for a determined
material, product, process or service. Standards are developed by SDOs, which involve selected
stakeholders in the item to be standardized, such as manufacturers, providers, consumers and
regulators, with possible contributions from academics and professional users. SDOs put in place
procedures to guarantee a fair standards development process, which is aimed at building consensus
among the stakeholders involved (Figure 2.7) and ensuring the quality of the final deliverables.

12
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

The two main concepts that we can identify in the preceding definition and that are worth noting to highlight
the main characteristics of a "standard" are "consensus built" and "fair development process".
By "consensus built" we mean that standards are the products of negotiation among all involved (and
relevant) stakeholders, aimed at establishing a general agreement and the absence of sustained opposition
to substantial issues.
By "fair development process" we mean that the consensus building is regulated by procedures that aim to
ensure that all involved parties are able to express their views and to reconcile any conflicting arguments.
The process includes, for instance, provisions to publicize SDO internal body activities to stakeholders and
to set up formal reviews and approvals for all deliverables.

STAN
TAANNNDAR
NDARD
ND DA
DARRD

Figure 2.7: Consensus reaching.

Another main characteristic of "standards" is the fact that their adoption is on a "voluntary basis". This
feature makes "standards" different from "regulations" (Figure 2.8). In fact, whereas conformity with
standards is voluntary, regulations are compulsory. Regulations are defined by appointed authorities,
which rule determined territories/markets. An item (product, service, process, etc.) that does not meet
the requirements of regulations is not allowed to be sold or used on the territory/market where those
regulations apply. On the contrary, non-compliance with standards does not restrict the distribution of an
item "by law".

13
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

Although there is a distinction between "standards" and "regulations", they may sometimes be linked.
In fact, regulatory authorities often (fully or partially) reference established standards in regulations, as this
simplifies and accelerates regulatory work, leveraging the directions of established and widely agreed best
practices defined in standards.
A third main characteristic of standards is their "limited focus". As a matter of fact, standards are aimed
at defining a minimum set of requirements for an item (product, service, process, etc.) in order to make
it meet certain well-defined objectives, for instance to guarantee a certain degree of interoperability or
to define a minimum level of performance. Standards are not intended to be a set of thorough design
rules that are aimed at constraining the development of an item (Figure 2.8); many "standard-compliant"
implementations of the item are possible. In this respect, standards do not substitute the designer and
should not limit (at least in principle) the designer’s potential to create innovative contributions in the
development of new products or services. They rather give a guide and some rules useful for assuring a
minimum level of interoperability and quality to the final result.

Regulation

Constraining rules
established by a
Inspires governmental
authority and
Defines addressed to
people/organisations
under authority’s
control
Constrains
STA
TAN
ANNNDAR
NDARD
ND
DAR
DARD

Produces Specific
inplementation
Inspires inspired by
standards and
constrained by
regulations

Design

Figure 2.8: Standards and regulations

14
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

2.2 BENEFITS AND RISKS OF STANDARDIZATION

2.2.1 BENEFITS
As a consensus-built set of rules/definitions for doing something, standards benefit sustainable innovation
and the economy as a whole. Standards can be used in a large number of cases to meet a diverse range
of needs. They can provide a common language for defining product, service, and process requirements.
They can help identify reference performance indicators concerning the safety, environmental and technical
characteristics of products, giving the opportunity to set (at least) a minimum reference level of acceptability.
They can ensure the correct interworking of different parts of complex systems. They can define common
test and measurement procedures, allowing a fair comparison of quality and performance among different
products from different producers.
At a glance, we can identify three broad areas that can greatly benefit from standards: innovation,
environment/safety and the economy.

IDEA

STANDARD
Figure 2.9: Standards benefit innovation

Standards strongly benefit innovation by promoting the interoperability of products, services, and processes.
A standard, by steering the activity of designers, gives producers the opportunity to:
■■ reduce development time: by setting basic product requirements, standards provide designers with
valuable references that offer a set of consolidated solutions for many key issues;
■■ reduce design costs: by steering design activities, standards provide a shorter development time,
with fewer design errors and consequent re-design;
■■ reduce risks: standards allow a product to be designed according to market-driven and largely
accepted rules, for increased product success rate;

15
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

■■ improve quality: standards define already proven solutions that push up the potential quality of results;
■■ decrease time-to-market: this effect is a consequence of shorter development times and the assured
level of conformance with market needs;
■■ open cross-border markets: interoperability guaranteed by standards ensures that products
manufactured in one country can be sold and used in other locations;
■■ attract more customers: by giving them the tangible perception of reliable and effective products in
an open and competitive market.
To summarize, the above positive effects of standards facilitate the uptake of innovation in the marketplace
and concretely enhance the company’s propensity to innovate.

STANDARD
Figure 2.10: Standards benefit the environment and safety

Standards benefit the environment and safety by defining requirements, which become widespread in the
industry and often referenced by normative regulations and labelling systems. In fact, standards have many
positive effects:
■■ the process of making products more sustainable and safer becomes less expensive and faster if
this process is supported by standards, which provide consolidated guidelines, within reach of a
broader range of companies;
■■ the labelling that refers to standards/regulations can communicate the level of quality of the products/
services in a common, unambiguous and understandable way, promoting company and product
images with customers;
■■ standards typically facilitate the creation of regulations, which impose constraints for safety and
sustainability.

16
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

EXAMPLE
One example, among many, which is worth mentioning in this respect, is the universal/common charger
for mobile phones. Until the second decade of the 21st century there were no common rules about
mobile phone chargers. Each producer—and sometimes each phone model—had a different power
supply with a different connector. This situation resulted in a lot of waste, a number of inconveniences
to the customer, including cost, difficulty in finding replacements, and unclear performance indications,
especially concerning energy efficiency during use and especially when on standby (when chargers were
plugged in, but not connected to the phone). In 2009, the ITU-T produced the L.1000 Recommendations
(inspired by and harmonizing preceding ones from the GSM Association, the Chinese Ministry of Industry
and Information Technology and the Korean Telecommunications Technology Association [TTA]), which
specified the physical reference structure (in terms of connectors) and main electrical characteristics,
including energy efficiency and safety, of the universal charging solution. Nowadays, most mobile phones
(and often also other equivalent equipment in terms of energy requirements) use interchangeable power
supplies, with real advantages for users (cost, performance, safety) and the environment (waste, pollution).

Standard !

Standard !

$ Standards benefit economy

Standard !

Figure 2.11: Standards benefit the economy

Standards benefit the economy by incentivizing investments, as standards ensure the stability of the
technology over a reasonable period of time, enabling economies of scale, encouraging greater and fairer
competition, and facilitating trade thanks to common approaches among countries.
In the majority of relevant technological contexts, the presence of a standard actively contributes to
the consolidation of new technologies and to identifying evolution paths that are able to preserve past
investments, which is a critical aspect, especially in a rapidly evolving sector such as ICT. These kinds of

17
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

actions make investments more affordable and facilitate their quick return. Beyond their evident (although not
always effective) effect against geographical and political barriers, standards can also significantly increase
collaboration opportunities among the companies that came together to produce them. Moreover, they
can tangibly contribute to opening up essential opportunities for small and innovative enterprises, mainly
because of investment cost reduction, better revenue opportunities, but also, and possibly especially,
thanks to better accessibility to some key (standardized) technology solutions that standards can very
often guarantee.
The positive effects that standards have on innovation, the environment and the economy are reflected in
benefits for both industries and society.
Standards benefit industries (especially newly established ones, as well as Small and Medium Enterprises),
by driving and facilitating the development of new technologies, and by ensuring fair competition and
potentially large market penetration.
As depicted in Figure 2.12, on the one hand, the positive effects of standards on innovation encourage the
development of new advanced products/services, owing to reduced risks and investment and increased
market opportunities. On the other hand, the growth in the safety and sustainability of products and
production processes makes competition fairer, as a consequence of common and testable targets/
requirements (defined by standards) and the reduction of non-compliance risks (mainly for safety but also,
in part, for sustainability). The benefits to the economy and business, with cost reductions, increased
efficiency, and an enlargement of trade and potential markets, complete the picture, in which standards
really can operate as an effective market booster, especially for new and innovative companies.

+ Innovation + Trade and competition + Safety and sustainability


Standard !

Standard !

IDEA $
Standards benefit economy

Standard !

STANDARD STANDARD
Enlarge potential market
Ease new developments Fairer competition and less
(- risk, - investment, risks of non-compliance
+ opportunities) (widespread and shared
basic requirements)

Figure 2.12: How standards can benefit industries.

18
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

On the other hand, the general benefits that standards have on innovation, the economy and the environment
are reflected in society too, i.e. among communities and individuals (Figure 2.13).
As depicted in Figure 2.13, by boosting innovation, standards help satisfy people’s tangible and intangible
needs, while contributing to improving their quality of life. Moreover, by fostering the sustainability and
safety of products and production processes, standards contribute to enhancing people’s health and
safety as well. Finally, by favouring fair competition among industries and the reduction of final product
costs, standards can enlarge customers’ choice and ensure best "value for money".
As a final consideration, it is also important to note how standards can support regulations. Many countries
reference standards in legislation to determine rules about the safety, quality or environmental compatibility
of objects, services and procedures. This approach has many advantages for legislators. They are able to
access the specific technical expertise and the resources of the standard makers and can take advantage
of the higher (compared to laws and regulations) update frequency of the standards. The relationship
between legislators and SDOs can also be explicit and formally stated as part of the creation of laws and
requirements, with mandates for developing standard-supporting specific guidelines.

+ Innovation + Trade and competition + Safety and sustainability


Standard !

Standard !

IDEA $
Standards benefit economy

Standard !

STANDARD STANDARD
Best value for money
Satisfaction of tangible and Safer environment
intangible needs

Figure 2.13: How standards benefit society (for both individuals and groups).

Figures 2.12 and 2.13 give an initial, but concrete view of the relevance and the positive effects of standards
on both people and the market. Additional and more detailed information about this topic can be found
in the next chapters and mainly in Chapters 5, 7 and 8 where relationships among standards, innovation,
business and society are extensively discussed.

19
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

2.2.2 RISKS
Using standards may also imply some drawbacks and risks. In the following paragraphs, some of the
most well known risks and drawbacks are listed and briefly discussed; moreover, we also present some
indications about how SDOs tackle them to reduce their potentially negative occurrence in different
contexts.

IDEA

STANDARD
Figure 2.14: Standards and innovation

Especially, but not only, in the scientific arena, there is often the feeling that standards can jeopardize
innovation as, when established, they could limit or delay the introduction of new innovative (disruptive)
solutions in the market. This drawback mainly comes from the consolidation effect that standards have
in some contexts, especially in technology-oriented ones. In this condition, a standard makes access to
the specific technology easier, but at the same time (if successful) also makes a solution a semi-obligatory
choice (Figure 2.14), and more difficult to change or evolve. If this effect does not stop innovation completely,
it may significantly slow down the innovative evolution. Furthermore, introducing innovation into standards
(i.e. developing new standards based on innovative technologies) may be complex given the very nature of
SDOs. As a matter of fact, the same procedures SDOs put in place to ensure the fairness of the standards
development process and to get the largest consensus among stakeholders may require a long time to
converge to the final solution.
This real adverse effect can be reduced or even eliminated if the creation of the standard, and particularly
its evolution, is strictly related to and driven by the scientific and industrial research environment, which
can actively contribute to evolving standards according to the most relevant technological innovation.
This situation can already be found in many ICT contexts, which may also be market driven, such as
Mobile Radio Networks, starting from 2G up to the future 5G, where standards are continuously evolving
and innovation is not slowed down but, on the contrary, encouraged and boosted by standardization.
In order to mitigate risk, SDOs usually actively involve academics and researchers in the development of
standards. They also often establish and support open expert groups to explore innovation and generate
new standardization initiatives, including the evolution of current ones.

20
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

NO:1234 /11:12:2

DAILY NEWS
014

BIG NEWS
Influence of
interests on special
DOLOR SIT AMET

LOREM IPSUM DOLOR


SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM

standards
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMETLOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM

One of the pena


IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT

for refusing to lties


LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT

participate in
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET

politics standard
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT

that you end up s is


LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET

being governed
your inferiors. by
Plato

NEW DEAL
DOLOR SIT AMET
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM
DOLOR SIT AMET
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR

WORLD NEWS
SIT AMET
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM
DOLOR SIT AMET
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR
SIT AMET

LOREM IPSUM LOREM IPSUM DOLOR


DOLOR SIT AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM
DOLOR SIT AMET LOREM IPSUM
DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMETLOREM IPSUM
SIT AMET LOREM DOLOR SIT AMETET
IPSUM DOLOR SIT
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET
SIT AMET LOREM
IPSUM DOLOR SIT LOREM IPSUM DOLOR
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET SIT AMET LOREM
SIT AMET LOREM IPSUM DOLOR SIT
IPSUM DOLOR SIT DOLOR SIT AMET AMET LOREM IPSUM
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR AMET LOREM IPSUM DOLOR DOLOR SIT AMET
SIT AMET LOREM LOREM IPSUM
SIT AMET LOREM IPSUM DOLOR SIT
IPSUM DOLOR SIT AMET LOREM IPSUM AMET LOREM IPSUM
LOREM IPSUM AMET DOLOR SIT AMET DOLOR SIT
DOLOR SIT AMETLOR LOREM IPSUM DOLOR
EM IPSUM DOLOR IPSUM DOLOR SIT SIT AMETLOREM
AMETET SIT AMET LOREM IPSUM IPSUM DOLOR SIT
DOLOR SIT AMET AMET LOREM
SIT AMET LOREM LOREM IPSUM DOLOR
IPSUM DOLOR SIT SIT AMET LOREM
AMET LOREM IPSUM IPSUM DOLOR
DOLOR SIT AMET
LOREM IPSUM DOLOR
SIT AMET

Figure 2.15: Influence of special interests on standards

A second possible risk, often feared by both consumers and companies (especially SMEs) is the fact that
standards might jeopardize fair competition among industries and countries, as SDOs may be politicized,
or unduly influenced by "special interests".
In general, it is natural and unavoidable for all (or at least most) of the participants in the standard creation
process, to try to uphold the interests of the organizations (companies, country, etc.) that they represent. To
minimize this risk, the main actions that SDOs put in place are, on the one hand, to enlarge the participation
in the standardization processes to include the maximum number of eligible and competent contributors
and, on the other hand, to set and apply fair and transparent rules in managing the standards development
processes. Enlarging the participation in standards is a key point to guarantee fairness. Those who do
not participate cannot protect their interests. Indeed, this can easily apply to small companies. However,
they have the possibility to organize themselves in groups and be represented in the standardization arena
without excessive investment. A second aspect to be considered is related to the right balance between
effectiveness and fairness. In fact, a large number of participants in a standard might make consensus
more difficult and time consuming, increasing the standard’s time-to-market and causing possible failures.
In this respect, the role of SDOs is relevant in order to manage all these aspects in the right way and to drive
the organization towards the right balance of fairness, technical excellence and timing.

21
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

Figure 2.16: Influence of special interests on standards

The importance of standards in modern times has led to the creation of a large number of SDOs, often
(at least partially) overlapping in terms of interests and goals and which may even, in some cases, act
as competitors. In this context, a diversified standardization landscape can lead to inconsistencies, as
standards produced by different SDOs might cover the same topic or be partially overlapping, but offer
different solutions. These situations may potentially lead to the production of inconsistent or, at the very
least, redundant requirements that could strongly jeopardize the benefits of standardization. Additionally, an
uncoordinated and uncontrolled proliferation of standards/SDOs can feed, at least in principle, the previous
risk of "unfairness" because some SDOs could be "misused" to support local or specific interests. There
are two main actions that aim to mitigate this possible negative behaviour. The first is by the users of and
contributors to the standard, who need to carefully choose the most appropriate SDO. The second, this
time by the SDOs, is to promote liaisons among SDOs and to increase collaboration and joint coordination
actions.
The three issues presented and discussed are just some of the potential drawbacks of standardization.
Other risks and drawbacks will be described in the following chapters of the book. However, if the above-
mentioned risks are correctly and effectively managed, the negative effects of standardization will become
negligible, and the positive effects will more than outweigh the negative ones.

22
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

2.3 STANDARDIZATION LANDSCAPE


A fundamental point for effectively dealing with standards and standardization is represented by the
knowledge of the standardization landscape. A minimum level of understanding of at least the main SDO
types, objectives and relevance is essential to be able to select the correct documents (if you are or want to
be a user of standards) or to choose the suitable context to contribute to (if you are a potential contributor
to standards). The key role played by this kind of knowledge is also amplified by the size of the ICT
standardization landscape, considering that the number of SDOs active around the world is currently quite
large and the relationships among them are often quite complex. In this section, we start by introducing a
basic classification of SDOs and a general overview of the ICT standardization ecosystem with summary
descriptions of some of the most relevant players in the field. A detailed and rather in-depth analysis of the
standards world is reported in Chapter 3, where the reader can find a more comprehensive and detailed
picture.
As a basic classification to approach the landscape here, we can consider three possible categories of
SDO types:
■ by geographical coverage;
■ by type of affiliates;
■ by technical scope of activities (as per each SDO’s statute).

Considering that the selection/identification of a suitable SDO is very frequently related to the geographical
location of the interests of the standard user/maker, the geographic "coverage" is the first and most simple
type of classification. In this respect, we can distinguish three types of SDOs:
■ International SDOs
■ Regional SDOs
■ National SDOs

DEFINITION
International SDOs have members worldwide, including representatives of National or Regional
standard bodies, and their deliverables have worldwide coverage.

EXAMPLE
As main examples of this category in the ICT field (with some not only restricted to this field), we can
cite (see Figure 2.17) the International Telecommunication Union (ITU), the International Organization for
Standardization (ISO) and the International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC).

23
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

Figure 2.17: The logos of the three reference international SDOs

ITU (www.itu.int) was founded in Paris in 1865 as the International Telegraph Union. It took its present
name in 1934, and in 1947 became a specialized agency of the United Nations. ITU is organized into
three Sectors (http://www.itu.int/en/about/Pages/whatwedo.aspx): the Radiocommunication Sector
(ITU-R), the Telecommunication Standardization Sector (ITU-T) and the Telecommunication Development
Sector (ITU-D). Its headquarters are in Geneva (Switzerland), but it also has many area and regional
offices distributed around the world. It includes state members, sector members, and associates from
industry, international and regional standard organizations, as well as academia, who are organized in
study groups. The ITU-T sector deals with the interoperability of ICT by covering all aspects of electronic
design and test specifications. ITU-R coordinates the use of the global radio spectrum and satellite orbits,
and ITU-D promotes fair and affordable access to telecommunications and helps stimulate social and
economic development.
ISO (www.iso.org/home.html) is an independent, international non-governmental organization founded
in 1946, when delegates from 25 countries met at the Institute of Civil Engineers in London and decided
to create a new international organization "to facilitate the international coordination and unification of
industrial standards". Today it brings together members from more than 160 countries and includes
hundreds of technical committees and subcommittees in charge of developing standards. The ISO
Central Secretariat is located (like ITU) in Geneva, Switzerland. National members are often represented
by corresponding national SDOs. For example, the American National Standards Institute (ANSI) is the
United States’ ISO representative. ISO standards cover several market sectors such as ICT, healthcare,
energy and automotive.
Founded in 1906, the IEC (www.iec.ch) prepares and publishes International Standards for all electrical,
electronic and related technologies, collectively known as "electrotechnologies". It is based in Geneva like
the ITU and ISO and has one local site in each continent. The IEC’s members are National Committees,
which appoint experts and delegates from industry, government bodies, associations and academia
(http://www.iec.ch/dyn/www/f?p=103:5:0##ref=menu). Since 1987, most of the activities related to ICT
are conducted jointly with ISO in Joint Technical Committee 1 (ISO/IEC JTC 1, http://www.iec.ch/dyn/
www/f?p=103:7:0::::FSP_ORG_ID:3387).
The three above-mentioned organizations have established a well-defined set of relationships and
agreements and typically operate with quite a high level of coordination on the various topics, often with
joint initiatives.

24
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

DEFINITION
Regional SDOs include members (industry, academia and national SDOs) from a set of countries that
usually share, or are interested in promoting, common practices and regulations.

EXAMPLE
In this category, we can find, for example, the European Committee for Standardization (CEN) and the
European Committee for Electrotechnology Standardization (CENELEC), the Pacific Area Standards
Congress (PASC), and the African Regional Organization for Standardization (ARSO).

Figure 2.18: The logos of some international/regional SDOs

Both CEN and CENELEC (www.cencenelec.eu) are organizations in charge of developing standards that
set out specifications and procedures for a wide range of products and services in Europe. The members
of CEN and CENELEC are the National Standards Bodies and National Electrotechnical Committees
of all EU member states, plus associated nations (such as Iceland, Norway, Switzerland, and Turkey).
European standards approved by CEN and CENELEC are accepted and recognized at least in all of
these countries. CENELEC focuses on standardization in the electrotechnical engineering field, in close
collaboration with the IEC and ETSI. CEN also works to remove trade barriers for European stakeholders,
such as industry and service providers.
PASC (pascnet.org) was established in 1973 and includes most of the countries in the Pacific areas. Its
main objectives are to strengthen ISO and IEC international standardization programmes and to improve
the ability of Pacific Rim standards organizations to participate in these programmes effectively, to improve
the quality and capacity of standardization in economies of the region and to support the improvement of
economic efficiency and development through the promotion of standardization.
The African Organization for Standardization, formerly ARSO (www.arso-oran.org), was founded in the
1970s under the Organization of African Unity (OAU). The main goals of this organization are to harmonize
national and/or sub-regional standards as African Standards, to initiate and coordinate the development
of African Standards (ARS) with reference to products that are of particular interest to Africa, such as
agriculture and food, civil engineering, chemistry and chemical engineering, and to encourage and
facilitate the adoption of international standards by member bodies.

DEFINITION
Finally, at individual-country level, we find National SDOs (NSDOs), which issue country-specific
standards and collaborate with International and Regional SDOs.

25
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

EXAMPLE
A large number of such entities have been set up. European NSDOs are listed on the CEN website
(standards.cen.eu/dyn/www/f?p=CENWEB:5) (see, among others, the German Deutsches Institut
für Normung [DIN], the French Association Française de Normalisation [AFNOR], and the Italian Ente
Nazionale Italiano di Unificazione [UNI]).
Notable NSDOs from outside of Europe include the American National Standards Institute (ANSI, www.
ansi.org), the Japanese Industrial Standard Committee (JISC, http://www.jisc.go.jp/eng/index.html) and
China’s Standardization Administration (SAC, http://www.sac.gov.cn/sacen/).

In addition to the classification for geographical relevance, SDOs can be also characterized with respect
to the type of affiliation, i.e. by considering the type of members that they include and organize/represent.
In this respect, we can identify:
■■ Standard initiatives,
■■ Professional organizations,
■■ Industrial fora.

DEFINITION
The standard initiatives are built by SDOs to coordinate standardization efforts on particular subjects.

EXAMPLE
Relevant examples in the ICT area include the 3rd Generation Partnership Project (3GPP) and oneM2M.

Figure 2.19: 3GPP logo

3GPP (www.3gpp.org) brings together, in a partnership project, SDOs operating in the telecommunication
field in countries and regions across the globe (Association of Radio Industries and Businesses [ARIB],
Japan, Alliance for Telecommunications Industry Solutions [ATIS], USA, China Communications Standards
Association [CCSA], ETSI, Telecommunications Standards Development Society [TSDSI], India,
Telecommunications Technology Association [TTA], Korea, Telecommunication Technology Committee
[TTC], Japan) and provides their members with a shared environment in which to produce the reports and
specifications that define mobile radio technologies. 3GPP covers cellular telecommunications network
technologies, including radio access, the core transport network, and service capabilities and hooks for
non-radio access to the core network, and for interworking with Wi-Fi networks.

26
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Figure 2.20: OneM2M logo

The purpose of oneM2M (www.onem2m.org) is to develop technical specifications, which address the
need for a reference Machine-to-Machine Service Layer that can be embedded within various hardware
and software. One of oneM2M’s main goals is to actively involve organizations from M2M-related business
domains, such as telematics and intelligent transportation, healthcare, utilities, industrial automation,
smart homes, etc. The main SDO partners in this organization are the same as 3GPP with the addition of
the Telecommunications Industry Association (TIA), USA.

DEFINITION
Professional organizations bring together independent professionals to promote best practices and
innovation in specific areas.

EXAMPLE
Two relevant examples of this affiliate type come from the Americas: the Internet Engineering Task Force
(IETF) and the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers Standards Association (IEEE-SA).

Figure 2.21: IETF logo

Based in Reston, Virginia, the IETF (www.ietf.org) is the governing body of the Internet and has the support
of other national and international standards bodies. The IETF defines the basic standard Internet operating
protocols such as TCP/IP (Transmission Control Protocol/Internet Protocol), the reference communication
language for the Internet. There are five main principles that underpin IETF work: (1) an open process, in
other words any interested person can participate in the work, (2) technical competence, (3) volunteer
core, (4) rough consensus, and (5) running code. The IETF operates as part of the Internet Society (ISOC),
a non-profit organization founded in 1992 to provide leadership in Internet-related standards, education,
access, and policy. Moreover, it is controlled by the Internet Architecture Board (IAB), which is both a
committee of the IETF and an advisory body of the Internet Society.

27
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

Figure 2.22: IEEE logo

IEEE-SA (standards.ieee.org) is a primary SDO with a large number of active technical standards,
ranging from wireless communications and digital health to cloud computing, power and energy, 3D
video, electrical vehicle standards, and the Internet of Things. It was created by the Institute of Electrical
and Electronics Engineers (IEEE), the American association of Electrical and Electronics Engineers. It
brings together and organizes members from all over the world.

DEFINITION
Industrial Fora are primarily established by industries that coordinate their efforts on specific subjects
to accelerate, complement or promote the development of a standard.

EXAMPLE
Examples in this category include: the Broadband Forum, the World Wide Web Consortium (W3C) and
Zigbee Alliance.

Figure 2.23: Broadband Forum logo

The Broadband Forum (www.broadband-forum.org) is a non-profit industry consortium dedicated


to engineering smarter and faster broadband networks. The main aim of this forum is to define best
practices for global networks, enable new service and content delivery, establish technology migration
strategies, and engineer critical device, service and development management tools in the home and
business IP networking infrastructure.

28
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Figure 2.24: W3C logo

The W3C (www.w3.org) mission is to lead the World Wide Web to its full potential by developing protocols
and guidelines that ensure the long-term growth of the Web. W3C is directed by Tim Berners-Lee,
inventor of the World Wide Web.

Figure 2.25: Zigbee logo

The Zigbee Alliance (www.zigbee.org), established in 2002, is an open, non-profit association of


members coming from businesses, universities and government agencies. Its activities are focused
on developing and promoting standards for low-power and open global wireless networks focused on
monitoring, control and sensor applications, by also ensuring that quality Zigbee products are available
for product manufacturers and their customers through a certified programme.

Figure 2.26: ECMA logo

ECMA (European Computer Manufacturers’ Association; https://www.ecma-international.org/) was


founded in 1961 by major multinational computer hardware manufacturers present in Europe. Whilst
the brand name has been kept, nowadays ECMA’s membership has grown: it includes companies
and academies from around the world. ECMA specifically focuses on standardization topics such as
hardware, software, communications, consumer electronics, media, storage and environmental subjects.
ECMA actively contributes to the work of other SDOs, by submitting its own standards to ISO, IEC and
ETSI for approval and publication.

29
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

Figure 2.27: Bluetooth logo

The Bluetooth Special Interest Group (https://www.bluetooth.com/) was established in 1998 by five
founding companies. It currently has around 33,000 member companies. The Bluetooth SIG has
standardized and is currently maintaining and improving the widespread namesake technology for
connecting devices over a short–range wireless personal area network.

The third and last classification type relates to the SDO’s technical scope of activities (according to each
SDO’s status), which is fundamental when searching for a standard for implementation. However, it can
often be a complex task, considering the wide range of activities in which many entities are involved and
the rather intricate relations among SDOs across different topics.

EXAMPLE
Table 2.1 provides the typical technical scopes of activity of some of the main SDOs. Moreover, a non-
exhaustive overview of the Information and Communication Technology ecosystem, where International,
Regional and National SDOs, Professional Organizations, and Industrial Consortia collaborate through
liaisons and Global Initiatives, is represented in Figure 2.28.

ORGANIZATION TYPICAL TECHNICAL SCOPE OF ACTIVITY

ITU-T Interoperable telecom specifications including architecture, services, protocols, addressing/numbering


plans.

ISO ICT architecture (OSI model), services, protocols including application layer protocols.

IEC Electrotechnical standards, incl. connectors, electrical safety and tests.

ETSI Interoperable ICT specifications including architecture, services.

CEN ICT architecture (OSI model) services, protocols incl. application protocols.

CENELEC Electrotechnical standards, incl. connectors, electrical safety and tests, electromagnetic compatibility.

IEEE All LAN specifications: IEEE 802.xx, including cabled LANs, Token Ring and Bus, Wireless LANs
(WLAN), e.g. Wi-Fi.

IETF All Internet-related specifications, including protocols, generic applications, addressing rules (IP, URL,
etc.).

ECMA Media specifications, ICT specifications fed into ETSI, ISO/IEC, IEEE, etc.

Table 2.1: SDOs and technical scope

30
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Agreement
for
cooperation

Joint
technical
Co-work commitee
on specific
subjects

Agreement

Liaisons

Partners

Figure 2.28: An overview of the ICT Standardization ecosystem

31
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

2.4 THE STANDARDIZATION PROCESS AT A GLANCE

2.4.1 STANDARD–DEVELOPMENT PROCESS


Each SDO sets up its own specific internal organization and procedures to control the life cycle of standards
documents. Yet some common features can be noted among various SDOs’ procedures, which imply a
shared understanding of best practices. A more detailed description of these procedures is presented in
Chapter 3.
This chapter summarizes and describes the most basic steps of a generic standard life cycle management
procedure (Figure 2.29)

Define scope Elaborate new


Identify needs
and work plan or revised standards

INCEPTION CONCEPTION DRAFTING

OBSOLESCENCE APPROVAL

Obsolete superseded Official issue


standards or revised standards

OBSOLETE APPROVED

Figure 2.29: Standards life cycle

Step 1 consists of the "Inception phase", which is related to the identification of the need for a new
standard and the consequent initiation of the standardization work. New standardization work starts with
the submission of a proposal to the SDO. The procedure for submitting a new standardization activity
varies from one SDO to another and depends on the SDO’s nature and internal organization (as described
in Section 2.3).

32
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

EXAMPLE
For instance, in ITU-T, proposals for new standardization actions can only be submitted by ITU-T members,
who represent ITU member states or associated organizations such as industries and academia. Members
can address the request to the relevant Study Group (SG) (ITU-T, (c)), i.e. the internal ITU-T established
body responsible for technical activities in the relevant area.
In the case of ETSI, the initiative can be taken by a single ETSI member (administrative bodies, NSOs,
industries, research bodies and academia). Proposals can also come (ETSI, 2018 (b)) (ETSI, 2016)
from components of established ETSI Technical Bodies (TB7), Special Committees (SC8) and Industry
Specification Groups (ISG9) and, lastly, from government bodies such as the European Commission (EC)
or the European Free Trade Association (EFTA). Proposals compliant with the mandate of an already
established TB are first addressed to the relevant TB; other proposals with a broader impact, which
suggest a new TB or could change TB scope, have to be submitted to the ETSI Board10 or, if the proposal
involves ETSI Partnership Projects (EPP7), to the ETSI General Assembly10.
A further example worthy of note is the IETF, which relies on straightforward and non-bureaucratic internal
processes. The IETF has no formal membership: there is no application form or fee and participation is
reserved to individuals (legal entities, i.e. organizations of any kind, are not eligible as members), who can
simply register for and attend IETF meetings. An individual can submit a proposal for an IETF specification
by participating in the relevant IETF Working Group (WG ), either by joining and contributing to the WG
mailing list or by attending periodic WG meetings. As an alternative, an "Internet Draft" can be uploaded
directly to the online IETF "Internet Drafts Directory" to make it available to the community for informal
review and comments (IETF, (c)). To increase the effectiveness of the process, the IETF encourages
members to organize unofficial "side meetings" (IETF, 2012), where "groups of interested individuals hold
informal get-togethers to discuss and develop their ideas" (IETF, 2012), gather preliminary consensus and
develop more stable proposals.

After the inception phase, the proposal for a new standardization action needs to have some form of formal
approval from the involved SDO. Subsequently, the SDO needs to prepare a detailed plan for the actual
work to be done, while defining how it is to be carried out within its own organization, the time schedule,
the final target outcomes, and the allocation of relevant resources. This step (Step 2) is represented in
Figure 2.29 by the "Conception" block.
The actual implementation of the Conception step largely varies depending on the internal organization of
the involved SDO.

7 ETSI includes three different types of Technical Body (TB): Technical Committees (TC), which are semi-permanent entities in charge of standardization activities
relevant to a specific technology area; ETSI Projects (EP), which are similar to TCs, but are established on the basis of a market sector requirement rather than
on a basic technology; ETSI Partnership Projects (EPP), which ETSI establishes with other organizations to achieve a defined standardization goal.
8 A Special Committee (SC) is a semi-permanent entity organized around a number of standardization activities addressing a specific technology area or related
topic. Special Committees tend to handle coordination, requirement gathering, and very specific support activities rather than drafting standards and specifications.
9 An Industry Specification Group (ISG) is an association of industries that share ETSI membership or that have applied for membership; it corresponds to an
industry forum built under the auspices of ETSI.
10 The GA is the highest decision-making body in ETSI and is composed of the representatives of all ETSI members. The GA delegates day-to-day management
activities to the ETSI Board.
11 Working Groups are the primary mechanism for development of IETF specifications; they are created to address a specific problem or to produce one or more
specific deliverables and are organized in areas; to date, there are seven areas (application and real time, general, Internet, operation and management, routing,
security, transport) structured in more than 100 WGs.

33
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

EXAMPLE
For instance, in ITU-T, the involved SG may approve the proposed action by consensus among participants
and consequently associate it with an existing or new "study question" and assign the work to a specific
Working Party (WP12) within the same SG. The team working on a certain "question" is known as the
"rapporteur group", which is chaired by the relevant rapporteur. Considering the guidance from the SG,
the team determines what recommendation documents and plans are required. The team also does the
editing work.
In ETSI’s case, if the proposal can be managed at TB level, the relevant TB can approve it by consensus
and open a new dedicated Work Item (WI13) if at least 4 members commit to supporting the work. The
new WI is publicized via the ETSI Website. Members that disagree with the item can oppose its adoption
within a 30-day period. Otherwise, the WI is definitively adopted.

Once the new standard proposal has been accepted and the actual work is started, the relevant
standardization documents enter a "drafting" phase (refer to Figure 2.29). This phase implies a lot of
technical and editorial work that is carried out according to the specific body’s internal workflow rules.
Once the documents are considered mature and stable, they transit into an "approval" phase (see Figure
2.29) to be officially released. If the outcome of the approval process is negative, a document may transit
more than once between the two phases.

EXAMPLE
For instance, in ITU-T, each SG develops its own work plan that includes periodic meetings, where the
draft standards prepared by WPs are reviewed to track their development and assess their maturity
(ITU-T, (c)). Once a document is considered mature, the SG/WP gives its consent for it to move to
the "approval" phase. The approval procedure can follow one of two different paths (Fishman, 2012):
the Traditional Approval Process (TAP) for standards having policy or regulatory implications, and
the Alternative Approval Process (AAP) for all other standards. When AAP is chosen (ITU-T, (a)), the
"consented" document is published on the ITU-T website and ITU-T members may review and comment
on it. If only editorial comments are received within a four-week period, the document will be considered
approved. If members submit substantive comments, the document is sent back to the SG, which sets
up a "comment resolution process" to produce the definitive version of the document. TAP (Fishman,
2012) is a longer procedure (see the next chapter for descriptions) in which ITU-T member States play a
decisive role.
At ETSI, standards development is carried out within relevant TBs and ISGs, which operate under the
provisions of the ETSI directives (ETSI, 2018 (b)) and the guidance of the appointed Chairmen. The
evolution of draft standards is regularly revised and tracked against the originally established Work
Programme. Once a document is considered stable, it is submitted for approval from the relevant TB
or ISG. The following approval steps depend on the type of the standard. As a matter of fact, ETSI
may produce a range of different documents (ETSI, 2018 (c)) (ETSI, 2018 (b)), which may have different
content and impact, as far as standard-related documentation is concerned.

12 Each SG manages a set of "study questions" that correspond to various technical subjects within its area of responsibility. "Study questions" are assigned to WPs,
which include the experts who edit standards documents.
13 A WI consists of a specific standardization task; it normally results in a single standard, report or other document.

34
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

ETSI Standards (ES)15 are approved by all ETSI members by means of the "Membership Approval
Procedure". Following committee approval, the document is sent to the ETSI Secretariat, which distributes
the document to ETSI members, who can approve or reject the document. European Standards (EN)14
follow a more complex approval procedure that requires a "public enquiry", followed by a weighted vote
reserved for national delegations. Technical Specifications (TS) and ETSI Group Specifications (GS)15 are
approved at committee level. After approval, TSs/GSs are issued to the ETSI Secretariat that will publish
the standard.
At the IETF, document drafting is usually performed within WGs, with the strong involvement of WG
chairs. WG chairs steer the drafting activities, moderate WG discussions, identify when the WG has
reached enough consensus on a specific topic in order for editors to proceed by consolidating it in the
draft (published in the online Internet draft directory), selecting meaningful contributions and discarding
inappropriate content. Once the draft has reached a good maturity level, the WG recommends its Area
Directors (Ads)16 to proceed to approve it as a standard (IETF, 2013). The request is submitted to the IESG,
which will notify the IETF community of the pending IESG consideration of the document to permit a final
review by the whole community for a limited period of time. The notification is referred to as "Last-Call
notification". It is sent by e-mail to the IETF Announce mailing list. Anyone can submit comments. After
the received comments have been revised, the IESG makes its final determination of whether or not to
approve the draft, and notifies the IETF community of its decision via an e-mail sent to the IETF Announce
mailing list. If the draft is approved, the document is published in the RFC (Request For Comments17)
directory and deleted from the Internet draft directory.

Once published, a standard is still to be considered a "living" document subject to maintenance and
updating, which may be just editorial or even substantive. While editorial maintenance is usually managed
as a routine activity within the working group that produced the standard, the introduction of major
modifications that impact the content of the document requires the same steps to be followed as for the
production of a brand new standard.
The final phase of a standard’s life cycle corresponds to its withdrawal due to obsolescence. A standard
withdrawal procedure is triggered following the assessment that new standards already developed or
being developed are replacing one or more established standards. Once withdrawn, a standard is usually
still retrievable in the SDO’s repository, in order to keep track of normative evolution, although the standard
itself is flagged as "no longer in force".

14 The formal output for standardization at the European level; it is intended to meet needs specific to Europe and requires transposition into national standards, or
it is produced under a mandate from EC or EFTA
15 ETSI Standard (ES), and ETSI Technical Specifications (TS) contain normative provisions on specific subjects; the difference between ESs and TSs lies in different
approval rules; TS, which has a faster approval path, is preferred when there is a need to reduce the time to market (i.e., when the standard is considered urgent).
ETSI Group Specification (GS), which may include normative or explanatory material, or both, are produced by ETSI Industry Specification Groups (ISGs). ETSI
EN, ES, TS standards are produced by Technical Committees or ETSI Projects.
16 Each IETF Area is managed by one or two Area Directors.
17 This is the traditional term that refers to IETF standards.

35
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

2.4.2 MAIN CHARACTERISTICS OF A STANDARD


As already explained, standards define some specific characteristics for a specific item (which may be, for
instance, a material, a product, a procedure, a process or a service), in order to make such an item meet
certain well-defined objectives (which may relate, for instance, to performance or interoperability). We have
also seen that they do not aim to fully characterize the items they are dealing with, but just to accurately
define the minimum set of characteristics to ensure the defined objectives are met.
SDOs take specific measures to make their standards effectively fit the above-listed scopes and objectives,
which means ensuring that documents are clear, unambiguous and not unnecessarily over-prescriptive,
and that they only stress the essential requirements for the compliance of the item they are addressing.
In order to ensure that standards have the above-listed characteristics, SDOs define their own guidelines
and rules to steer the standards writing process.
Standards writing rules differ from one SDO to another. Yet, as a summary of the indications from various
SDOs (refer, as examples, to ISO (ISO, 2016) and ETSI (ETSI, 2013) directions), we can identify some
general characteristics that a well-written standard needs to have. In the following section, there is a brief
description of such characteristics; further and more detailed examples are provided in Section 2.5.3.
Standards must be written while taking the users and the document objectives into account. The user is
expected to have technical competence and expertise in the field the standard is related to. The document
content should strictly focus on the essential according to the objectives of the standard. The focus on
the defined objectives aims to prevent authors from indulging in adding details that, although they may
add clarity to the subject and provide additional information to readers, could also produce unnecessary
prescriptions.
As a result, standards usually contain little supporting general information about the subject they address
(it is usually limited to a short introduction) and, as a consequence, they turn out to be very complicated to
non-expert readers and have little instructional value (which they are not intended to have).
The objectives of the standard will be explicitly and clearly stated in the document. This statement provides
readers with a concise summary of the subject and the area of application of the standard. Objectives
will be put in the relevant context, by describing their rational and possible correlations with other related
standards.
Standards must be clear and unambiguous. This implies that documents need to have a well-defined
structure, to help readers retrieve relevant information. The language must be plain and sentences must
be meaningful and as short and concise as possible. Usage of lists, tables, pictures and specialized
notations (i.e. special formalisms to describe requirements) is strongly encouraged, as it adds clarity to the
requirements. Though specialized notations may be obscure to newcomers, they are expected to be clear
to target readers with the required expertise.

36
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Standards must clearly distinguish among mandatory parts (which actually define the mandatory
requirements for the relevant item to be considered compliant), simple guidelines (something the item is
expected to comply with, but which is not mandatory), permissible characteristics (alternative provisions
that the item may or may not comply with) and further limited additional parts included for information
purposes. This can be achieved in different ways; for instance, by using specific and codified vocabulary,
or by segregating content with different impacts in different document sections.
References to other standards have to be carefully organized, so that it is possible to distinguish normative
references (i.e., other documents that are directly referenced within normative provisions in the main body
of the standard) from informative references (that provide additional information for clarification purposes).
All requirements in a standard (be they requirements, recommendations or permitted characteristics) must
be non-redundant and consistent among themselves and with the requirements quoted in the other related
standards. Necessary and non-redundant mean that requirements must consist of the minimum set that
fully specifies the characteristics of the standardized item according to the objectives of the standard.
Consistency may sound like an obvious goal, yet guaranteeing consistency among a (possibly large) set of
different standards requires great competence and commitment from the authors. At the same time, when
the item to be standardized is complex and demands a large set of requirements, care has to be taken to
avoid even partial contradictions among these requirements.
Furthermore, requirements must all be testable, at least in principle. This does not mean that it has to
always be practically possible to design and perform tests to check the fulfilment of each requirement,
but that the description of requirements has to be properly worded, according to its scope, and provide
all information needed to implement (possible) relevant tests. This also implies that standards need to
accurately state the possible conditions (if any) that constitute prerequisites for the applicability of the
requirements, and the latter must specify the terms of compliance for the item with the required accuracy,
depending on the objectives.

EXAMPLE
For clarification, we can consider an example provided by ETSI (ETSI, 2013). Let us compare the
following alternative wording for a requirement: a) "When the equipment receives a SERVICE_REQUEST
message, it shall respond immediately with a SERVICE_ACK message"; b) "When the equipment
receives a SERVICE_REQUEST message, it shall respond with a SERVICE_ACK message within 30
ms". Requirement (a) is not testable, as it lacks necessary information ("immediately" is evidently an
inaccurate term). On the contrary, requirement (b) is testable, as it correctly and accurately describes the
test conditions ("receiving a SERVICE_REQUEST") and expected behaviour ("respond with a SERVICE_
ACK message within 30 ms").

37
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

2.5 USING STANDARDS


This section provides a basic overview of the various steps that an individual has to follow to identify and
use the standards that are relevant to a specific topic of interest.
These steps can be summarized as follows:
1) Select the relevant SDOs involved in the development of a standard related to the specific item;
2) Identify SDO documents relevant to the item;
3) Understand the selected documents’ structure and formalisms.
The following sections expand upon and explain these steps.

2.5.1 SELECTING RELEVANT SDOS


As already analysed in Section 2.3, the standardization world is rather crowded and includes various types
of organizations that may compete or, ideally, collaborate to produce standard reference documents for a
broad set of subjects.
SDOs generally produce high-quality technical material that can provide valuable input. In practice, when
trying to simplify the search for standard references to define the characteristics of a certain feature, it is
worth prioritizing and focusing on the most relevant subset of SDOs and selecting them on the basis of the
classification criteria provided in Section 2.3:
a) Technical scope;
b) Geographical scope;
c) Type of affiliation.

TECHNICAL SCOPE
As described in Section 2.3, each SDO has its own particular technical scope, which derives from its official
statute, in other words from the common objectives that the members pursue when they participate in
making standards. The SDO’s technical scope constitutes the main criterion for the identification of standard
reference for a certain item. For instance, if an item is related to telecommunication technology, then ITU-T,
ETSI, IEEE and the IETF (see Section 2.3) represent, each for specific aspects, potential references. On the
other hand, if the item is related to energy technology, then references may be IEC, CENELEC, and IEEE.

GEOGRAPHICAL SCOPE
Whereas SDOs themselves do not constrain the geographical scope of their specifications, we have seen
in Section 2.3 how each SDO, due to its membership and statute, may be classified according to its
geographical area of influence as international, regional or national. When a new item is to be developed,
and standard reference is needed, relevant SDOs are those whose geographical scope encompasses the
geographical market at which the item is targeted.

TYPE OF AFFILIATION
As already explained in Section 2.1.3, there is no hierarchy among SDOs, and compliance with standards
is on a voluntary basis. Section 2.2.1 also explains how standards can sometimes be translated into (or
constitute the basis to develop) binding regulations. Therefore, SDOs that have country representatives as
members should be given special consideration, as policymakers can steer the action of these SDOs and
exploit them as a privileged source of regulatory provisions18.

18 As an example, refer to Section 2.4.1 for the description of how ITU and ETSI deal with the development of standards that have regulatory implications.

38
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

The above-described criteria for the selection of SDOs that are relevant to a certain item is only a
simplification. The selection process is actually more complicated and dynamic. In some cases, there
may be overlaps among various SDOs, especially with respect to technical scope, because of historical
reasons. Sometimes SDOs that share the same technological area can independently develop different
(and not necessarily fully aligned) specifications for the same subject. Furthermore, there may be borderline
items that may fall into more than one technological area covered by more than one SDO. For instance,
IEC and CENELEC standardize telecommunication protocols that are applicable to the control of energy
systems, and as such, they partially overlap with the traditional standardization areas of other SDOs. In
addition, an SDO’s technical scope changes over time, as it can be enlarged to include new technologies.
This sort of competition among SDOs may also produce temporary standard misalignments. Still, SDOs
actively cooperate to fix existing and prevent new divergences by setting up common study groups and
collaboration instruments, such as liaisons or common standard initiatives (see Section 2.3), and by
providing one another with mutual contributions.
Because of the complexity of the standardization institution landscape, SDO activities and relationships
need to be continuously monitored to keep the whole picture up to date.

EXAMPLE
For some of the SDOs already introduced in Section 2.3, the following Table 2.2 summarizes the main
classification criteria and their main existing contributions to other SDOs.

AFFILIATE OTHER SDOS IT


GEOGRAPHICAL DOMAIN OF
ORGANIZATION HEADQUARTERS ORGANIZATIONS / CONTRIBUTES
SCOPE ACTIVITY
MEMBERS TO

National SDO /
ITU Geneva (CH) International Telecoms /ICT Industries / Academia / ISO
Government bodies

ISO Geneva (CH) International ICT National SDO ITU

IEC Geneva (CH) International Electrotechnical National SDO ITU

National SDO /
International
Industries / Research
ETSI Sophia Ant (FR) (European regional Telecoms/ICT ITU
Institutes / Government
recognition)
bodies

CEN Brussels (BE) Regional (Europe) ICT National SDO ISO

CENELEC Brussels (BE) Regional (Europe) Electrotechnical National SDO IEC

IEEE New York (US) International ICT

ELECTROTECHNICAL Professionals ISO

IETF Fremont (US) International ICT Professionals ITU and ISO

ECMA Geneva (CH) International ICT Industrial Companies ISO

Table 2.2: SDO classification example

39
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

2.5.2 IDENTIFYING SDO DOCUMENTS


Once the relevant SDOs for a specific item have been identified, the next step is the selection of relevant
documentation. SDOs produce whole sets of standards, which may include various types of informative
documents besides the true formal standards that are available via their websites. Depending on the SDO’s
specific policy, access to standards may be free or subject to some restrictions. For instance, ITU-T, ETSI
and the IETF guarantee free access to published standards, while IEEE or ISO require the payment of a
fee. ITU-T and ETSI limit access to draft standards to selected and accredited personnel of their members,
while the IETF ensures free access to draft documents.
SDO websites usually provide search tools to allow users to navigate through all of their filed documents,
which may belong to different categories, such as, for instance, technology roadmaps, product/service
requirements, product/service technical specifications, regulations produced on behalf of regulatory bodies
and product/service test specifications. SDOs usually assign a different document code to each category,
so that it is possible to identify the topic covered by the documents just from their codes.

EXAMPLE
Table 2.3 includes a few examples of the different documentation produced by some major SDOs, such
as ITU-T (ITU-T, 2006), ETSI (ETSI, 2018 (a)) and the IETF (IETF, (b)).

ITU-T ETSI IETF

Publications from ITU’s ETSI produces a range of publications, The IETF’s official documents are named
Telecommunication standardization each with its own particular purpose, RFCs. "RFC" stands for Request for
sector (ITU-T) are coded with format which is encoded in the first two letters of Comments, and this name expresses
X.nnn, where X describes the document the document’s code; e.g.: the IETF’s approach to standardization:
domain, e.g.: EN – the document is intended to "the Internet is a constantly changing
A – Organization of the work of ITU T meet needs specific to Europe and technical system, and any document that
B – Means of expression: definitions, requires transposition into national we write today may need to be updated
symbols, classification standards, or the document is required tomorrow".
C – General telecommunication statistics under a mandate from the European The IETF does not code documents’
D – General tariff principles Commission (EC)/European Free Trade scope and objectives in their RFC
E – Overall network operation, telephone Association (EFTA). identifier system, which is simply a
service, service operation and human ES and TS – the document contains progressive number.
factors technical requirements (the difference
F – Non-telephone telecommunication between ESs and TSs lies in different
services approval rules)
G – Transmission systems and media, EG – identifies guidance to ETSI in
digital systems and networks general on the handling of specific
technical standardization activities
TR – the document contains explanatory
material

Table 2.3: Examples of standards classifications

Because of the complexity and extent of SDO activity, retrieving the right documentation by navigating
SDO sites, even when they support users with search engines (which, for instance, allow documents to be
searched for based on a subject or keywords), is not an easy task. As such, when it comes to collecting
documentation, it is necessary to continuously monitor SDO activities, in order to stay up to date about the
evolution of their document base.

40
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

2.5.3 UNDERSTANDING THE DOCUMENTS’ STRUCTURE AND FORMALISM


In Section 2.4.2, we introduced the main characteristics of a standard and highlighted how SDOs ensure
that their documentation is as clear as possible, in order to avoid any reader misunderstanding. In this
section, we provide some hints about how readers need to approach standards. In the following, we deal
in particular with ITU-T, ETSI and IETF document writing rules.
A first basic element that a standard must include consists of a clear statement of its objectives and area
of application. This statement is usually put in the introductory part of the document.

EXAMPLE
Different SDOs implement the introductory part in slightly different ways.
ITU-T (ITU-T, 2016) instructs authors to include, at the beginning of the document, some introductory
material that needs to include a mandatory summary paragraph. The summary must be included "before
the main body of the recommendation" to "provide a brief overview of the purpose and contents […],
thus permitting readers to judge its usefulness for their work". The summary may be optionally integrated
into the following introduction section, which is used to "provide information that the author deems
appropriate and that is not already provided in the Summary". The summary and introduction sections are
not numbered. The first numbered section of the recommendation (i.e., in ITU-T terms, the first "clause")
is the so-called scope, which specifically aims "to define, without ambiguity, its intent or object and the
aspects covered, thereby indicating the limits of its applicability".
Similarly, ETSI (ETSI, 2015) includes an unnumbered foreword paragraph at the top of its standards.
It is intended to be a "required, informative element" that provides information about, for instance, the
technical body that prepared the deliverable, the approval process the document followed, possible
relations between the deliverable and other ETSI standards and, where applicable, the main changes
the current version of the deliverable is introducing with respect to the previous version. The foreword
section may be optionally followed by executive summary and introduction sections, which summarize
the contents of the document and give information about the "reasons prompting its preparation". The
foreword, executive summary and introduction sections are not numbered. The first numbered item of
the document is the scope, which "defines without ambiguity the subject of the ETSI deliverable and the
aspect(s) covered, thereby indicating the limits of applicability of the ETSI deliverable or particular parts
of it".
It is worth noting that in both ITU-T and ETSI documents, information about scope and applicability can
be derived, as explained in Section 2.5.2, from the document code on the first page.
IETF documents (IETF, 2014) must include an abstract section "that provides a concise and
comprehensive overview of the purpose and contents of the entire document". The abstract is followed
by the introduction section, which is considered the first section of the document body. The introduction
"explains the motivation for the RFC and, if appropriate describes the applicability of the document,
e.g., whether it specifies a protocol, provides a discussion of some problem, is simply of interest to the
Internet community". In RFCs, the use of the title "Introduction" to name such a section is recommended,
but "authors may choose alternative titles, such as overview or background". The IETF also includes a
specific "Status of this memo" section in the introductory part of its documents, which clarifies many
basic characteristics of the documents, namely the document category19 and what review process the
document was subject to.

19 The category can clarify if the document is, for instance, an "Internet Standard" or defines "Best Current Practices" or has an "Informational" purpose only.

41
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

Further fundamental information that a standard needs to include is a list of other reference documentation
the standard is related to. Most often, standards include references to other documentation produced by
the same SDO or by others. This documentation either provides informative material, such as supplemental
information to assist the understanding of the documents, or references documents that provide normative
provisions, which are mandatory to claim compliance with the standard.

EXAMPLE
In ITU-T (ITU-T, 2016) recommendations, normative references are listed in the References section,
included as the second clause of the recommendation (just after the scope clause). Informative references
are, instead, collected in a bibliography section arranged at the end of the recommendation.
Similarly, ETSI deliverables (ETSI, 2015) list references in their second clause (again, after the scope
clause); the reference clause is split into two sub-clauses that respectively include normative (clause 2.1)
and informative (clause 2.2) references.
In IETF RFCs (IETF, 2014), references are grouped in the specific references section, which "must indicate
whether each reference is normative or informative". Note that an IETF RFC not only lists other documents
that possibly provide references but also explicitly quotes, just at the top of the document, the list of other
RFCs that the document makes obsolete.

SDOs also need to take provisions to ensure that requirements are clear and unambiguous. Such provisions
include, for instance, strictly discriminating, within a standard, normative sections from simply informative
ones, as well as using codified vocabulary and specific formalisms to clearly express requirements and
to highlight, within a normative section, what is actually a requirement, a recommendation (desirable, but
not compulsory), a permissible characteristic (alternative provisions that may or may not be met) or parts
included for information purposes.

EXAMPLE
The structures of ITU-T, ETSI and IETF documents are designed to take account of the above provisions
and ensure a clear separation between the document body, including the normative part, and the scope
statement, list of reference documents, and any annexes which may be normative or informative. One of
these provisions that aims to make the requirements clear is to include the definitions of the concepts and
terms to be used in the standard, after the description in the introductory part.
For instance, ITU-T (ITU-T, 2016) specifies that all standards need to include a definition section, to
appear as the third clause of the body of the document and giving "the definitions necessary for the
understanding of certain terms used in the recommendation". ITU-T also specifies that the fourth clause
of each document needs to list "in alphabetical order all the abbreviations and acronyms from throughout
the recommendation". Furthermore, clause 5 of ITU-T documents is reserved for defining or referencing
special notations used throughout the recommendation.
Similarly, ETSI (ETSI, 2015) specifies that definitions, symbols, and abbreviations must be listed in the
third clause of the body of its recommendations; the clause is split into three sub-clauses (numbered 3.1,
3.2 and 3.3), each devoted to one of the three item types.

42
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

As an additional provision to differentiate between normative and informative text, some SDOs define
different aims for the different sections of their documents, and specify whether they can contain normative
requirements or just informative parts and other content.

EXAMPLE
As an example, ITU-T (ITU-T, 2016) clarifies that the introductory part of its recommendations—the part
that comes before the scope section as explained above—does not include normative requirements.
Mandatory requirements are contained in the main body of recommendations, from clause 6 onwards. In
ITU-T recommendations, any annexes, which may expand some matters and are referred to within the
main body, are considered to "form an integral part of the recommendation" and therefore may include
normative requirements.
In the same manner as ITU-T, in ETSI deliverables (ETSI, 2015), the actual text of the standard starts
from clause 4, while preceding parts do not contain normative requirements. Any annexes may or may
not include requirements. The content of an annex is clearly stated by adding an indication close to its
heading, which identifies it as normative or informative.
Unlike ITU-T and ETSI, the IETF does not provide strict guidance on how to structure RFCs to include
parts that explain definitions and acronyms (even if it is a common practice) and segregate normative and
informative contents of a document. With respect to acronyms, the IETF (IETF, 2014) just recommends
the "expansion of abbreviations on first occurrence".

As a further provision to clarify the text of requirements and discriminate normative from informative parts,
as well as to distinguish different requirement types (for instance, mandatory or desirable), SDOs take
particular care in defining some specific wording conventions, which may differ from one SDO to another.

EXAMPLE
For instance, ITU-T (ITU-T, 2016) strictly rules "the use of the words 'shall' and 'must' and their negatives
'shall not' and 'must not'", which are verbs reserved "to express mandatory provisions", "i.e., if certain
values and/or parts of a recommendation are essential and the recommendation will have no meaning if
these values and/or parts are not strictly respected or adhered to".
Similarly, but even more accurately, ETSI (ETSI, 2015) defines the actual intended meaning of various
verbal forms. ETSI specifies that "shall" and "shall not" are used "to indicate requirements strictly to be
followed in order to conform to the standard"; usage of verbs "must" and "must not" is, on the contrary,
not allowed. Verbal forms "should" and "should not" are used to indicate "that among several possibilities
one is recommended as particularly suitable, without mentioning or excluding others, or that a certain
course of action is preferred but not necessarily required, or that (in the negative form) a certain possibility
or course of action is deprecated but not prohibited". Moreover, verbal forms "may" and "need not" are
used to indicate permitted behaviours or values; "can" and "cannot" "are used for statements of possibility
and capability, whether material, physical or causal"; "will" and "will not" are "used to indicate behaviour
of equipment or sub-systems outside the scope of the deliverable in which they appear"20. Finally, verbal
forms "is" and "is not" have to be used only "to indicate statements of fact".

20 "For example, in a deliverable specifying the requirements of terminal equipment, these forms shall be used to describe the expected behaviour of the network or
network simulator to which the terminal is connected." (ETSI, 2015)

43
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

Also, the IETF defines strict terminology to express different levels of requirement (IETF, 2014) (IETF, 1997).
In RFCs, some capitalized words may be used for this purpose. "MUST", or the terms "REQUIRED" or
"SHALL", mean that the definition is an absolute requirement of the specification. "MUST NOT", or the
term "SHALL NOT", mean that the definition is an absolute prohibition of the specification. "SHOULD",
or the adjective "RECOMMENDED", mean that "there may exist valid reasons in particular circumstances
to ignore a particular item, but the full implications must be understood and carefully weighed before
choosing a different course". "SHOULD NOT", or the term "NOT RECOMMENDED", mean that "there
may exist valid reasons in particular circumstances when the particular behaviour is acceptable or even
useful, but the full implications should be understood and the case carefully weighed before implementing
any behaviour described with this label". Finally, "MAY", or the adjective "OPTIONAL", mean that "an item
is truly optional", in other words that "one vendor may choose to include the item because a particular
marketplace requires it or because the vendor feels that it enhances the product, while another vendor
may omit the same item".

Besides strict document wording rules, SDOs may use suitable formalisms to better clarify requirements.
Such formalisms may take the form of simple tables, graphical descriptions such as block diagrams or, in
some cases, actual formal languages.
All of these provisions are usually allowed (or even encouraged, in some cases), provided that the chosen
formalism, such as block diagrams or formal language syntax, is extensively and unambiguously described
within the standard or in further documentation that the standard refers to (i.e. that is appropriately included
in the list of "normative" or "informative references").

EXAMPLE
Different SDOs may also have different approaches when considering the usage of formal languages to
express standard requirements.
For instance, IETF IESG (IETF, 2001) acknowledges that formal languages are useful tools and does not
prohibit their usage. However, it recommends that standard developers continue using English, with
formal languages left as a supporting mechanism.
On the contrary, ITU-T (ITU-T, (b)) and ETSI (ETSI, 2018 (d)) promote the extensive usage of formal
languages in standards "in order to produce precise and unambiguous formal specifications, which are
essential to the quality of the recommendations and their implementations".

44
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

2.6 SUMMARY
This chapter introduced some basic concepts and definitions about standards, which the following parts
of the book will deal with in greater detail.
Firstly, a very intuitive and practical definition of "standards" has been provided, together with some
examples of how standards are widely applied by industries. Then, the chapter gave an overview of the
aims of Standards Development Organizations (SDOs), the positive economic and societal impacts their
job has, as well as the possible risks and drawbacks an ill-conceived standards development process
might bring. This was followed by examples of major SDOs, mainly active in the ICT area and, lastly, a
basic description of the characteristics and structure of processes and deliverables for a generic SDO was
provided.
Key messages which should be retained from this chapter include:
■■ In the technology field, standardization to some extent is required to make things developed by
different makers interwork
■■ Standards may arise either simply because a certain technology asserts itself on the market, so as to
become a natural choice for many manufacturers (de facto standard), or because they are developed
by organizations that are built for that purpose (formal standards developed by SDOs)
■■ The main characteristics of SDOs: they work by building consensus among participants; they follow
self-imposed formal standards development procedures to guarantee consensus building and quality
deliverables.
■■ SDO standardization effort benefits innovation, trade and environment; yet there are risks of
disadvantages, which SDOs need to manage.
■■ The standardization landscape is crowded. There are many SDOs, with no hierarchical relationship,
whose activities may overlap; however, SDOs work to set up liaisons or common standardization
initiatives. SDOs may be roughly classified by geographical coverage, by type of affiliates and by
technical scope of activities.
■■ Each SDO sets its own specific internal processes to develop standards; nevertheless, different SDO
processes have common features that allow a generic standard document life cycle to be drawn up.
■■ SDO deliverables have some specific characteristics: they are specialized documents, intended for
expert people; they must be clear and unambiguous and include only necessary, non-redundant and
consistent requirements. SDOs ensure these characteristics are achieved through strictly defined
document structure and drafting rules.

45
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

2.7 QUIZ

1 - WHICH OF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS APPLY TO A "DE FACTO" STANDARD?


(See Section 2.1 for hints)
a) it usually has very little impact, as it is recognized only within a restricted community of users;
b) it is based on a winning technologic solution, which is widely and independently adopted by
different producers/providers within a market segment and products developed on such basis
are widely accepted by users/customers;
c) it has been agreed through a formal process by members of an established organization.

2 - WHICH OF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS APPLY TO A "FORMAL" STANDARD?


(See Section 2.1 for hints)
a) it has been developed through a fair process and by consensus by members of an established
organization;
b) it establishes mandatory characteristics of a product to be put on the market;
c) t strictly and fully rules the design of an item.

3 - WHAT IS THE DIFFERENCE BETWEEN "REGULATIONS" AND "STANDARDS"?


(See Section 2.1 for hints)
a) none, as standards "regulate" the characteristics of products;
b) regulations define a set of characteristics an item needs to have to access a regulated market,
while compliance with standards is on voluntary basis;
c) standards only provide a set of best practices to design/develop a specific item and cannot
cover critical issues (such as safety or security) that are governed by regulatory bodies.

4 - HOW ARE REGULATIONS AND STANDARDS RELATED?


(See Section 2.1 for hints)
a) standards and regulations are the same thing;
b) standards are sometimes turned into regulations;
c) standards are often referenced by regulations.

5 - WHAT DO STANDARDS PROVIDE TO PRODUCT DEVELOPERS/DESIGNERS?


(See Section 2.1 for hints)
a) a thorough set of design rules they are forced to comply with;
b) references for a high-quality design;
c) a minimum set of requirements in order to make the product meet certain well-defined
objectives.

6 - HOW DO STANDARDS BENEFIT INNOVATION?


(See Section 2.2 for hints)
a) by defining the products’ characteristics related to the most critical aspects, so as to reduce
design risks and time;
b) by inspiring designers with innovative ideas;
c) by constraining designers’ choices, so as to speed up the design phase.

46
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

7 - HOW DO STANDARDS BENEFIT THE ENVIRONMENT?


(See Section 2.2 for hints)
a) by enforcing mandatory safety and sustainability characteristics for marketable products;
b) by defining widely shared safety and sustainability requirements for products, often publicized to
customers through proper product labelling;
c) by forcing designers to follow detailed design rules that ensure products meet determined safety
and sustainability requirements.

8 - HOW DO STANDARDS BENEFIT THE ECONOMY?


(See Section 2.2 for hints)
a) by restricting market access to only standard-compliant, high-quality products;
b) by enabling economies of scale, encouraging wider and fairer competition and facilitating trade
thanks to the definition of widely shared practices;
c) by freezing technological evolution, so as to allow producers and customers to get the best
return from their past investments in established products.

9 - HOW DO STANDARDS BENEFIT INDUSTRIES?


(See Section 2.2 for hints)
a) by facilitating the development of new technologies, by ensuring fair competition among
industries and by enlarging products’ market penetration opportunities;
b) by ruling market access of new products, as they define a mandatory minimum set of
requirements that new products must comply with;
c) by pacing the technological evolution, so as to consolidate market positions of established
industries.

10 - HOW DO STANDARDS BENEFIT SOCIETY AND INDIVIDUALS?


(See Section 2.2 for hints)
a) by ruling the market introduction of innovative products, so as to guarantee safety and
environmental sustainability;
b) by establishing a minimum level of performances for any new product entering the market;
c) by promoting innovation, a safer environment and a more competitive market.

11 - COMPLETE THE TABLE BELOW BY DEFINING THE CHARACTERISTICS OF THE LISTED


SDOS ACCORDING TO THE CLASSIFICATION CRITERIA DEFINED IN THE FIRST ROW:
(See Section 2.3 for hints)

SDO GEOGRAPHICAL COVERAGE TYPE OF AFFILIATES MAIN TECHNICAL SCOPE

ISO

ITU

ETSI

3GPP

IETF

ECMA

47
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

12 - LIST THE MAIN PHASES OF THE GENERIC STANDARD LIFE CYCLE AND SUMMARIZE
WHAT THEY ARE FOR:
(See Section 2.3 for hints)

PHASE WHAT IT IS FOR (SCOPE, MAIN ACTIVITIES INCLUDED IN


PHASE NAME
NUMBER THE PHASE)

13 - IDENTIFY THE TWO CHARACTERISTICS, FROM THOSE LISTED BELOW, THAT DO NOT
DESCRIBE A NORMATIVE REQUIREMENT PART OF A STANDARD:
(See Section 2.4 for hints)
a) clear, concise and unambiguous;
b) widely explained by means of extended examples;
c) expressed by means of specialized notations;
d) defined by means of references to other standards;
e) well justified by means of an extended technical dissertation;
f) testable: the description has to be worded so as to provide all needed information to implement
(possible) relevant tests.

14 - DESCRIBE THE TYPICAL CONTENT OF THE VARIOUS SECTIONS OF A GENERIC


STANDARD LISTED BELOW:
(See Section 2.3 and 2.5 for hints)

SECTION CONTENT

SCOPE / ABSTRACT

REFERENCES

DEFINITIONS

BODY OF THE DOCUMENT

ANNEXES

➜➜ SOLUTIONS PAGE 242

48
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

2.8 GLOSSARY
■■ De facto standard: A de facto standard, also known as standard "in actuality", arises when an
established solution, not developed through a standardization process put in place by an SDO, is
widely and independently adopted by different industries within a market segment and products
developed on such basis are widely accepted by customers.
■■ International SDO: An SDO that has members worldwide, including representatives of National or
Regional standard bodies, and their deliverables have worldwide coverage.
■■ Formal standard: A standard developed by an SDO.
■■ Industrial forum: An organization established by industries that coordinate their efforts on specific
subjects to accelerate, complement or promote the development of a standard.
■■ National SDO: An SDO that issues country-specific standards and collaborates with International
and Regional SDOs.
■■ Professional organization: An organization that brings together independent professionals to promote
best practices and innovation in specific areas, and that may act as an SDO.
■■ Regional SDO: An SDO that has members (industries, academia and national SDOs) from a set of
countries that usually share, or are interested in promoting, common practices and regulations.
■■ Standard: In general, a widely agreed way of doing something. More specifically, in the technological/
industrial environment, a model or norm to which a certain item is aligned; a set of prescriptions,
specifications, guidelines or characteristics for a determined material, product, service, process or
procedure.
■■ Standards Development Organization (SDO): An organization devoted to developing standards and
that puts in place well-defined procedures to guarantee a fair development process, which is aimed
at building consensus among involved contributors and ensuring the quality of the final deliverables.
■■ Standard initiative: An organization that multiple SDOs put in place to coordinate standardization
efforts on particular subjects.

49
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

2.9 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS


■■ 3GPP: 3rd Generation Partnership Project ■■ HTML: HyperText Markup Language
■■ AAP: Alternative Approval Process ■■ IEEE: Institute of Electrical and Electronics
■■ AD: Area Director Engineers
■■ ANSI: American National Standards Institute ■■ IETF: Internet Engineering Task Force
■■ ARSO: African Organization for ■■ IP: Internet Protocol
Standardization ■■ Psec: IP security
■■ BGP: Border Gateway Protocol ■■ HDMI: High Definition Multimedia Interface
■■ CEN: Comité européen de normalisation— ■■ ICT: Information and Communication
European Committee for Standardization Technology
■■ CENELEC: Comité européen de ■■ LTE: Long Term Evolution
normalisation en électrotechnique— ■■ M2M: Machine to Machine
European Committee for Electrotechnical
■■ NSDO: National Standards Development
Standardization
Organization
■■ CERN: Centre Européen pour la Recherche
■■ OSPF: Open Shortest Path First
Nucléaire—European Organization for
■■ PASC: Pacific Area Standards Congress
Nuclear Research
■■ PDF: Portable Document Format
■■ DVD: Digital Versatile Disk
■■ SDO: Standards Development Organization
■■ ECMA: European Computer Manufacturers’
Association ■■ TAP: Traditional Approval Process
■■ ETSI: European Telecommunications ■■ UMTS: Universal Mobile
Standards Institute Telecommunications System
■■ IEC: International Electrotechnical ■■ VESA: Video Electronics Standards
Commission Association
■■ INCITS: InterNational Committee for ■■ W3C: World Wide Web Consortium
Information Technology Standards ■■ WG: Working Group
■■ ISO: International Organization for ■■ WI: Work Item
Standardization ■■ XML: eXtensible Markup Language
■■ ITU: International Telecommunication Union
■■ JEDEC: Joint Electron Device Engineering
Council
■■ HD DVD: High Definition Digital Versatile
Disc

50
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

2.10 REFERENCES
✚✚ Biddle & al., 2010. How many standards in a Laptop? (and other empirical questions).
http://ssrn.com/abstract=1619440. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ CEN-CENELEC, 2018. Smart Grids.
https://www.cencenelec.eu/standards/Sectors/SustainableEnergy/SmartGrids/Pages/default.aspx.
Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ETSI, 2013. A Guide to Writing World Class Standards.
https://portal.etsi.org/LinkClick.aspx?fileticket=N_gN9ctXowg%3D&tabid=1408&portalid=0. Accessed
March 2018.
✚✚ ETSI, 2015. ETSI Drafting Rules (EDRs).
https://portal.etsi.org/Services/editHelp!/Howtostart/ETSIDraftingRules.aspx. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ETSI, 2016. Standards making process.
https://portal.etsi.org/Resources/StandardsMakingProcess/Process.aspx. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ETSI, 2018 (a). Different types of ETSI Standards.
http://www.etsi.org/standards/different-types-of-etsi-standards. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ETSI, 2018 (b). ETSI directives.
https://portal.etsi.org/Resources/ETSIDirectives.aspx. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ETSI, 2018 (c). How does ETSI make standards.
http://www.etsi.org/standards/how-does-etsi-make-standards. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ETSI, 2018 (d). Protocol Specification Languages.
http://www.etsi.org/technologies-clusters/technologies/protocol-specification. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ Fishman, G., 2012. Decision-Making and Approval Procedures: soft and hard decisions.
https://www.itu.int/en/ITU-T/tutorials/Documents/201210/Session-06-Rapporteur%20Tutorial%20
1208G-Decision_Making.pdf. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ IETF, (a). Birds of a Feather sessions (BoFs).
https://www.ietf.org/how/community-discussions/bofs/. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ IETF, (b). IETF Internet Standards web page.
https://www.ietf.org/standards/. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ IETF, (c). The Tao of IETF: a Novice’s Guide to the Internet Engineering Task Force.
https://www6.ietf.org/tao.html. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ IETF, 1997. RFC2119 - Key words for use in RFCs to Indicate Requirement Levels.
https://tools.ietf.org/pdf/rfc2119.pdf. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ IETF, 1998. RFC2418 - IETF Working Group Guidelines and Procedures.
https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc2418/?include_text=1. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ IETF, 2001. Guidelines for the Use of Formal Languages in IETF Specifications.
https://www.ietf.org/iesg/statement/pseudocode-guidelines.html. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ IETF, 2012. RFC 6771 - Considerations for Having a Successful "Bar BOF" Side Meeting.
https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc6771. Accessed March 2018.

51
CHAPTER 2 - Introduction to standards

✚✚ IETF, 2013. RFC 2026 - The Internet Standards Process - Revision 3.


https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc2026/?include_text=1. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ IETF, 2014. RFC 7322 - RFC Style Guide.
https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7322. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ IETF, 2018. IETF - Mission and Principle.
https://www.ietf.org/about/mission/. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ISO, 2016. How to write Standards.
https://www.iso.org/iso/how-to-write-standards.pdf. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ITU-T, (a). ITU Standards approval.
https://www.itu.int/en/ITU-T/about/Pages/approval.aspx. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ITU-T, (b). Formal descriptions and Object identifiers databases.
https://www.itu.int/ITU-T/formal-language/index.html. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ITU-T, (c). ITU Standards development.
https://www.itu.int/en/ITU-T/about/Pages/development.aspx. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ITU-T, 2006. ITU-T Recommendation web page.
https://www.itu.int/rec/T-REC/en. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ITU-T, 2012. Resolution 40 – Regulatory aspects of the work of the ITU Telecommunication Standardization
Sector.
https://www.itu.int/dms_pub/itu-t/opb/res/T-RES-T.40-2012-PDF-E.pdf. Accessed March 2018.
✚✚ ITU-T, 2016. Editing Guidelines.
https://www.itu.int/oth/T0A0F000004/en. Accessed March 2018.

52
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

3 THE STANDARDS ECOSYSTEM

In this chapter, readers are introduced to key concepts of standardization:


■ The types of standards development organizations (SDOs), and the standards they produce;
■ The three major geographical scopes of SDOs (international, regional and national), as well as the
mechanisms supporting their cooperation and coordination;
■ The reuse and reference of standards by other standards and official documents, including adoption
and transposition.
■ The main types of documents published by recognized SDOs;
■ The conventions used to name standards and the typical information contained in a standard’s
name;

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
■ Students should understand and apply the different criteria for establishing the classifications of
standardization documents and the organizations producing them, especially in the ICT arena.
■ Students should understand the differences among national, regional and international organizations,
as well as the necessary agreements among them aiming to improve the efficiency of standardization
efforts. In addition, students should understand that the coordination of standardization activities
among SDOs with different scopes has beneficial aspects from business and legal perspectives.
■ Students should know about how specifications from industrial consortia are transposed into
standards; also, students should understand that marketing organizations produce specifications
and suites with the objective of assessing and validating the conformance to a standard and
enabling interoperability between products. The notion of regulations and how they may refer to
standards is also relevant.
■ Students should become familiar with the naming conventions of different SDOs and be able to
extract and identify several characteristics of a document from its name, including the title, the SDO
that published/adopted the document, the type of standardization document, whether or not the
document belongs to a family of standards, whether it is a harmonized standard, the version of the
standard, as well as the date/year the document was published.
■ Students should become familiar with the differences between types of standardization documents
in terms of their scope and addressed stakeholders, whether they contain requirements (normative
documents) or simply provide information, as well as the process leading to their approval/publication.
Also, it is important to know about which organizations may produce which type of document, and
the definition/purpose of each type of document, which may differ across organizations.

As introduced in Chapter 2, the standardization landscape is rich and complex. Its very first definition of
"standard" was rather generic: "a widely agreed way of doing something". But then it clarified that, in our
context, proper standards are formal documents that are produced by organizations with expertise in the
field, which at the same time may be categorized according to their geographical scope, among other
characteristics. As described there, hundreds of standards, by dozens of organizations, are needed for a
Personal Computer to run.
The current chapter aims to provide some basic concepts to help readers find their way around the
standards ecosystem.

53
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

3.1 TYPES OF ORGANIZATIONS AND STANDARDIZATION


DOCUMENTS
This section provides readers with key concepts and examples of organizations and standardization
documents.

European
Domain Technical
Regional Co-ordination Scope
Approval Adoption
Publication Legislation Company Formal
Public Horizontal National Management
Regulation
Standard Test Industry
Directive

Organisation Agreement
Test
Report
Scope
Specification
International
Formal Harmonised Domain Consortium Guide
European Organisation
Vertical
Co-ordination Co-operation Stakeholders Directive Management

Figure 3.1: The complex ecosystem of standardization organizations and the documents they produce

3.1.1 RECOGNIZED SDOS


Some standards development organizations (SDOs) are officially recognized by regulation systems as
providers of standards. They are known as recognized SDOs. They publish standards when a specific
societal need is identified; sometimes the corresponding governmental authority invites them to address
a topic in the need of standardization. Recognized SDOs have robust and documented processes for
building consensus and approving standards. Some authors refer to these organizations as official SDOs.

EXAMPLE
Regulation (EU) No 1025/2012 of the European Parliament and of the Council designates CEN, CENELEC
and ETSI as the European Standards Organizations (ESOs).

Besides the officially recognized SDOs, there are well-respected and long-existing SDOs that are not
officially recognized by regulation systems, but have well-established procedures to ensure the quality of
their standards (e.g. W3C, OASIS, IEEE, OMG).

EXAMPLE
IEEE counts on a specific board (the IEEE-SA Standards Board) to coordinate the development and
revision of IEEE standards. This includes approving the initiation of standards projects and reviewing
them for consensus, due process, openness, and balance. IEEE 802 is just an example of an IEEE
family of standards with a significant impact on society. 802 standards deal with local area networks and
metropolitan area networks.

54
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

EXAMPLE
European standard EN 301 549 on ICT accessibility requirements, produced by the official European
Standards Organizations (ESO), makes explicit references to Web Content Accessibility Guidelines
(WCAG), published by W3C.

3.1.2 FORMAL STANDARDS


A formal standard is a document that has been approved by a standards development organization.
Sometimes, authors refer to formal standards simply as "standards".
Sometimes experts take formal standards into account when putting together regulation, since they provide
guidance on technical details and are the result of well-established and documented procedures. In some
situations, governments invite recognized standards organizations to produce standards in support of
specific policies or legislation. As an example of this policy, the European Commission invites the European
Standardization Organizations (ESOs) to produce formal standards through Standardization Requests.
About a fifth of all European standards are developed following a standardization request (a.k.a. mandate)
from the European Commission to the European Standardization Organizations (ESOs). The process can
be summarized as follows:
■■ Draft requests are drawn up by the Commission through a process of consultation with a wide group
of interested parties, including social partners, consumers, small- and medium-sized enterprises
(SMEs), industry associations and EU countries. Before being formally sent to the ESOs, they are
submitted to the Committee on Standards of the Regulation (EU) 1025/2012 for a vote. If the outcome
of this vote is positive, the Commission adopts the request as a Commission Implementing Decision.
■■ The European Standards Organizations (ESOs), which are independent organizations, have the right
to refuse a mandate if they do not think that standards can be produced in an area. Due to the
preceding consultation process, however, standardization requests are rarely refused.
■■ The standardization requests issued by the European Commission are available in a database of
mandates.
Furthermore, regulation may make explicit reference to a specific standard. In those cases, the referenced
standard is called a "de jure" standard. However, some authors use the term "de jure" standard to refer
generally to formal standards.
On some occasions, the only way to comply with regulation is by complying with the referenced standards.
Other times, compliance with the standard remains voluntary: the standard is just an officially accepted
way to comply with regulation, but there may exist alternative ways to do so. However, anyone choosing
the latter would be required by authorities to prove that the alternatives chosen fulfil the requirements in
the regulation.

55
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

EXAMPLE
In 2005, the European Commission sent a standardization request, called Mandate 376, to the ESOs
(CEN, CENELEC and ETSI). Mandate 376 was an instruction to assist with the harmonization of public
procurement practices in Europe by developing a standard that specifies the functional accessibility
requirements for publicly procured ICT products and services, so that they can be used by citizens with
and without disabilities.
The main output resulting from Mandate 376 was the standard EN 301 549 "Accessibility requirements
suitable for public procurement of ICT products and services in Europe", published in 2015. This standard
contains requirements that, when fulfilled, ensure that ICT products and services are accessible to people
with and without disabilities.
One year after the standard was published, the "Directive (EU) 2016/2102 of the European Parliament
and of the Council of 26 October 2016 on the accessibility of the websites and mobile applications of
public sector bodies" was approved. Article 4 of Directive (EU) 2016/2012 is entitled "Requirements for
the accessibility of websites and mobile applications" and reads:
"Member States shall ensure that public sector bodies take the necessary measures to make their websites
and mobile applications more accessible by making them perceivable, operable, understandable and
robust."
Furthermore, the Directive references standard EN 301 549 as follows:
■ "content of websites that fulfils the relevant requirements of European standard EN 301 549 V1.1.2
(2015-04) or parts thereof shall be presumed to be in conformity with the accessibility requirements
set out in Article 4 that are covered by those relevant requirements or by parts thereof."
Does the latter mean that ensuring compliance with EN 301 549 is the only way to be in conformity with
the accessibility requirements set out in Article 4? It probably does not. What it means is that the relevant
clauses of EN 301 549 should be considered as the minimum means of putting the requirements in
Article 4 of the Directive into practice (i.e. Perceivability, operability, understandability and robustness of
a website or of a mobile application). In effect, there might be alternatives to the standard that also allow
compliance with these principles. However, anyone using them should demonstrate their validity for this
purpose.

SDOs may produce different types of standardization documents, each with its own particular purpose, and
with a specific approval processes. This strategy is useful to address different societal needs. Sometimes,
documents are produced with the aim of becoming national or international standards. These documents
will require the highest level of excellence in terms of maturity and consensus. In other cases, certain
societal or industry topics may benefit from having a standardization document as a reference, even if that
topic has not reached the highest level of either maturity or consensus. In any case, an SDO may produce
a document that is useful for that particular purpose, by means of a shorter and more flexible way than the
one a higher level standard would demand.

56
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

3.1.3 DE FACTO STANDARDS


Let’s have a look at the following ICT-related items:
■■ PDF: a document format created by Adobe Systems.
■■ HTML: a language for describing the structure and content of Web pages. It was originally created
by Tim Berners-Lee and is currently published and maintained by W3C.
■■ Microsoft Windows: an operating system that became an industry standard, and so did its
specifications (e.g. the Microsoft Web Services Security specification, WS-Security).
What they all have in common is that they have had a huge impact on society, as they are used by millions
of users… They are called "de facto standards". They are common practices adopted by the market,
which are not the result of any standardization process.
According to Maxwell (2006), a de facto standard is a custom or convention that has achieved a dominant
position by public acceptance or market forces (for example, by early entry into the market), and that usually
has the attractive characteristic of having been validated by market processes. This effect was analysed
by Utterback and Abernathy, who introduced the "dominant design" concept in the mid-70s (Abernathy
and Utterback 1978). They identify key technological features that become a de facto standard. Dominant
designs may not be better than other designs; they simply incorporate a set of key features that sometimes
emerge due to technological path-dependence and not necessarily strict customer preferences. In Chapter
5, de facto standards are dealt with in the context of dominant designs and innovation.
De facto standards may be adopted as standards by recognized SDOs, like in the case of HTML (see
the example below) and PDF (ISO 32000-1:2008 Document management—Portable document format—
Part 1: PDF). Furthermore, de facto standards may considerably influence formal standards.

EXAMPLE
Tim Berners-Lee described HTML publicly for the first time in 1991. HTML is the language that enables
documents to be used and shared by users across the Internet. It was originally composed of 18 elements,
which web browsers interpret so that humans can interact with documents containing text, images, other
media, and links to other HTML documents.
Later on, the IETF published "HTML 2.0", the first time HTML was published as a standard. Since 1996,
the World Wide Web Consortium (W3C) has been in charge of maintaining the HTML specification. It was
in 2000 that a recognized SDO (ISO/IEC) published HTML as ISO/IEC15445:2000.

57
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

3.1.4 PUBLIC AND PRIVATE ORGANIZATIONS


Usually, public organizations are created by treaties. This is the case of ITU, an agency of the United Nations.
Hence, ITU is an example of an official, public organization. However, officially recognized organizations
are not necessarily public. In fact, most of them are private. For instance, ETSI is a private, not-for-profit
organization. Other examples of official organizations that are private are ISO, IEC, CEN, CENELEC, and
ANSI.
Some non-official standards organizations were created as industrial consortia to produce standards. For
instance, C2C-CC and W3C are industrial consortia created, respectively, by vehicle- and web-related
companies.

3.1.5 OPEN STANDARDS


Openness of standards is not a precise concept. It comprises a set of aspects regarding how standards
are written, approved, published, implemented and maintained. According to the Openstand initiative,
there are five principles involved (Dardailler and Jacobs 2012):
■■ Cooperation between standards organizations. Respectful cooperation between standards
organizations, whereby each respects the autonomy, integrity, processes, and intellectual property
rules of the others.
■■ Adherence to the following characteristics:
• Due process: Decisions are made with equity and fairness among participants. No one party
dominates or guides standards development. Standards processes are transparent and
opportunities exist to appeal decisions. Processes for periodic standards review and updating
are well defined.
• Broad consensus: Processes allow for all views to be considered and addressed, such that
agreement can be found across a range of interests.
• Transparency: Standards organizations provide advance public notice of proposed standards
development activities, the scope of work to be undertaken, and conditions for participation.
Easily accessible records of decisions and the materials used to reach those decisions are
provided. Public comment periods precede final standards approval and adoption.
• Balance: Standards activities are not exclusively dominated by any one person, company or
interest group.
• Openness: Standards processes are open to all interested and informed parties.
■■ Collective empowerment. Commitment by affirming standards organizations and their participants to
collective empowerment by striving for standards that:
• are chosen and defined based on technical merit, as judged by the contributed expertise of each
participant;
• provide global interoperability, scalability, stability and resiliency;
• enable global competition;
• serve as building blocks for further innovation; and
• contribute to the creation of global communities, benefiting humanity.

58
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

■■ Availability: Standards specifications are made accessible to all for implementation and deployment.
Affirming standards organizations have defined procedures to develop specifications that can be
implemented under fair terms. Given market diversity, fair terms may vary from royalty-free to Fair,
Reasonable, and Non-Discriminatory conditions (FRAND conditions).
■■ Voluntary adoption: Standards are voluntarily adopted, and it is the market that determines success.

How can we determine whether a standard or an SDO complies with the principles of open standardization?
What are the pros and cons of standardization openness? Let us consider some questions put forward in
Maxwell (2006) and Cerri and Fuggetta (2007).
■■ How open is the process of choosing to develop, and ultimately developing, the standard? Who
can participate and under what terms? Does the process ensure that all participants can affect the
standard? Is the process well documented? Who owns and manages the standard? Is there a single
party that has special rights to it?
• Pros of openness: Opening the effective participation in the standardization process to any
company or individual will minimize the possibility of the standard reflecting only the interests of
a limited set of stakeholders. Also, having representatives of civil society on board will contribute
to addressing consumer needs such as privacy, security or cost. Furthermore, this approach
will contribute to interoperability, allowing different services, applications and networks to
communicate with one another.
• Cons of openness: the higher the level of participation, the more difficult it is to reach consensus,
and therefore, the more likely it is that the standard will not be approved in time to address the
needs of a rapidly changing technological context.
■■ Is the standard publicly disclosed in its entirety? Is the document publicly available, either free of
charge or for a nominal fee? What terms and conditions govern its implementation? Does the
standard contain proprietary technology that must be licensed? Will royalties be charged and on
what basis will they be determined? Is it possible to extend and reuse the standard in other open
standards?
• Pros of openness:
-- As an example of the benefits of having publicly available, free-to-use standards, the growth
of the Internet would not have been as rapid without universal availability of TCP/IP protocols
or HTML.
-- The European Commission defines ICT lock-in (European Commission 2013) as the situation
where public authorities enter into contracts with providers of ICT in order to use an ICT product
or service for a certain period of time, and the public authority cannot easily change providers
once this period of time has expired because not every piece of essential information about
the system is available for efficient takeover by another provider. According to the results of a
survey by the European Commission (Galasso 2015), among the countermeasures to tackle
ICT lock-in, the most used is "to define ICT strategies and architectures on open source and
open standards".
• Cons of openness: It is indeed difficult to develop standards with no proprietary technology
involved, for instance in the case of existing technologies that have proven to solve a technological
issue. Hence, there is intense debate within SDOs about whether to include proprietary
technology, and how this should be done.

59
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

3.1.6 CLASSIFICATION OF ICT STANDARDIZATION DOCUMENTS


Standardization documents can be classified according to many approaches, such as the ICT aspect
addressed by the document, to name only one. Below is a list of categories and representative examples,
in agreement with de Vries (2006) and Hatto (2013).
Terminology standards. These documents compile structured vocabularies, terminologies, code sets
and classification systems that most ICT systems rely on, e.g.:
■■ ITU-T E.800 Definitions of terms related to the quality of service.
■■ ISO/IEC 17788:2014 Information technology – Cloud computing – Overview and vocabulary
Measurements or test methods. These documents define the objectives and guidelines for testing ICT.
They define roles, processes and techniques for testing and measuring. In addition, they provide guides for
test planning, implementation and reporting. Examples of such standards are:
■■ IEEE Std 299-2006 IEEE Standard Method for Measuring the Effectiveness of Electromagnetic
Shielding Enclosures
■■ ETSI ES 203 228 V1.0.0 (2015) Environmental Engineering (EE); Assessment of mobile network
energy efficiency
Specifications. These documents contain a detailed and formal description of a set of characteristics or
requirements that are relevant to a specific item. Examples of specifications are:
■■ ISO/IEC 10918-1:1994 Information technology—Digital compression and coding of continuous-tone
still images: Requirements and guidelines
■■ EN 55 024 European immunity requirements for information technology equipment
System architecture. Documents that support the formal description of ICT systems and their
components, characteristics and processes. For example:
■■ ISO/IEC/IEEE 42010:2011 Systems and software engineering—Architecture description.
Reference models. These documents inform the design of the architecture of ICT systems according to
a given model, for example:
■■ ISO/IEC 7498:1994 Preview. Information technology—Open Systems Interconnection,
■■ W3C Recommendation, 15 December 2004. The Architecture of the World Wide Web, Volume One.
Software and networking standards. There are documents about computer software, including
programming languages (e.g. C++ is published as ISO/IEC 14882), Application Programming Interfaces
(API) (e.g. ISO 17267 on API for navigation systems for intelligent transport systems), communication
protocols (e.g. Wi-Fi IEEE standards), file information and formats (e.g. RFC 8259 JSON).
Quality assurance. These documents provide requirements for managing the quality of projects or
systems, such as:
■■ IEEE 730-2014 – Software Quality Assurance Processes.
The above classification is not strict in the sense that one document may be allocated to more than one
category, for example:
■■ Requirements standards may include testing procedures to assess whether the requirements are
met,
■■ Documents where systems or reference models are described may include the vocabulary involved,
■■ Software standards may include requirements.

60
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Horizontal and vertical standards. Another broad classification of standards is related to whether
a standard is horizontal or vertical (de Vries 2006). Vertical standards apply to different aspects within
an industry sector or entity. Horizontal standards, however, address aspects that are applicable across
multiple industries or entities.

EXAMPLE
Example of vertical standards: Standards about social alarm systems and telecare, which are ICT-
mediated services aiming to provide safety and wellbeing to citizens, especially to the elderly and disabled.
The EN 50134 family of standards about social alarm systems, published by CENELEC, deal with different
aspects of social alarms, such as the vocabulary and terms, the technical requirements for their devices
(sensors, panic buttons, home units, etc.), their interconnections, etc.
Example of horizontal standards: Standards about electromagnetic compatibility (EM), the IEC
EN 61000 family of standards about EM addresses aspects that include terminology, descriptions
of electromagnetic phenomena and the EM environment, measurement and testing techniques, and
guidelines on installation and mitigation.

Given their nature, vertical standards normally reference horizontal standards. For instance, electromagnetic
compatibility (EM) standards apply to many different pieces of electrical equipment of all kinds, such as
mobile phones and social care alarm devices.

Smart-city Social
standards alarm
standards
Radio frequency
allocation
standards

Electromagnetic compatibility
standards

Figure 3.2: Illustration with examples of horizontal vs. vertical standards

61
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

3.2 NATIONAL, REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL


STANDARDIZATION: COOPERATION AND COORDINATION
This section introduces three major regional scopes of recognized SDOs (international, regional and national)
as well as the existing mechanisms that support coordination and cooperation within their standardization
activities and deliverables. Among these mechanisms, this section addresses the national and regional
adoption of standards published by SDOs with a wider scope.

3.2.1 NATIONAL, REGIONAL AND INTERNATIONAL SDOS AND STANDARDS


Recognized SDOs have a national, regional or international scope, as do the standards they produce:
■■ ISO, IEC and ITU are international standard organizations, with a worldwide scope.
■■ CEN, CENELEC and ETSI are officially recognized as European bodies for standardization, although
ETSI has an international membership base and produces globally applicable standards.
■■ PASC is a regional SDO in the Pacific area.
■■ DIN is the national SDO in Germany, UNE in Spain, ANSI in USA, and BIS in India.

National SDOs represent their own countries in organizations with a regional or international scope. At
the same time, regional SDOs may be represented in international SDOs. Article 2 of the EU Regulation
1025/2012 on European standardization provides the following definitions for formal standards in the EU:
■■ "International standard" means a standard adopted by an international standardization organization.
■■ "European standard" means a standard adopted by a European standardization organization.
■■ "Harmonized standard" is a special case for a European standard. Harmonized standards are
adopted on the basis of a request made by the Commission, with the objective of supporting the
harmonization of EU legislation.
■■ "National standard" means a standard adopted by a national standardization body.

Sometimes, SDOs produce standards with a scope that goes beyond their alleged geographical coverage.
For instance, ETSI is an official SDO within the European Union. However, it also publishes standards that
are adopted globally, such as the GSM family of standards for mobile communications.

3.2.2 COOPERATION AND COORDINATION AMONG DIFFERENT LEVELS OF


STANDARDIZATION
The need for coordination among different levels is inherent to the spirit of standardization. The objective is
to ensure that organizations make the best use of their resources, to help them to exchange information,
increase the transparency of procedures and reduce the possibility of duplicating work unnecessarily at a
national, regional or international level.

62
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

International

Region 1 Region 2

National SDO1 National SDO2 National SDO3

Figure 3.3: Hierarchy of SDOs according to their geographical scope

The typical stance when seeking coordination among different levels of standardization is that international
standardization takes precedence over regional standardization, which in turn takes precedence
over national standardization. One of the objectives of standardization carried out at higher levels (i.e.
international and regional) is to harmonize standardization coming out from lower levels (i.e. regional and
national, respectively). The ideal process is for approved international standards to be simultaneously
adopted as regional standards, and then as national standards in the countries in that region. However, that
requires a previous agreement among the SDOs at the different levels (national, regional and international).
SDO agreements also tend to recognize standardization with a narrower scope (regional, national), which
may have particular needs to be considered when adopting standards with a wider scope. Furthermore,
membership of SDOs in organizations with a wider geographical scope is also relevant to coordination: it
is commonplace for national SDOs to be members of their corresponding regional SDOs; and for national
and regional SDOs to be members of their corresponding international SDOs.
When national standards organizations adopt European and International standards, they have the
advantage of a wider geographical scope, covering in principle the whole world in the case of international
standards. Purely national standards may exist. However, they are only a small part—often less than
10%—of the national SDO portfolio of standards.

63
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

COORDINATION AMONG EUROPEAN AND NATIONAL STANDARDIZATION ACTIVITIES


According to the BSI "European standards and the UK" report (BSI 2017), the single-standard model
pursued by the European Union supports the European single market, as it means that there is only one
standard in use across all the countries of the single market on any given issue. This model is favoured
by industry because it reduces the number of standards that a company may have to consider in order
to trade across borders. It also reduces costs and increases choice for consumers by making it easier for
goods and services to be traded. Businesses gain the benefits of market-driven good practice developed
by broad communities of experts through robust and open standardization processes.
In this respect, the "standstill" is a relevant concept in European coordination of standards. It entails an
obligation for the national SDOs to not take any action, neither during the preparation of a European
Standard (EN), nor after its approval, that could prejudice the intended harmonization and, in particular,
not to publish a new or revised national standard that is not identical to an existing EN. For the sake of
transparency and the achievement of good coordination, both European and their national member SDOs
periodically (at least annually) publish their work programmes and the list of approved/adopted standards.
Once a European SDO has approved a standardization project where a standard is to be developed, the
generic process of coordination with a national SDO can be summarized as follows:
■■ Drafting: a standardization group within a technical committee of a European SDO drafts the
document.
■■ Voting and commenting: national SDOs that are represented in the technical committee voice their
corresponding national perspectives in the draft and submit their votes and comments about the
draft.
■■ Publication and national adoption: approved European standards are transposed and announced
by each national SDO. Where national legislation exists, it should be mentioned in an annex to
the standard. Importantly, national standards that conflict with the new European Standard are
withdrawn. The adoption of an EN can be done either by mere endorsement, by publishing a national
standard with identical text, by translating the standard into the national language, by publishing an
endorsement sheet, or by an announcement in the national member’s official journal. The default
national adoption dates for an EN vary between three to six months after publication by the ESO.
There are guidelines for the naming and numbering of European Standards that are adopted
nationally. In addition, there may be applicable requirements for distributing and selling adopted
European standards nationally. For instance, when EN 50134-3:2012 "Alarm systems—Social alarm
systems—Part 3: Local unit and controller" was approved by CENELEC, it automatically became
a national standard in each of the CENELEC member countries (e.g. BS EN 50134–3 in the United
Kingdom).

64
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

EN project EN Drafting National SDOs EN Publication


approval voting and and National
commenting adoption

Figure 3.4: The process of coordination of an EN project with national standardization

In those cases where the European SDO decides to exclude certain aspects from the scope and application
field of the future EN that are relevant to the national SDO, the latter is free to publish the additional aspects
as national standards. In any case, the national SDO has to ensure that this national standard is not in
conflict with the aims of European standardization and will not create barriers to trade.
Details about the obligations, rights and processes of national SDOs in relation to European Standards are
provided in the following documents:
■■ (ETSI 2015)
■■ (CEN, CENELEC 2008)
■■ (CEN 2016)

EXAMPLE
Each national SDO member of CEN, CENELEC and ETSI has adopted the European Standard EN 301
549, which was published in response to Mandate 376 of the European Commission.
In parallel, each member state of the European Union should transpose the Directive (EU) 2016/2102
(which references the EN) into its national law within two years of the Directive being approved. This
mechanism ensures that each transposed law references the corresponding standard resulting from the
adoption of EN 301 549.

65
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

COORDINATION AMONG EUROPEAN AND INTERNATIONAL SDOS


As described in Figure 3.5, there are cooperation and coordination agreements between international and
European SDOs.

Guide for ISO/IEC JTC1


and ITU cooperation

ISO/IEC JTC1

ISO IEC ITU

Vienna Frankfurt MoU


agreement agreement

Cooperation
agreement

CEN CENELEC ETSI

Regulation (EU) No 1025/2012

Figure 3.5: Cooperation and coordination agreements between European and international SDOs;
modified from Jakobs (2008)

66
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

COORDINATION BETWEEN ISO AND CEN (VIENNA AGREEMENT)


The agreement on technical cooperation between ISO and CEN (ISO and CEN 2001) is an agreement on
technical cooperation between these two SDOs. The latest version of the Vienna Agreement came into
effect in 2001, superseding both the 1991 version of the Vienna Agreement and the earlier 1989 Lisbon
Agreement.
In further detail, the agreement underlines that international standardization takes precedence over national
standardization (ISO and CEN 2016). ISO standards are simultaneously approved as a European Standards,
and they are adopted by each CEN member. In addition, CEN members must withdraw any pre‐existing
conflicting national standards. For instance, ISO 9001:2015 Quality management systems—Requirements
was automatically adopted as a European Standard (EN ISO 9001:2015) and nationally by member states
such as Spain as a Spanish standard (UNE-EN 9001:2015).
The agreement also recognizes that the single European market may have particular needs, for example
in the case of standards for which there is no international need currently recognized, or standards that
are urgently required in the European Union, but which have a lower priority at international level (ISO
and CEN 2016). In these cases, the agreement permits European standards to be made available for
voting and commenting by all ISO member bodies at the enquiry and formal approval stages. This allows
non-European ISO members to influence the content of European Standards and, where appropriate, to
approve those standards as International Standards.
Furthermore, the Vienna Agreement provides three main modes of cooperation between ISO and CEN:
■■ By correspondence/exchange of information;
■■ By mutual representation at meetings;
■■ By parallel approval of standards at international and European levels.
Approximately 30% of CEN standards are developed under the Vienna agreement.

COORDINATION BETWEEN IEC AND CENELEC (FRANKFURT AGREEMENT)


In 2016, IEC and CENELEC signed the Frankfurt Agreement (IEC and CENELEC 2016), which confirms
their "agreement on common planning of new work and parallel voting" that started in 1996 with the
Dresden Agreement. The agreement has had a significant impact on the activities of these organizations,
as around 80% of all European electrotechnical standards are identical to or based on IEC International
Standards. Moreover, new electrical standards projects are jointly planned between CENELEC and IEC
and, where possible, most are carried out at international level. For instance, the international standard
IEC 62236-3-2:2008 "Railway applications – Electromagnetic compatibility – Part 3-2: Rolling stock –
Apparatus" constitutes a technical revision and is based on the European standard EN 50121-3-2:2006.
The latest version of the agreement includes several updates that aim to simplify the voting processes
carried out in parallel and to increase the traceability of international standards adopted in Europe thanks
to a new referencing system.

67
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

GUIDANCE FOR THE REGIONAL OR NATIONAL ADOPTION OF INTERNATIONAL STANDARDS


ISO/IEC Guide 21 provides guidance on regional or national adoption of international standards and other
international deliverables. It has two parts:
■■ Part 1: Adoption of international standards, and
■■ Part 2: Adoption of international deliverables other than international standards (i.e., Technical
Specifications and Technical Reports).
This guide provides methods for the adoption of international standards (and other international
deliverables) as regional or national standards. Furthermore, it defines a system for indicating the degree
of correspondence between international standards and their national or regional adoptions. It also gives
the rules for the adoption of international deliverables other than international standards, and provides
indications for numbering regional or national standards that are identical adoptions of international
standards (and other international deliverables).
ITU and ETSI have established a Memorandum of Understanding (ITU and ETSI 2016) where both SDOs
have agreed to strengthen information exchange and cooperation, including:
■■ An iterative process where ETSI submits input documents to ITU study groups and other groups.
■■ The exchange of information on areas of mutual interest.

COORDINATION BETWEEN ISO AND IEC


ISO/IEC JTC 1 was formed in 1987 as a merger between ISO/TC 97 (Information Technology) and IEC/
TC 83, with IEC/SC 47B joining later. The intention was to bring together in a single committee the IT
standardization activities of the two parent organizations, in order to avoid duplicative or possibly
incompatible standards. The mandate of JTC 1 was to develop base standards in information technology,
upon which other technical committees could build. This would allow for the development of domain- and
application-specific standards that could be applicable to specific business domains, while also ensuring
the interoperation and function of the standards on a consistent base (ISO and IEC n.d.). ISO/IEC Joint
Technical Committee 2 (JTC 2) was created in 2009 for the purpose of "standardization in the field of
energy efficiency and renewable energy sources".
The guide for ITU-T and ISO/IEC JTC1 cooperation (ITU and ISO/IEC 2014) contains a set of procedures
for cooperation between ITU-T and ISO/IEC JTC 1. It is written in an informal style, much like a tutorial, to
be a practical, educational and insightful reference for both leaders and participants in cooperative work.

3GPP AS AN EXAMPLE OF INTERNATIONAL COORDINATION (3RD GENERATION PARTNERSHIP


PROJECT)
3GPP is composed of ICT SDOs (ARIB, ATIS, CCSA, ETSI, TSDSI, TTA, TTC), known as organizational
partners, and provides its members with a stable environment to produce reports and specifications about
mobile communication technologies, a field in constant evolution.
Once these deliverables are approved by 3GPP, each organizational partner adopts and publishes these
deliverables with identical text. Furthermore, organizational partners take decisions on the creation or
discontinuation of Technical Specification Groups, as well as the approval of their scope and terms of
reference.

68
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

ring together

Figure 3.6: SDOs that are partners of 3GPP

EXAMPLE
In the case of ETSI, 3GPP deliverables are adopted correspondingly as ETSI Reports or ETSI
specifications through the following process. First, a new document is created by inserting the text of the
3GPP specification into the ETSI deliverable template. Second, the ETSI title page is added, including the
specification title and code. Third, the administrative page, the ETSI Intellectual Property (IPR) information,
the Foreword and the final history pages are added. Finally, the document is made available for free
download from the ETSI website. When so requested by the European Commission, the document may
be adopted as a European Standard (EN).

The organizational partners may invite other organizations as market representation partners in 3GPP.
These market representation partners do not take part in the definition of specifications, but offer market
advice to 3GPP to give 3GPP a consensus view of market requirements.

69
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

3.3 ADOPTION/TRANSPOSITION OF STANDARDS

3.3.1 INTRODUCTION
There are situations in which a standard may be transposed or adopted by a committee different to the
one that produced it in the first place. There are cases when a de facto standard or a standard written by
a consortium / industrial forum is published and endorsed with the same content by a recognized SDO.
This may also happen when a marketing organization writes a testing specification to promote the market
adoption of a standard. Furthermore, a standard may be referenced as technical content of a regulation. This
section describes the cases that may occur and what type of documents may be concerned in this regard.

3.3.2 ADOPTION OF A DE FACTO OR INDUSTRIAL CONSORTIUM STANDARD


Industrial consortia are alliances of companies operating in the same domain that come together to
prepare specifications for products that must be brought to market very quickly. They usually benefit from
a lighter process and a lower level of consensus of document approval than the processes that traditional
SDOs go through. In response to the rapid development of ICT systems, a large number of consortia has
been created in this sector. Major industry players often consider consortia to be more efficient and more
oriented towards the needs of the industry than the formal standards-setting process, which—according
to them—depends on a cumbersome and time consuming wide consensus process. The time-to-market
of their specifications is expected to be much shorter than those of the recognized SDOs.
Consortia specifications are different from other documents owned by a single company (for example,
Windows as a Microsoft standard) in the sense that they are written by a community. In some cases, a
consortium may ultimately prefer to have its specifications become formal standards, as this provides
more confidence and ensures wider adoption by the market. It may bring a whole set of benefits to the
developed technology, because it ensures that the specifications comply with quality rules, which are often
tighter than what a private group may deliver.
Recognized SDOs have procedures for referencing and incorporating industrial technical specifications
or collaborating in the development of standards with these consortia. These procedures guarantee that
the fundamental principles set out in Section 3.1.5 are respected. After publication of the standards, it is
possible to develop further versions as necessary due to technological evolution, which will be discussed
within a larger group of stakeholders, thus fostering wider market adoption.

DEFINITION

THE PAS PROCESS


The Publicly Available Specification (PAS) procedure is a means to transpose a specification more
rapidly into an international standard published by a recognized SDO. This mechanism has primarily
been designed to enable JTC 1 to transpose specifications that originated from consortia into
international standards.
The PAS procedure takes into consideration the fact that the publication is already developed at an
almost final stage and approved by consensus at consortium level. The approval of the document
by a technical committee is then set up at the recognized SDO. PASs are published by the SDO for
immediate use. The standard benefits from the SDO’s reputation as a provider of standards for global
use and receives increased visibility. A PAS published as a standard is subsequently maintained and
possibly evolved by the SDO that applied the procedure. The PAS process allows the document to
be available to the market faster and in a lighter way than with the full, regular SDO process.

70
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

EXAMPLE
ETSI defines Publicly Available Specifications (PAS) for technical specifications developed by Standards
Development Organizations outside ETSI. The ETSI PAS process (ETSI 2017) defines the procedures
to adopt specifications written by industrial alliances as ETSI documents, namely ETSI Technical
Specifications (TS) or ETSI Technical Reports (TR). It has already been applied to specifications from
two different consortia, the Home Gateway Initiative (HGI) and the Car Connectivity Consortium (CCC),
presented below.
Based upon the "Home Gateway" as a modular application platform, HGI developed a smart home
architecture that enables applications to connect with devices on any home network interface. Following
the closure of HGI in June 2016, TC SmartM2M handled the conversion of the three HGI specifications
(HGI 2016) into ETSI TSs using the PAS procedure and published the three TSs in November 2016.
"HGI consulted closely with ETSI SmartM2M during the development of these key documents. This work
complements our own work on smart appliances very well, and we are happy to integrate these HGI
requirements into our family of specifications." (ETSI 2016c)

Lights

Home
Energy
Management

Advanced
Telephony

e-Health

HGI
e-Security

Home
Automation

Media

Broadband

Figure 3.7: Overview of HGI use cases

71
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

The CCC (CCC 2016) is a cross-industry collaboration including car OEMs, tier-1 suppliers, phone
manufacturers and application developers, who create global solutions for smartphone and in-vehicle
connectivity. Developed by the CCC, MirrorLink® is an open standard for smartphone-car connectivity
that allows smartphone apps to be displayed on the In-Vehicle Infotainment (IVI) system.
MirrorLink® specifications were released through the ETSI PAS process and published as ETSI TS
in October 2017. The addition of MirrorLink® to the list of ETSI standards is expected to facilitate
implementation of the technology by manufacturers.
The PAS procedure is offered by ISO as well. The EnOcean Alliance (EnOcean 2017) created a wireless
standard to develop self-powered wireless monitoring and control systems for sustainable buildings as
well as energy harvesting solutions. The specifications of the Wireless Short-Packet protocol (WSP) for
the IoT were later ratified as an ISO/IEC standard.
According to EnOcean, the international standardization is expected to accelerate the development and
implementation of energy-optimized wireless sensors and wireless sensor networks, and to open up
new markets and areas of application. Moreover, the EnOcean Alliance complemented the standard
with dedicated equipment and generic profiles, which describe the data communication of products
using the WSP protocol. Developers and manufacturers can therefore benefit from the Alliance’s practical
experience and years of user education. This has been documented by ETSI (2016).

Application
EnOcean Equipment
Profiles (EEP)

Network

Data Link

ISO/IEC 14543-3-1X

Physical

Figure 3.8: EnOcean Alliance standards

72
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Another case occurs when specifications from SDOs partnership projects are adopted as standards at
regional level. This is the "mirror process". The partnership project produces Technical Specifications,
which are transposed by relevant standardization bodies into appropriate deliverables and standards.

EXAMPLE
For example, the 3rd Generation Partnership Project (3GPP) and oneM2M are partnership projects
including regional organizations, such as ATIS (USA), ETSI (Europe) and ARIB (Japan), as well as other
related bodies. Both projects bring together telecommunications SDOs and regional organizations,
which have signed a partnership agreement.
The mirror process means that, for example, 3GPP TS 23.401 version 14.7.0 Release 14 was
published by ETSI as ETSI TS 123 401 V14.7.0 and oneM2M TS-0001 version 2.10.0 Release 2
was transposed as ETSI TS 118 101 V2.10.0.
3GPP is presented in more detail as a case study in Section 4.5.

Bring together

Figure 3.9: Link between 3GPP and its organizational partners. OneM2M has a similar model

ISO/ IEC JTC 1 is another example of partnership between ISO (the International Organization for
Standardization) and IEC (the International Electrotechnical Commission). ISO and IEC technical
committees collaborate in fields of mutual interest. ISO/IEC JTC 1 is a joint technical committee for
the development of worldwide Information and Communication Technologies (ICT) standards for
business and consumer applications. The standards produced are identified with both SDO names
and can be obtained from either ISO or IEC catalogues.

73
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

3.3.3 EXTENSION OF STANDARDS BY MARKETING ORGANIZATIONS


In the reverse direction, standards are referenced by industrial alliances to build test suite specifications
and promote the technology. Their objective is to provide specifications for testing, certification and other
related elements of conformity assessment, and ensure that the products, services or systems implemented
according to the initial standards meet the standards’ requirements.
Conformity assessment activities act as an essential intermediary between standards and the products
themselves. The produced test specifications describe the testing methodology used to assess the
conformity as well as the conformity assessment process itself. Conformity assessment plays an important
role in various areas, including safety control, government procurement, business transactions and product
selection by consumers.
Different types of organizations operate third-party certification programmes, for example competent
laboratories, trade associations, organizations composed of producers, and testing facilities. For critical
products, they may need an accreditation from the regional or national authorities to be allowed to operate.

EXAMPLE
For example, the IEEE 802.11 standard was adopted by the Wi-Fi Alliance to develop the requirements
and profiles for certification of WLAN products. The Wi-Fi Test Suite (Wi-Fi 2017) is a software platform
designed to support the certification programme development and the certification of the devices
themselves.
As another example, the Global System for Mobile Communications Association (GSMA) writes guidelines
and specifications to help implementers use the ETSI standards developed by 3GPP. For example, the
latest guidelines published address topics such as "Service Provider Device Configuration" (RCC 14 v5.0,
published in June 2017), "Device Field and Lab Test Guidelines" (TS.11 v19.0, published in April 2017)
and "Smarter Traffic Management" (IG.16, published in March 2017).

3.3.4 ADOPTION INTO/FROM REGULATIONS


A strong link exists between regulations, legislation and policies defined by local authorities at regional level,
and standards. The authorities are regularly required to draft regulatory texts, in which they must define
technical specifications to be complied with. They have the choice of developing their own specifications
or using already existing standards. In the ICT domain, referencing standards avoids having to describe
technical attributes such as requirements on performance indicator, on testing limits, etc.
Standards can be referenced in regulations to simplify their content, facilitate or reduce certain controls,
and better enact laws. It helps to focus the regulations on public policy goals and requirements. Regulations
can reference standards in several ways: by mentioning them implicitly or explicitly, with the title and with/
without the date, and with an optional, privileged or binding reference. A standard that has been made
compulsory becomes part of the regulation.
Moreover, standards may be subject to copyrights held by the SDO. It is thus better practice for regulations
to only refer to the relevant standard and avoid citing parts of it.

74
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

REGULATIONS REFERRING TO STANDARDS


Regulations may refer to, use or impose standards and specifications.
The reference to standards and specifications concerns either the mandatory adherence to technical
requirements, including the required implementation of standards and specifications, or these standards
and specifications serve as references for mandatory essential requirements. In the latter case, the
implementation of the referenced standards and specifications is optional, but the contained mandatory
essential requirements must be met.
With respect to the corresponding legislation, regulations may then add further details and references to
standards and specifications. Enforcement of specific regulations may be entrusted to and exercised by
specific entities appointed for that purpose. Furthermore, a regulation may allow penalties and sanctions
to be imposed with immediate effect if the regulation is not observed.

CATEGORIES OF STANDARDS SUITABLE FOR REFERENCES


Legislation and regulations may include references to the following types of standards:
■■ Harmonized standards, developed for this purpose, which are voluntary and carry with them the
presumption of conformity: compliance with these standards is the recommended but not exclusive
method to meet essential requirements, e.g. for CE marking.
■■ Other standards or specifications that may be recommended or imposed.

USE OF HARMONIZED STANDARDS

DEFINITION
A harmonized standard is a European standard developed by a recognized European Standards
Organization: CEN, CENELEC, or ETSI, created following a request from the European Commission
to one of these organizations.

Adherence to harmonized standards carries with it the presumption of conformity with essential
requirements. Conformity to harmonized standards can be used to demonstrate that products, services or
processes comply with relevant EU legislation: the use and correct implementation of these standards is
assumed to be sufficient indication that the relevant essential requirements have been met.
However, implementation of these harmonized standards remains voluntary: manufacturers, other
economic operators and conformity assessment bodies are free to choose other technical solutions, but
then need to demonstrate compliance with the mandatory essential requirements.
The references of harmonized standards are published in the Official Journal of the European Union (OJEU);
it is a precondition for legal validity of the harmonized standards and references to them, including the
presumption of conformity. (EC 2018).

75
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

EXAMPLE
Radio Spectrum Regulatory Framework
Figure 3.10 illustrates the European Radio spectrum regulatory environment (ETSI-ECC 2016).

Mandates
CEPT reports

THE REGULATORY
ENVIRONMENT
How does it work ?

Standardization Cooperation for the development


requests (mandates) of harmonized standards
European standards and relevant ECC deliverables
- Inclusion of HENs in OJEU

Figure 3.10: European radio spectrum regulatory environment

The radio spectrum regulation framework is a typical example of this collaboration between authorities
and SDOs. It associates three entities: the European Commission (EC), the Electronic Communications
Committee (ECC) of the European Conference of Postal and Telecommunications Administrations
(CEPT), and the ESOs: ETSI and CENELEC. The CEPT and the ECC bring together radio spectrum
experts delegated by 48 countries, including the EU member states. One of the ECC’s main objectives is
to harmonize the efficient use of the radio spectrum across Europe.

76
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

■ The EC, via its Radio Spectrum Committee (RSC), mandates the CEPT to conduct technical
studies in order to develop technical measures related to the radio spectrum to be implemented at
the European community level. Such measures may be specifications or other documentation on
specific technologies and their application. For example, System Reference Documents advise on
the need for an allocation of spectrum, in particular when either a change in the current frequency
usage, or a change in the regulatory framework for the proposed band, is needed to accommodate
a new radio system or service.
■ ETSI, as an SDO, receives standardization requests from the EC. The appropriate ETSI working
groups prepare standards to be approved as harmonized standards in collaboration with the ECC
and specify how products can comply with the requirements of the EC and EFTA (European Free
Trade Association, a regional trade organization and free trade area consisting of four European
states: Iceland, Liechtenstein, Norway and Switzerland).
■ The ECC/CEPT prepares CEPT reports in response to the mandates received from the EC.
■ The application of harmonized standards referenced in the Official Journal of the European Union
(OJEU) enables manufacturers and service providers to benefit from a presumption of conformity
with the requirements of the EC Directives, and thus to be able to market their radio devices within
the EU.

The Radio Equipment Directive (RED) (EU 2014) is a typical application of the regulatory environment
described above. Its provisions have been applicable since 13 June 2016.
Any provider that wants to place transmitting or receiving radio equipment on the European market and
operate it using the radio spectrum must meet the requirements of the relevant directives and regulations.
In the EU, the manufacturer or distributor of a device bears full responsibility for placing it on the market.
The RED specifies the requirements to be met by products with radio equipment in order to be sold and
put into service.
Radio equipment covered by the RED is not subject to the Low-Voltage Directive (LVD) or the
Electromagnetic Compatibility Directive (EMCD): the essential requirements of those Directives are
comprehensively covered by the RED itself, with certain modifications with respect to the LVD and the
EMCD. RED also applies to radiodetermination equipment: equipment that uses the propagation qualities
of radio waves to determine its position; this includes systems that receive GPS signals.

The RED places additional emphasis on efficient and effective use of the spectrum: radio equipment
needs to demonstrate its receiver and transmitter performance, as both are considered to affect the
efficient and effective use of the spectrum. As a consequence, broadcast TV & radio receivers are now
specifically included in the scope of the RED to ensure efficient operation.
Harmonized standards developed after the RED allow manufacturers to enter the market with a
presumption of conformity.

77
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

EXAMPLE
CE Marking
"CE" is the abbreviation of "Conformité Européenne", or "European Conformity". The official term now
used for labelling is "CE Marking" and is included in all EU official documents (EC 2018).
CE Marking is a requirement for products covered by this regulation entering the European Economic
Area (EEA) and European Free Trade Association (EFTA) markets. It is not intended for use with products
not covered by this regulation. It is forbidden to affix CE Marking to such products.
CE Marking identifies a product as complying with the health and safety requirements contained in
European legislation (Directives). Once CE marked, a product or equipment can enter the EEA and EFTA
markets.
The requirements of the CE Marking process are as follows:
■ Identify applicable directive(s)
■ Identify the harmonized standards concerned
■ Verify the product’s specific requirements
■ Identify whether a conformity assessment by a notified body is necessary
■ Test the product’s conformity with the relevant requirements and, if necessary, have tests performed
by a notified body
■ Establish the required technical documentation
■ Affix the CE marking and complete the Declaration of Conformity.
CE marking does not indicate that a product has been approved as safe by the EU or by another
authority, neither does it indicate the origin of a product. Furthermore, CE marking does not automatically
guarantee the parameters of individual product characteristics: manufactured products might deviate and
not conform to the relevant requirements due to changes in the requirements, changes to the product or
poor-quality production.
Due to the size of the combined EU and EFTA markets, CE marking has an influence that goes well
beyond the market: for example, it is not uncommon to find CE marking on products (also) sold on the
American market.

78
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

3.4 TYPES OF DOCUMENTS PRODUCED BY SDOS


This section explains the differences between types of standardization documents in terms of their scope
and addressed stakeholders, whether they contain requirements (normative documents) or they simply
provide information, as well as the process leading to their approval/publication. These types of documents
are produced by most of the official SDOs. However, they may also be published by non-recognized SDOs.
This section also deals with the organizations that are suitable for producing each type of document, and
describes the definition/purpose of each type of document, which may differ across organizations. Finally,
this section illustrates the main characteristics of each type of standardization document.
There are different types of standardization documents, which may differ in certain aspects, including:
■■ Their scope and addressed stakeholders.
■■ The absence or presence of requirements that could lead to certification.
■■ The process leading to their approval/publication.
In addition, the type of organization needs to be considered, as: 1) not all organizations are suitable for
producing every type of document; 2) the definition/purpose of each type of document may differ across
organizations.
Regarding their applicability to compliance processes, standards fall into two general categories: normative
and informative (Hatto 2013). Normative documents contain requirements, which must be met in order to
claim compliance with the standard. Requirements in a standard are usually worded with the term "shall",
while recommendations are worded with "should". Informative documents do not contain requirements.
Normative documents may include informative elements, but these must be clearly presented as such and
may not contain requirements.

3.4.1 NORMATIVE DOCUMENTS


A standard is a document that contains requirements or recommendations that have reached wide
consensus. Normally, for standards to be approved, they must first go through the comprehensive and
rigorous procedures of the organizations publishing them.
■■ EN 301 893 5 GHz RLAN; Harmonized Standard covering the essential requirements of article 3.2
of Directive 2014/53/EU
A specification is a document needed by industry in the short term concerning a technical aspect that
is still under technical development, or where it is believed that there will be a future, but not immediate,
possibility of agreement on a standard.
■■ Example: ISO/IEC TS 19841:2015 Technical Specification for C++ Extensions for Transactional
Memory

79
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

3.4.2 INFORMATIVE DOCUMENTS


A technical report is a document with explanatory material about a topic.
■■ Example: ETSI TR 103 234 Power Line Telecommunications; Power line recommendations for very
high bitrate services. This document investigates the capacity of several technologies to distribute
streaming services from residential home gateways to set-top box and media servers.
A guide is a document used by standards organizations for guidance regarding how to handle specific
technical standardization activities.
■■ Example: ISO/IEC Guide 71 Guide for addressing accessibility in standards
• Guides standardizers on how to address accessibility when either producing new standards or
revising existing ones
■■ Example: CEN-CENELEC and ISO-IEC Guide 17 for writing standards, by taking into account the
needs of micro, small and medium-sized enterprises
• This document guides standardizers on how to take SME needs into account, for instance by
making standards "simple and understandable".

3.4.3 DOCUMENTS SPECIFIC TO CERTAIN ORGANIZATIONS


Some document types are specific to certain organizations, e.g.:
■■ ETSI Standard (ES): ETSI uses this kind of document for a standard that is submitted to the whole
ETSI membership for its approval. (ETSI n.d.).
■■ CEN Workshop Agreement (CWA) is an agreement developed and approved in a CEN Workshop
(CEN n.d.).
■■ ISO Workshop Agreement (IWA) is a document developed outside the normal ISO committee system
to enable market players to negotiate in an "open workshop" environment (ISO n.d.).
■■ ISO Publicly Available Specifications (PAS) are published to respond to an urgent market need.
They do not call for wide consensus involving all stakeholder groups, but only the consensus of the
experts within a working group, or a consensus in an organization outside ISO. PAS are published
for immediate use and serve as a means to get feedback for an eventual transformation into an
International Standard (ISO n.d.).

80
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

3.5 NAMING CONVENTIONS FOR STANDARDIZATION DOCUMENTS


This section deals with the naming conventions of different SDOs, and shows how to extract and identify
several characteristics of a document from its name, including the title, the SDO that published/adopted
the document, the type of standardization document, whether or not the document belongs to a family of
standards, whether it is a harmonized standard, the version of the standard, as well as the date/year the
document was published.
The name of a standardization document may contain information about:
■■ The SDO (or SDOs, in the case of a joint publication) that published it.
■■ Other SDOs that might have adopted the standard after it was originally published.
■■ The type of document, for instance if it is an international, European or national standard, a
specification, technical report, etc.
■■ Whether the document belongs to a family of standards.
■■ Whether it is a harmonized standard.
■■ The version number of the standard that indicates whether it is a draft or final version and informs
whether the document adds major, technical or editorial changes to the previous version.
■■ The year of publication of the document.
■■ The title of the standard.
Some issues concerning naming conventions are significant. First, different SDOs have different naming
conventions. Furthermore, different countries or regions may use different naming conventions, either for
the formal standards published by the SDOs operating in that geographical context or for the standards
adopted from SDOs with a wider scope, such as international standards. Finally, the names of standards
may differ slightly depending on whether they are given directly by the publishing SDO (e.g. the standard
itself or the institutional database) or by external sources, such as the standard’s citations by a report or
journal, which may have specific citation guidelines or restrictions.

EXAMPLE
EN 45502-2-3:2010 Active implantable medical devices—Part 2-3: Particular requirements for cochlear
and auditory brainstem implant systems
What information can we obtain from this name?
■ The "EN" prefix indicates that it is a European Standard.
■ The code of the standard "45502-2-3" indicates that it includes the 2nd and the 3rd documents of
a standard family ("45502").
■ It was published in 2010.
■ The family name is "Active implantable medical devices".
■ The title of the standard itself is "Part 2-3: Particular requirements for cochlear and auditory
brainstem implant systems".
The name of the standard does not tell us whether it was developed and published by CENELEC. Each
European Standard is identified by a unique reference code that contains the letters "EN", without stating
which of the three recognized European SDOs (CEN, CENELEC or ETSI) published it. Furthermore, the
name does not provide any indication as to whether previous versions of this standard exist.

81
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

EXAMPLE
ETSI TS 102 412 V12.0.0 (2015-02) "Smart Cards; Smart Card Platform Requirements Stage 1"
(Release 12)
What information can be obtained from this name?
■ The "ETSI" prefix indicates that this standard was published by ETSI.
■ The "TS" prefix indicates that it is a technical specification.
■ The code of the standard is 102 412.
■ This is version 12.0.0 of the standard (which is confirmed by the "Release 12" in the title). ETSI uses
three numbers (x.y.z) to indicate its document versions. The first final version of a document will
be Version 1.1.1. Subsequent final documents will increase the first number "1.x.x" of the version
number (1.x.x, 2.x.x, etc.). While the document is under review, subsequent draft versions will
increase "x.1.1", e.g., 1.2.0, 1.3.0, etc.
■ It was published in February 2015.
■ The document is part of the "Smart Cards" family of standards.
Nevertheless, it is not clear whether there is a unique code for this family of standards. In fact, ETSI
allocates consecutive numbers to their individual standards, irrespective of whether they are part of a
family or not.

EXAMPLE
ISO/IEC 27002:2013 Information technology—Security techniques—Code of practice for information
security controls
What information can be obtained from this name?
■ The "ISO/IEC" prefix indicates that this standard was published jointly by ISO and IEC, as part of
the JTC 1 agreement.
■ The code of the standard is 27002.
■ This document belongs to a family of standards named "Information technology—Security
techniques", the 27000 series. Another example of a document in this family is ISO/IEC 27005—
Information technology—Security techniques—Information security risk management.
This is an international standard (IS), but this information is not explicitly stated in the title of ISO documents.
Should the document belong to any other category (e.g. Guide, Specification, etc.), this would be made
explicit in the document name (e.g. ISO Guide 82:2014 Guidelines for addressing sustainability in
standards, ISO/IEC TR 14143-5:2004 Information technology—Software measurement—Functional size
measurement—Part 5: Determination of functional domains for use with functional size measurement).

82
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

EXAMPLE
BS EN ISO/IEC 27002:2005 Information technology. Security techniques. Code of practice for information
security management
What information can be obtained from this name?
■ The "BS EN ISO/IEC" prefix indicates that this standard was first published by ISO/IEC, then
adopted as a European Standard (EN), and then as a British standard (BS)

EXAMPLE
ETSI has produced several different versions of the ETSI EN 302 054 standard. Let’s have a look at a
subset of them:
■ ETSI EN 302 054 V2.2.1 (2018-02) Meteorological Aids (Met Aids); Radiosondes to be used in the
400,15 MHz to 406 MHz frequency range with power levels ranging up to 200 mW; Harmonized
Standard for access to radio spectrum
■ ETSI EN 302 054 V2.1.1 (2017-10) Meteorological Aids (Met Aids); Radiosondes to be used in the
400,15 MHz to 406 MHz frequency range with power levels ranging up to 200 mW; Harmonized
Standard covering the essential requirements of article 3.2 of Directive 2014/53/EU
■ Draft ETSI EN 302 054 V2.1.0 (2017-05) Meteorological Aids (Met Aids); Radiosondes to be
used in the 400,15 MHz to 406 MHz frequency range with power levels ranging up to 200 mW;
Harmonized Standard covering the essential requirements of article 3.2 of Directive 2014/53/EU
■ ETSI EN 302 054-2 V1.2.1 (2015-10) Meteorological Aids (Met Aids); Radiosondes to be used in
the 400,15 MHz to 406 MHz frequency range with power levels ranging up to 200 mW; Part 2:
Harmonized Standard covering the essential requirements of article 3.2 of the Directive 2014/53/
EU
■ ETSI EN 302 054-1 V1.1.1 (2003-03) European Standard (Telecommunications series)
Electromagnetic compatibility and Radio spectrum Matters (ERM); Meteorological Aids (Met Aids);
Radiosondes to be used in the 400,15 MHz to 406 MHz frequency range with power levels ranging up to
200 mW; Part 1: Technical characteristics and test methods
What information can be obtained from the names in the above list?
The standard was a European Standard (EN), and therefore a formal standard, since its first version
was published. Version 2 of the document was approved as a harmonized standard, as it reads in the
document title. Furthermore, the deliverable was originally a two-part standard, but in version 2 it became
a single-part standard.
Regarding the different versions of the standard, and based on the version numbering system used by
ETSI (ETSI 2016), we can say the following:
■ There has been one major revision of the standard (from version 1.x.x to version 2.x.x). After an
analysis of the document titles, we can conclude that this major revision included the transformation
of the originally multi-part standard into a single-part standard.
■ The first approved document for version 2 of the document was version V2.1.1, which has editorial
differences to V2.1.0. According to its name, version V2.1.0 was only published as a draft, but it
was not finally approved as an ETSI deliverable.
■ After V2.1.1, V2.2.1 was published. There are technical differences between them.

83
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

3.6 CASE STUDY: THE REVISION OF A NATIONAL STANDARD ABOUT


TELECARE, FROM THE ICT ACCESSIBILITY PERSPECTIVE
The UNE 158401 standard was approved in 2007 by UNE, the Spanish official SDO. The objective and
scope section of the document reads as follows: "This standard specifies the minimum requirements and
the level of service that the telecare service must meet, both in its domiciliary and mobile versions. This
standard does not cover the requirements for the applied technology".
Public administration agencies in the country, usually local authorities, or regional government in the case of
telecare provision, hire private companies through calls for tenders. These companies provide the telecare
services and equipment to eligible end users. In the calls for tenders, the professional and technical standing
of the companies are assessed against the telecare standard. There are several hundreds of thousands
of citizens from that country who benefit from telecare to enhance their safety and wellbeing. Hence, the
economic and social impact of this standard is significant.
In early 2016, nine years after the first version of the standard was published, the telecare committee
decided to revise the document. By that time, the committee was composed of social representatives
of the telecare arena, including public administration, service providers and manufacturers of telecare
equipment.
The document was in need of an update, as both the service model and the technology had evolved
quite a lot in recent years. At the time the revision began, telecare was much more advanced than it used
to be; a single panic button now allowed the end user to make a hands-free phone call to request help
from an operator. Existing technology and services can detect and alert users in case of fire, extreme
temperatures, and user falls. It is also possible to identify and pick up on behavioural patterns that might
indicate a deterioration of users’ physical or cognitive abilities to live on their own. Furthermore, telecare is
increasingly using IP and web technologies as a complement to traditional phone communications.
According to its scope section, the original version of the standard did not cover technology aspects
of telecare. Stakeholders agreed that the standard should be revised to include requirements about
technology aspects such us minimum battery life and the minimum set of events that should be detected
and transmitted by telecare sensors, etc.
However, in this case study we focus on one single aspect of technology: the accessibility of telecare
devices to citizens with and without disabilities. Considering that a significant percentage of potential
beneficiaries of telecare have a disability, lack of accessibility requirements within the standard stood as a
major barrier for the impact and quality of telecare services in the country.
Shortly before the revision of the telecare standard was agreed, standards and regulation on ICT accessibility
were changing fast in the EU. The standard EN 301 549 V1.1.2 (2015-04) "Accessibility requirements
suitable for public procurement of ICT products and services in Europe" had been approved in April 2015,
following Mandate 376 issued by the European Commission. M376 asked the three ESOs (CEN, CENELEC
and ETSI) to deliver "a European Standard specifying for all ICT products and services within each of the

84
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

technical areas the corresponding requirements for accessibility". One year later, the European Parliament
and the Council approved Directive 2016/2102 on the accessibility of the websites and mobile applications
of public sector bodies. The Directive explicitly states that the content of websites that fulfils the relevant
requirements of European standard EN 301 549 V1.1.2 (2015-04) shall be presumed to be in conformity
with the Directive’s accessibility requirements.
In parallel to what was going on in the telecare committee, the members of another standards committee
on "ICT accessibility" learnt that the telecare standard was being revised. In fact, this was a combination of
coincidence and informal communications among standardizers working in different committees. The two
committees had not previously established formal contact, and therefore were not automatically notified by
the SDO information system about each other’s activities.
This committee on ICT accessibility was composed of accessibility advocates who were up to date on
standardization and regulatory news on the subject of ICT accessibility in the EU. They realized that the
revision process was a good opportunity to include requirements about ICT accessibility.
Regarding the accessibility inputs to the standard revision, the process can be summarized as follows:
■■ The ICT accessibility committee conducted desk research that revealed that there were not any
European or International standards published specifically on telecare accessibility, except an ETSI
Guide on human factors of telecare services (ETSI EG 202 487). Hence, EN 301 549 and ETSI EG
202 487 were used as the primary references to prompt comments for the revision of the telecare
standard.
■■ The convener of the ICT accessibility committee was designated as the delegate in the telecare
committee. Being a delegate means attending telecare committee meetings, introducing and
negotiating the comments submitted, receiving automatic notifications on meeting schedules and
minutes, as well as on updates to committee documents.
■■ The negotiations about accessibility requirements were long and complex. Especially in the
beginning, the proposals to include accessibility requirements in the telecare standard: a) were not
fully understood by the telecare professionals within the committee, b) entailed real challenges for the
telecare manufacturers and providers participating in calls for tenders, as the services and devices
would have to comply with the accessibility requirements, c) might imply higher costs for the public
administrations funding the services.
■■ At the beginning of the revision process, a training session was held on the application of EN 301
549 accessibility requirements to telecare. The session was structured around real case studies
submitted by telecare stakeholders (either public administrations or providers). The aim was to train
delegates on the rationale of user-accessibility needs as well as on the technical solutions required
to address them.
■■ The negotiations had to reach a consensus: Not all of the accessibility contributions were ultimately
included in the telecare standard as requirements (i.e., with the term "should"). Those that were not
achievable in practice for the industry at that time were included as recommendations (i.e., with the
term "shall"). A further revision of the standard would transform recommendations into requirements
when feasible.

85
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

In the end, the telecare committee considered that the accessibility contributions added value to the
revised standard:
■■ More citizens with disabilities will benefit from telecare services, leading to a growing telecare market.
■■ By integrating ICT accessibility solutions into their products, telecare providers and manufacturers
are innovating their service portfolio.
Relationship of the case study with the learning objectives of our materials (guidance information for
teachers):
■■ Standards published by recognized SDOs are used as technical references in public procurement
processes
■■ Standards need to be revised from time to time because of changes in technology and/or societal
needs
■■ The relevance of the information contained in the "objectives and scope" section of standards
■■ Pros of open standardization:
• Committees that are open to all stakeholders reflect the real needs of society in the standards
they produce
• Committees from different standardization areas may cooperate, provided that their activities are
openly and publicly disseminated
• Liaisons between different standardization committees and the use of information systems for
notifications ensure effective communication among committees
■■ Cons of open standardization:
• Reaching consensus takes time, especially when different stakeholders are represented in the
committee
• Different knowledge domains and backgrounds across committees may imply different
"languages and cultures"
■■ Standardizers should be up to date on the most recent standards and regulations in their area
■■ Negotiation and communication are soft skills that standardizers should possess.

86
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

3.7 SUMMARY
This chapter provides readers with key concepts and examples to orientate themselves in the complex
landscape of standardization.
First, it describes the main types of Standards Development Organizations (SDOs), as well as several
classifications for the standards they produce.
Then, it describes the three major geographical scopes of SDOs (international, regional and national), as
well as the need for coordination among these organizations, and the main agreements supporting that
coordination. The case of coordination between European and national SDOs is described in detail. Finally,
the naming conventions of the different organizations are analysed.
Furthermore, this chapter defines the main types of documents published by official SDOs. Normative
and informative documents are defined, as well as the main types of documents within each of these two
categories. Then, the chapter introduces some examples of document types that are specific to particular
SDOs.
Regarding naming conventions, the typical information contained in a standard’s name is described, and
several examples are provided.
Finally, the chapter has shown how standards may be reused by other standards and official documents.
Regional standards are transposed at national level, industrial specifications become formal standards, or
they may serve as references for test and certification platform specifications, or for regulatory texts.
Key messages which should be retained from this chapter include:
■■ The standardization landscape is rich and complex, because of the variety of standards and the
organizations producing them.
■■ From a geographical perspective, there are three major SDO scopes (international, regional and
national). There is a justified need for coordination among these organizations and the treaties, which
is supported through agreements supporting that coordination. The case of coordination between
European and national SDOs, and with international SDOs, is especially relevant.
■■ In addition to geographical coordination, interoperability among industrial consortia and recognized
SDOs is relevant.
■■ The names and codes of standardization documents provide readers with useful information,
including the SDO that published/adopted the document, the type of standardization document, its
topic, its code and family, its version and the publication date.
■■ There are a number of types of standardization deliverables. The most important classification is
normative vs. informative documents. Then, each of these categories has other subcategories;
some of them are particular to specific SDOs.

87
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

3.8 QUIZ

1 - RECOGNIZED SDOS ARE:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Organizations with a sole mission to publish standards that are referenced by regulation.
b) Organizations that have been elected by the corresponding Parliament (e.g., National Parliament,
European Parliament, etc.)
c) Public organizations that have been created by treaties.
d) Officially recognized by regulation systems as providers of standards.

2 - FORMAL STANDARDS:
(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Are also known as de facto standards.
b) Are produced by SDOs.
c) Are only published by officially recognized SDOs.
d) Are documents that companies and public organizations must comply with.

3 - STANDARDIZATION REQUESTS FROM THE EUROPEAN COMMISSION:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Are drafted by the European Commission after consulting social representatives.
b) Can be refused by the European SDOs, but this situation is quite rare.
c) Must be previously approved by each Member State.
d) Need to be ratified by the European Parliament.

4 - STANDARDIZATION REQUESTS FROM THE EUROPEAN COMMISSION:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Are translated into all the official languages of the European Union, and then approved as
directives.
b) Are requests to the European Standardization Organizations to develop standards.
c) Are transformed into de facto standards by non-official SDOs.
d) Are transformed into de facto standards once their adoption is universal.

5 - NON-OFFICIALLY RECOGNIZED SDOS:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) May have well-established procedures to ensure the quality of their standards.
b) Only produce private standardization documents.
c) Produce standards that may later be published by recognized SDOs.
d) Approve regulatory documents.

6 - DE FACTO STANDARDS:
(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Cannot ever become formal standards.
b) Have been previously approved by a public SDO.
c) Are conventions that have achieved a dominant position.
d) Usually have the characteristic of having been validated by the market.

88
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

7 - THE CONCEPT OF DOMINANT DESIGN:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Is the main topic of an ISO Guide that addresses the coordination of SDOs.
b) Is related to the key technological features that transform a document into a de jure standard.
c) Is always based on the best user experience of technology.
d) Is related to the key technological features that become a de facto standard.

8 - EXAMPLES OF DE FACTO STANDARDS ARE:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) PDF.
b) Asynchronous communication.
c) ISO 9001.
d) HTML.

9 - REGARDING PUBLIC AND PRIVATE SDOS:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Only public SDOs may adopt de facto standards as formal standards.
b) Public SDOs are usually created by treaties.
c) Generally speaking, private SDOs are commercial companies that publish private standards.
d) Only public SDOs are eligible as recognized SDOs.

10 - THE FOLLOWING ASPECTS REFLECT GOOD PRACTICES IN STANDARDIZATION


OPENNESS:
(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Consensus.
b) Mandatory compliance with standards.
c) Respect for the intellectual property of other SDOs.
d) Transparent, well-documented standardization processes.

11 - THE FOLLOWING ARE PROS OF OPENNESS IN STANDARDIZATION:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Institutions putting open standardization into practice never need to involve proprietary
technologies when developing standards.
b) Civil society will participate in the development of standards more effectively.
c) More interoperability.
d) It is an effective tool for public administrations to tackle ICT lock-in.

12 - THE FOLLOWING ARE CONS OF OPENNESS IN STANDARDIZATION:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) It may be harder to reach consensus.
b) At a certain point in time, SDOs developing open standards may need to involve proprietary
technology, which implies complex debates on how to do so.
c) It increases the ICT lock-in effect in public administrations.
d) Privacy issues are not duly considered.

89
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

13 - INDICATE WHICH OF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS ARE TRUE, REGARDING THE


CLASSIFICATION OF ICT STANDARDS:
(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) The ITU-T Recommendation I.112. Vocabulary of terms for ISDNs belongs to the "terminology
standards" category.
b) The standard ISO/IEC 24800-4 File format for metadata embedded in image data (JPEG and
JPEG 2000) belongs to the "System management standards" category.
c) The UML specification belongs to the "Communication reference models" category.
d) The 802.3 IEEE Standard for Ethernet belongs to the "software and networking" category.

14 - REGARDING VERTICAL AND HORIZONTAL STANDARDS:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) The ISO/IEC 27001 standards on information security management are vertical standards.
b) The ETSI GSM family of standards are an example of horizontal standards.
c) The smart grid standards belong to the category of vertical standards.
d) The standards applicable to the food and drink industry are horizontal standards.

15 - REGARDING INTERNATIONAL, REGIONAL AND NATIONAL SDOS:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) Regional organizations may be represented in international SDOs.
b) National SDOs may not be represented in international SDOs.
c) Standards published by an official regional SDO cannot ever be adopted beyond the scope of
the region where that SDO is officially recognized.
d) ISO and ITU are international organizations with a worldwide scope.

16 - REGARDING COORDINATION AMONG DIFFERENT LEVELS OF STANDARDIZATION:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) International standardization takes precedence over regional standardization.
b) National standardization takes precedence over regional standardization.
c) Regional standardization takes precedence over national standardization.
d) Regional standardization takes precedence over international standardization.

17 - REGARDING COORDINATION AMONG DIFFERENT LEVELS OF STANDARDIZATION:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) Agreements among the corresponding SDOs make it possible for approved international
standards to be adopted as regional standards, and then as national standards.
b) Agreements tend to recognize that standardization at a narrower scope may have particular
needs that need to be considered when adopting standards with a wider scope.
c) Approved international standards are usually adopted as regional standards, and then as national
standards.
d) Approved national standards are simultaneously adopted as regional standards, and then as
international standards.

90
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

18 - ABOUT THE STANDSTILL CONCEPT:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) It is a process through which national standards are approved as international standards.
b) It is the process through which SDOs are officially recognized by the European Commission.
c) It entails an obligation for national SDOs not to take any action that could prejudice European
standard harmonization.
d) It is a tool to support coordination between European and national standardization activities.

19 - REGARDING THE PROCESS OF COORDINATION AMONG EUROPEAN AND NATIONAL


SDOS:
(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) Once a European standard is approved, conflicting national standards are withdrawn.
b) First, national SDOs submit their contributions or national perspectives on the standard’s topic
and scope; these contributions inform the drafting of the first version of the European standard,
which is undertaken by the European SDO.
c) European SDOs translate the approved EN into the languages of all of the nations where the
standard is adopted.
d) First, a standardization group within a technical committee of a European SDO drafts the
document, then national SDOs submit their votes and comments about the draft.

20 - THE VIENNA AGREEMENT:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) Establishes that international standards are simultaneously approved as European standards.
b) Establishes that any pre-existing conflicting national standards must be withdrawn.
c) Recognizes that the European Single Market may have particular needs.
d) Was signed between ITU and ETSI, and underlines the fact that international standardization
takes precedence over national standardization.

21 - AS A RESULT OF THE FRANKFURT AGREEMENT:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) Around 80% of all European electrotechnical standards are identical to or based on IEC
International Standards.
b) New electrical standards projects are jointly planned between CENELEC and IEC.
c) All European electrotechnical standards are identical to or based on IEC International Standards.
d) All European electrotechnical standards are identical to or based on ISO International Standards

22 - WHAT IS THE PROCEDURE USED TO RELEASE AN INDUSTRIAL SPECIFICATION AS A


FORMAL STANDARD?
(See Section 3.3 for hints)
a) Adoption
b) Transposition
c) Publicly available specification
d) Regulation

91
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

23 - WHAT IS THE AVERAGE PROPORTION OF EUROPEAN STANDARDS IN AN EU COUNTRY?


(See Section 3.3 for hints)
a) Less than 10%
b) Between 10% and 50%
c) Between 50% and 90%
d) More than 90%

24 - REGARDING NORMATIVE AND INFORMATIVE STANDARDIZATION DOCUMENTS:


(See Section 3.4 for hints)
a) Normative documents contain requirements, which must be met in order to claim compliance
with the standard.
b) Requirements in a standard are usually worded with the term "must".
c) Informative documents contain information and requirements.
d) The term "should" is used to include recommendations

25 - THE NAME ETSI ES 201 873-11 V4.7.1 (2017-06) GIVES THE READER THE FOLLOWING
INFORMATION ABOUT THE STANDARDIZATION DOCUMENT:
(See Section 3.5 for hints)
a) It is part of a family of standards.
b) It is a European Standard.
c) It needs to be revised before June 2019.
d) It has been approved by ETSI.

26 - THE NAME NF EN ISO/IEC 15416 AUGUST 2003 GIVES THE READER THE FOLLOWING
INFORMATION ABOUT THE STANDARDIZATION DOCUMENT:
(See Section 3.5 for hints)
a) It has been previously approved by ISO/IEC.
b) The document was originally approved as an International Standard, then as a European
Standard, and then as a National Standard.
c) It is document 416 within the 15000 family of standards.
d) It was published in 2003.

➜➜ SOLUTIONS PAGE 246

92
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

3.9 GLOSSARY
■■ Alliance: Organization gathering companies operating in the same domain, which gather to achieve
a common objective, e.g. the production of specifications for a specific technology.
■■ Directive (European Union): A directive is a legal act of the European Union that requires member
states to achieve a particular result without dictating the means of achieving that result.
■■ Drafting: Iterative writing of the different clauses of a draft standard.
■■ Guide: Documents used by standards organizations for guidance on how to handle specific technical
standardization activities.
■■ Specification: Set of rules that competing products must comply with to enable their interoperability.
■■ Standardization stakeholder: Parties impacted by the publication of standards, e.g., corporate
organizations, user groups or national authorities.
■■ Technical body: Generic term designating technical committees, sub-committees and working
groups that bring together delegates to produce standards.

93
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

3.10 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS


■■ 3GPP: Third Generation Partnership ■■ EN: European Standard
Project ■■ EPC: Evolved Packet Core
■■ AFNOR: Association Française de ■■ ES: ETSI Standard
Normalisation (French Standards
■■ ESO: European Standards Organization
Association)
■■ ETSI: European Telecommunication
■■ ANSI: American National Standards
Standards Institute
Institute
■■ EU: European Union
■■ API: Application Programming Interface
■■ FIN: Finance
■■ ARIB: Association of Radio Industries and
■■ FTC: Federal Trade Commission
Businesses
■■ FTP: File Transfer Protocol
■■ ATIS: Alliance for Telecommunications
Industry Solutions ■■ GA: General Assembly
■■ BIS: Bureau of Indian Standards ■■ GSC: Global Standards Collaboration
■■ BS: British Standard ■■ GSMA: Global System for Mobile
Communications (GSM) Association
■■ BSI: British Standards Institution
■■ HEN: Harmonized European Standard
■■ C2C-CC: Car to Car—Communication
Consortium ■■ HGI: Home Gateway Initiative
■■ CA: Conseil d’Administration ■■ HL7: Health Level Seven
(Administrative Board) ■■ HTML: HyperText Markup Language
■■ CCC: Car Connectivity Consortium ■■ IAB: Internet Architecture Board
■■ CE (Marking): Conformité Européenne ■■ IANA: Internet Assigned Numbers Authority
(European Conformity) ■■ IASA: IETF Administrative Support Activity
■■ CEN: Comité Européen de Normalisation ■■ ICT: Information and Communication
(European Committee for Standardization) Technology
■■ CENELEC: European Committee for ■■ I-D: Internet-Draft
Electrotechnical Standardization ■■ IEC: International Electrotechnical
■■ CSC: Council Standing Committee Commission
■■ CEPT: Conférence Européenne des Postes ■■ IEEE: Institute of Electrical and Electronics
et des Télécommunications Engineers
■■ CWA: CEN Workshop Agreement ■■ IESG: Internet Engineering Steering Group
■■ DIN: German Institute for Standardization ■■ IETF: Internet Engineering Task Force
■■ EC: European Commission ■■ IM: Instant Messaging
■■ ECC: Electronic Communications ■■ IPR: Intellectual Property Rights
Committee ■■ IRTF: Internet Research Task Force
■■ EEA: European Economic Area ■■ IRSG: Internet Research Steering Group
■■ ETFA: European Free Trade Association ■■ IS: International Standard
■■ EM: Electromagnetic Compatibility ■■ ISO: International Organization for
■■ EMCD: Electromagnetic Compatibility Standardization
Directive

94
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

■■ ISO/IEC JTC 1: Joint technical committee ■■ PDF: Portable Document Format


1 of ISO/IEC ■■ PT: Project Team
■■ ISOC: Internet Society ■■ RED: Radio Equipment Directive
■■ ISO/CS: ISO Central Secretariat ■■ RFC: Request for Comments
■■ IT: Information Technology ■■ RSC: Radio Spectrum Committee
■■ ITS: Intelligent Transport System ■■ SC: Sub-Committee
■■ ITU: International Telecommunication Union ■■ SDO: Standards Development Organization
■■ ITU-T: International Telecommunication ■■ SE: Standardization Expert
Union—Telecommunication Sector
■■ SME: Small or Medium-sized Enterprise
■■ IVI: In-Vehicle Infotainment
■■ SPC: Strategy and Policy Committee
■■ IWA: ISO Workshop Agreement.
■■ Std: Standard
■■ JTC: Joint Technical Committee
■■ TBT: Technical Barriers to Trade
■■ LTE: Long Term Evolution
■■ TC: Technical Committee
■■ LVD: Low-Voltage Directive
■■ TR: Technical Report
■■ M2M: Machine-to-Machine
■■ TS: Technical Specification
■■ MoU: Memorandum of Understanding
■■ TSG: Technical Specification Group
■■ NIST: National Institute of Standards and
■■ TV: Television
Technology
■■ UML: Unified Modelling Language
■■ NSO: National Standards Organization
■■ UNE: Spanish Association for
■■ OASIS: Not-for-profit consortium, the
Standardization
acronym stands for Advancing Open
■■ US: United States
Standards for the Information Society
■■ W3C: World Wide Web Consortium
■■ OEM: Original Equipment Manufacturer
■■ WCAG: Web Content Accessibility
■■ OJEU: Official Journal of the European
Guidelines
Union
■■ WG: Working Group
■■ OMG: Object Management Group
■■ WI: Work Item
■■ PAS: Publicly Available Specifications
■■ WLAN: Wireless Local Area Network
■■ PAS (ISO): ISO Publicly Available
Specification ■■ WS-Security: Microsoft Web Services
Security specification
■■ PASC: Pacific Area Standardization
Conference ■■ WSP: Wireless Short-Packet (protocol)
■■ WTO: World Trade Organization

95
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

3.11 REFERENCES
✚✚ 3GPP (1998). Third Generation Partnership Project (3GPP) Partnership Project Description, December
1998.
http://www.3gpp.org/ftp/Inbox/2008_web_files/3GPP.ppt. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚✚ 3GPP (2017). Technical Specification Group working methods. Technical Report. TR 21.900.
✚✚ Abernathy, W. J., & Utterback, J. M. (1978). Patterns of innovation in technology. Technology Review, 80(7),
1–47.
✚✚ Beeler GW. (1998). HL7 version 3--An object-oriented methodology for collaborative standards
development. International Journal of Medical Informatics. February 1998 (pp. 151–161).
✚✚ Biddle, B., White, A., & Woods, S. (2010). How Many Standards in a Laptop? (And Other Empirical
Questions). ITU-T Kaleidoscope: Beyond the Internet? - Innovations for Future Networks and Services.
September 2010 (pp. 1-7).
✚✚ Breitenberg, M. (2009). The ABC’s of Standards Activities. Report NISTIR 7614, NIST, August 2009. https://
www.nist.gov/document/abcs-standards-activities. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚✚ BSI. (2017). European standards and the UK. BSI.
https://www.bsigroup.com/LocalFiles/en-GB/EUREF.pdf
✚✚ Carnahan L. & Phelps A. (2018). ABC’s of Conformity Assessment. NIST Special Publication 2000-01, NIST,
Draft under comment.
https://www.nist.gov/file/416646. Accessed 15 January 2018.
✚✚ CCC (2016). Car Connectivity Consortium.
http://carconnectivity.org. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚✚ CEN. (2016). Implementation of European Standards - ENs not corresponding to national standards on a
one-to-one basis. CEN.
https://boss.cen.eu/reference%20material/guidancedoc/pages/impl.aspx
✚✚ CEN. (n.d.). CWA - CEN Workshop Agreement.
https://www.cen.eu/work/products/CWA/Pages/default.aspx
✚✚ CEN, CENELEC. (2008). CEN/CENELEC Guide 12. The concept of affiliation with CEN and CENELEC.
CEN, CENELEC.
✚✚ CEN-CENELEC (2017). Common Rules for Standardisation Work. Internal Regulations, Part 2, February
2017.
✚✚ Cerri, D., & Fuggetta, A. (2007). Open standards, open formats, and open source. Journal of systems and
software, 80(11), 1930–1937.
✚✚ Dardailler, D., & Jacobs, I. (2012). W3C Self-Evaluation of OpenStand Principles.
https://www.w3.org/2012/08/open-stand-w3c.html. Accessed 6 February 2018
✚✚ de Vries, H. J. D. (2006). IT Standards Typology.
http://services.igi-global.com/resolvedoi/resolve.aspx?doi=10.4018/978-1-59140-938-0.ch001, 1–26.
doi:10.4018/978-1-59140-938-0.ch001

96
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

✚✚ de Vries, H. (2006). Advanced Topics in Information Technology Standards and Standardisation Research,
Volume 1. Hershey, PA: IGI Global. IT Standards Typology (pp. 1-26). DOI: 10.4018/978-1-59140-938-0.
ch001.
✚✚ Delaney, H. & van de Zande, R. (2000). A Guide to EU Standards and Conformity Assessment. Global
Standards Program, Office of Standards Services, National Institute of Standards and Technology, Order
No. 43 NANB912297, May 2000.
✚✚ Direction Generale des Entreprises (2016). Guide relatif au bon usage de la normalisation dans la
réglementation. June 2016.
https://www.entreprises.gouv.fr/files/files/guides/guide-pratique-du-bon-usage-de-la-normalisation-dans-la-
reglementation.pdf. Accessed 9 January 2018.
✚✚ EnOcean (2017). EnOcean Wireless Standard.
https://www.enocean-alliance.org/what-is-enocean/enocean-wireless-standard. Accessed 15 November
2017.
✚✚ ETSI. (2015). NSO’s Guide. ETSI. 
✚✚ ETSI. (2016). Version numbering system. ETSI.
https://portal.etsi.org/Services/editHelp!/Howtostart/Documentproceduresandtypes/
Versionnumberingsystem.aspx
✚✚ ETSI. (n.d.). Different types of ETSI standards. ETSI.
https://www.cen.eu/work/products/CWA/Pages/default.aspx
✚✚ ETSI (2013). A Guide to Writing World Class Standards,
http://www.etsi.org/standards/how-does-etsi-make-standards. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚✚ ETSI. (2015). NSO’s Guide. ETSI.
https://portal.etsi.org/Portals/0/TBpages/nso/Docs/NSOs_guide.pdf
✚✚ ETSI. (2016). SmartM2M; IoT Standards landscape and future evolutions. Technical Report TR 103 375.
✚✚ ETSI. (2016) Home Gateway Initiative smart home specifications published by ETSI, ETSI Press Release,
November 2016.
Available at http://www.etsi.org/news-events/news/1150-2016-11-home-gateway-initiative-smart-home-
specifications-published-by-etsi. Accessed 15 January 2018.
✚✚ ETSI (2018). Harmonised Standards for the RED and EMC Directives.
http://www.etsi.org/standards/looking-for-an-etsi-standard/harmonised-standards. Accessed 17 July 2018.
✚✚ ETSI (2017). Publicly Available Specifications (PAS).
http://www.etsi.org/about/what-we-do/publicly-available-specifications-pas. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚✚ ETSI-ECC (2016). The European regulatory environment for radio equipment and spectrum, an introduction.
Version 2.1, July 2016.
✚✚ European Commission (2005). Information Society and Standards: Linking European Policies, European
Commission. Document KK-65-05-529-EN-D.

97
CHAPTER 3 - The standards ecosystem

✚✚ European Commission. (2013). COM(2013) 455 final. Against lock-in: building open ICT systems by making
better use of standards in public procurement.
http://ec.europa.eu/newsroom/dae/document.cfm?doc_id=2327
✚✚ European Commission (2018). CE Marking.
https://ec.europa.eu/growth/single-market/ce-marking_en. Accessed 17 July 2018.
✚✚ European Commission (2018). Harmonised standards.
http://ec.europa.eu/growth/single-market/european-standards/harmonised-standards. Accessed 17 July
2018.
✚✚ European Union (2014). Radio Equipment Directive. "Directive of the European Parliament and of the
Council of 16 April 2014 on the on the harmonisation of the laws of the Member States relating to the
making available on the market of radio equipment and repealing Directive 1999/5/EC". Directive 2014/53/
EU. April 2014.
Available at http://eur-lex.europa.eu/legal-content/EN/TXT/PDF/?uri=CELEX:32014L0053&from=EN.
Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚✚ European Union (2018). Regulations, Directives and other acts.
https://europa.eu/european-union/eu-law/legal-acts_en. Accessed 17 July 2018.
✚✚ Galasso, G. (2015). Open standards for ICT procurement: evidences from the ICT Procurement survey.
PWC.
https://joinup.ec.europa.eu/sites/default/files/inline-files/07_Giovanna_Galasso.pdf
✚✚ Hatto, P. (2013). Standards and standardisation: A practical guide for researchers. European Commission,
Publications Office of the European Union.
✚✚ HGI (2016). Home Gateway Initiative web site.
http://www.homegatewayinitiative.org. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚✚ Government of India (2016). Discussion paper on standard essential patents and their availability on FRAND
terms. Department of Industrial Policy and Promotion, Ministry of Commerce & Industry, March 2016.
✚✚ IEC, & CENELEC. (2016). IEC - CENELEC Frankfurt Agreement. IEC-CENELEC.
http://www.iec.ch/about/globalreach/partners/pdf/IEC-CENELEC_Frankfurt_Agreement%7B2016%7D.pdf
✚✚ ISO. (n.d.). ISO deliverables. ISO.
https://www.iso.org/deliverables-all.html
✚✚ ISO, & CEN. (2001). The Agreement on technical cooperation between ISO and CEN (Vienna Agreement).
ISO-CEN.
https://isotc.iso.org/livelink/livelink?func=ll&objId=4230458&objAction=browse&sort=subtype
✚✚ ISO, & CEN. (2016). The Vienna Agreement FAQs. ISO-CEN.
https://boss.cen.eu/ref/VA_FAQ.pdf
✚✚ ISO, & IEC. (n.d.). ISO/IEC JTC 1 — Information Technology. ISO-IEC.
https://www.iso.org/isoiec-jtc-1.html
✚✚ ISO (2016). ISO in brief.
https://www.iso.org/publication/PUB100007.html. Accessed 15 November 2017.

98
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

✚✚ ISO, & IEC. (n.d.). ISO/IEC JTC 1 — Information Technology. ISO-IEC.


https://www.iso.org/isoiec-jtc-1.html
✚✚ ISO/IEC JTC1 (2017). Buy Standards.
https://jtc1info.org/page-2/buy-standards/. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚✚ ITU and infoDev (2018). ICT Regulation Toolkit.
http://www.ictregulationtoolkit.org. Accessed 17 July 2018.
✚✚ ITU, & ETSI. (2016). Memorandum of understanding between ETSI and ITU. ITU-ETSI.
https://www.itu.int/en/ITU-T/extcoop/Documents/mou/MoU-ETSI-ITU-201605.pdf
✚✚ ITU, & ISO/IEC. (2014). A.23 : Guide for ITU-T and ISO/IEC JTC 1 cooperation. ITU-ISO/IEC.
https://www.itu.int/rec/T-REC-A.23-201406-I%21AnnA
✚✚ Jakobs, K. (2008). ICT standardisation - coordinating the diversity. In 2008 First ITU-T Kaleidoscope
Academic Conference - Innovations in NGN: Future Network and Services (pp. 119–126). doi:10.1109/
KINGN.2008.4542257
✚✚ JISC (2013). Japan’s Standardization Policy 2013. Japanese Industrial Standards Committee Secretariat,
Ministry of Economy, Trade and Industry, March 2013.
✚✚ Maxwell, E. (2006). Open Standards, Open Source, and Open Innovation: Harnessing the Benefits
of Openness. Innovations: Technology, Governance, Globalization, 1(3), 119–176. doi:10.1162/
itgg.2006.1.3.119
✚✚ NIST (2013). Comments of the Telecommunications Industry Association to the National Institute of
Standards and Technology on Developing a Framework to Improve Critical Infrastructure. Cybersecurity,
NIST Docket Number 130208119–3119–01.
✚✚ Sharpe, M. (2016). Identifying Spectrum Needs for Future Radio Systems. Workshop "From Research to
Standardization", ETSI, France.
✚✚ SPF (Service public fédéral) Economie belge (2017). Référer aux normes dans les réglementations
techniques - Découvrez les avantages! May 2017.
http://economie.fgov.be/fr/binaries/Referer-aux-normes-dans-les-reglementations-techniques_tcm326-
282895.pdf. Accessed 9 January 2018.
✚✚ Wi-Fi (2017). Certification: Wi-Fi Test Suite.
http://www.wi-fi.org/certification/wi-fi-test-suite. Accessed 15 November 2017.

99
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

4 THE PRODUCTION OF STANDARDS

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
Regarding the standardization scene, students should understand the development process and
methodology for producing high-quality standards. Important concepts, such as consensus, and guiding
principles, such as fairness, which are applied during the different phases of standard writing, are presented
in this section. Students should be able to identify the most important management and administration
bodies and roles in SDOs, such as the technical management board, chief executive officer, and the most
important parties in the project organization, as well as in technical committees, for instance the chairman
of a committee. By the end of the section, they should know how to initiate a new standard and how to
become a member of an SDO.
As for the roles and competencies of a standardization expert, students should know and understand the
most relevant skills that make an efficient delegate of a technical body (in the context of active participation
in standardization). This section should serve as a basis for students to develop the necessary skills of a
delegate.
When addressing the activities of a standardization expert, students should learn the main tasks that a
standardization expert has to perform during standardization meetings, between standardization meetings
and inside his company. They should know how to cooperate with different company departments (e.g.
marketing, sales) to achieve the most out of standardization. Furthermore, students should understand the
additional duties of a national SDO delegate.

The standardization scene


An example of a standardization process (e.g. CEN/CENELEC) will be provided, and all of the key stages,
events and outcomes will be described by means of a timeline. The students will gain knowledge about
the structure and organization of an SDO as well as all of the key internal players, together with their tasks
and responsibilities. Concerning the standardization process, the composition of the working group (e.g.
companies, academics, users and further external stakeholders) will be discussed. Further concepts such
as consensus and other important guiding principles and rules in the standardization process are explained.
In addition, other areas/concepts surrounding the standards development process (e.g. implementation,
adoption, usage, technology and standard updates) will be explained.

Roles and competencies of a standardization expert


The notion of "standardization expert" is introduced as the general concept of an individual active in
standardization tasks. The relevant technical competencies, experience and soft skills are discussed and
linked to the tasks of a member of an organization actively participating in standardization. The tools used to
execute these tasks are also introduced.

Activities of a standardization expert


The main tasks of a standardization expert are explained. These include e.g., coordination of internal and
external standardization activities, preparation of draft documents and requests for national and international
standardization together with subject matter experts (inside an organization), tracking and monitoring of
external standardization deadlines, ensuring the approval of new standards, managing the internal repository
of standards and the communication of the standardization work inside the company, quality management
tasks, and improvement of all the processes in this area. These tasks are also discussed for representatives
of organization types other than industry, such as academia researchers or national organization delegates.

100
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

4.1 INTRODUCTION
This chapter addresses several topics related to the development and methodology used to produce
formal standards of high quality. It first sets the standardization scene by introducing the underlying code of
good practice of formal standardization and the different criteria that should be satisfied to ensure the high
quality of a standard. The process of producing standards is described in detail and illustrated with several
examples of different methodologies, as well as the organization of SDOs that are responsible for providing
a suitable environment. As standards are written by standardization experts, this chapter describes their
roles in the standardization process as well as the technical and personal skills that enable them to carry out
their daily tasks. Finally, this chapter presents the main activities and duties of standardization experts and
how they interact with their peers, both inside the standardization group and within their own organization.

4.2 THE STANDARDIZATION SCENE

4.2.1 INTRODUCTION
A standard describes technical solutions, and its preparation strongly depends on organizational aspects
and social ramifications. To prepare a good and fair standard, some fundamental principles and quality
requirements should be respected. Some of them have already been described in Section2.4.2, "Main
characteristics of a standard", for example clarity of the content. Nevertheless, other criteria should be
fulfilled as well: openness, transparency, impartiality, consensus, relevance to market needs, and avoiding
duplication and competition among SDOs. These criteria are presented in the first part of this section.
Indeed, the implementation of standards is voluntary and all the above characteristics can help increase
their level of adoption.
Different steps allow the comprehensive standardization of a technology, a function or a system. These
steps are usually documented in either dedicated or more integrated documents. Such documents range
from feasibility study reports to testing specifications. The production of a standard follows a well-defined
procedure that may vary, depending on SDO policies. Generally, the procedure covers activities starting
from inception and ending in the publication and maintenance of a document. These activities are described
in the second part of this section.
SDOs are organizations with a well-defined structure designed to manage and administer the activities
of their members. Becoming a member of an SDO requires a set of rules to be followed, which vary
depending on the organization. The way SDOs are governed, including the internal organization of a
technical committee, is described in the last part of this section. Knowledge of governance is essential for
success in standardization.

101
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

4.2.2 CODE OF GOOD PRACTICE FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OF INTERNATIONAL


STANDARDS
Standardization is based on a set of fundamental principles and mechanisms to foster the production of
fair standards. These principles have been identified by the World Trade Organization’s (WTO) Committee
of Technical Barriers to Trade (TBT) (WTO 2000) and are fulfilled by the recognized SDOs. Other SDOs
tend to apply these principles in their methodology as well. The principles cover notions such as openness,
transparency, impartiality, consensus, efficiency, relevance, development, and coherence. Respecting
these principles is especially important for standards to be referenced by regulations. This explains why
authorities often prefer to mandate and use standards published by recognized SDOs, which fully adhere
to these principles. Indeed, industrial alliances have their own set of rules and usually prefer the faster
adoption of their specifications, as compared to SDO standards. Membership and participation of experts
are restricted to a specific industry group (Jakobs 2008), which results in a lower level of enforcement of
fundamental principles such as openness and transparency.
In the following sections, we describe these principles, policies and best practices. Furthermore, we give a
broader view of how these principles may be circumvented to serve specific interests.

OPENNESS
As previously mentioned, open standards are made available to the general public and are developed
(or approved) and maintained via a collaborative and consensus-driven process (ITU-T 2017b). Open
standards facilitate interoperability and data exchange among different products or services and are
intended for widespread adoption.
Openness also means that the standardization process is easily accessible to any interested stakeholder at
all stages, from policy development and draft submission, to adoption and dissemination of the standards.
The SDO work programme is published, together with the list of standards under development, and kept
updated. New standard proposals announce their precise scope and objectives.
Industry fora/consortia may disregard this principle and have closed meetings and membership restricted
only to companies with a specific industry interest. Access to the standards, whether under development
or even approved, is then limited to paying members only. In contrast, recognized SDOs often offer access
to their approved standards for a small fee or even for free.

TRANSPARENCY
Transparency is achieved if the draft standard is made available to all of the working group members
throughout its development steps with sufficient time to give them the opportunity to submit comments.
Transparency implies that these comments will be collected, taken into account and discussed. Transparency
also means that notification of standard proposals is given at an early stage, that approved standards are
published in a timely manner after their adoption and that a monitoring system is set up to periodically
verify the status of the different standards. The policies adopted for the governance and activities of the
organization, as well as the rules of the standards development process should be easily available to all the
members and users of the standard.
However, in real life, a standard may well be put forward for approval at very short notice, with little notification
given to peer working group members, who are deprived of the opportunity to read and carefully analyse
the document prior to its approval.

102
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

IMPARTIALITY
An impartial process is managed by a group of diverse stakeholders with varied interests so that the group
avoids being influenced, for instance by funding or by an interest group.
SDO rules grant identical basic rights to all participants of standardization work, although special additional
rights may be granted in specific cases. Any interested party directly or indirectly affected by the activity
is able to propose a new standard, submit comments and contributions at any stage of the development
process, and express its views or ask for the revision of an outdated document.
On this matter, Intellectual Property Rights (IPR), such as patents, are a very sensitive topic and recognized
SDOs often require that known IPRs be declared as early as possible, in order to be able to take appropriate
action, such as selecting another technology or ensuring fair and reasonable terms and licensing conditions
for all implementers/users.
However, it might be possible for a standard is proposed purely to satisfy the interests of a particular
supplier or governmental entity. Alternatively, a major player who dominates the market might be reluctant
to have any standard at all and might try to slow down the process by adopting a difficult and demanding
attitude.

EQUITY
A balanced standardization process is achieved if all representatives are allowed to express their positions
and comments, and every representative’s opinion is considered.
The development process does not favour the interests of a specific provider, country or region. The
platform used for standards development is neutral and equally accessible to all parties. All interests are
taken into account, whether they are private or public, economical, societal or environmental. Committee
officials are required to adopt a neutral position in their tasks.
It might happen, however, that the valid opinion of a participant is noted and not further considered because
it hampers the objectives of a specific interest group.

CONSENSUS
Consensus is obtained if a standard is approved by a large majority of the group of stakeholders. Every
effort is made to reach unanimity. The views of all stakeholders are taken into account, even when they are
diverging, and they generally agree to the resulting publication; no sustained opposition is expressed on a
substantial issue. SDO development rules aim to reconcile conflicting opinions, including a fair mechanism
for raising objections and enabling discussions until a large majority of the participants can achieve an
acceptable compromise. Tough negotiations often occur in parallel and outside of official SDO meetings.
In any case, consensus does not necessarily mean unanimity. Consensus may be achieved, for example,
through a voting process. This depends on the SDO’s established procedures.
In practice, actions might be taken to silence the objections of one or a group of stakeholders, for example
by providing the final version at very short notice, which facilitates the adoption of a disputed standard.
Groups of members might block approval by unexpectedly bringing many "rarely participating" members
into a voting situation.

103
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

EFFECTIVENESS
Standards should be developed only when it has been proven that implementation is feasible and
appropriate, based on existing technological capabilities. Standards requiring performance indicators from
the technology or specifying interfaces between entities are considered more efficient than descriptive or
design standards. Moreover, the high quality of standards ready to be published is checked by independent
reviewers. Standards are revised when they become obsolete or have been identified as ineffective. In the
worst case, they are marked as deactivated.
Some standards are, however, developed to describe an emergent technology, which is not yet mature,
but whose supporters want to reach the market early and prevent the development of other competing
technologies. Because the future market and market positions are still unclear, economic interests may
favour ambiguities in that standard. It is thus good practice, when drafting a standard, to validate it with
experience from a few implementations and testing events.

RELEVANCE
Relevance means that the standard responds to regulatory and market needs. Fair standards enable
implementation by different providers and enable competition in the market. They do not try to distort the
global market and do not prevent innovation and future evolutions of technologies. Impact risk assessment
studies may help determine whether adverse effects can be expected. At the SDOs, IPR policies ensure
transparent procedures and strategy plans are periodically revised to analyse and follow the market
evolution and their stakeholders’ needs.
Nevertheless, it might happen that a stakeholder tries to develop a standard to consolidate its position in
the market. Furthermore, so-called "patent hold-up" may occur when the owner of a patented technology,
necessary to implement a standard, starts claiming ownership and fees after the approval and publication
phases are completed. In a published case, two sub-committee officers provided a misinterpretation of
the standards, which weakened the competitiveness of one of the providers. In the US, the Federal Trade
Commission (FTC) has identified examples of standards and certification documents that had the effect of
restraining trade or deceiving customers (Breitenberg 2009).

DEVELOPMENT
According to the development principle, the standardization process is open to all interested parties and
encourages the participation of developing countries. For example, the SDO Secretariat provides additional
technical assistance and capacity to contribute to the concerned delegates. The standards are neutral and
do not favour characteristics of specific countries or regions when different needs exist in other parts of the
world. Another important point is that the process remains market driven rather than regulatory driven and
does not fulfil the needs of a specific national authority.
However, it might happen in practice that, as recognized by the "Technical Barriers to Trade" (TBT)
agreement (WTO 2000), technical regulations and standards are published to protect domestic industries.

104
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

COHERENCE
When respecting the coherence principle, the work programme of an SDO and its committees avoids
duplicating the work of another SDO. The standardization contributes to the coherence of the market and
prevents the introduction of a solution that conflicts or overlaps with the standards developed in another
SDO.
In this regard, collaboration and cooperation rather than competition with other SDOs is essential. Coherence
also means that national SDOs do not develop their local standards in parallel to a regional organization.
In Europe for example, this process is called the "standstill" (CEN 2017). Cooperation can be established
at different levels, such as liaison or exchange of information between committees and/or sub-committees
(see Section 4.2.5), or creating a collaborative team shared by the two SDOs or coordination groups where
work programmes are exchanged and discussed. Partnership projects are yet another instance of such
cooperation. The projects coordinate the activities of regional SDOs and industry consortia. The best-
known example is 3GPP, which produces standards for mobile communications (see Section 4.5).
However, it might happen in the practice of standardization that SDOs or consortia are requested by
competing interest groups to work in parallel towards standards for technologies targeting the same
market. They claim to rely on the market to select the "winning" one, but in reality, they fragment it and
hinder its development. Furthermore, a large number of industrial consortia have been or are being created
in the ICT domain, which is evolving at a fast pace. Coordinating their work, in parallel to the activities of
the recognized SDOs, represents a huge challenge.

EXAMPLE
For example, the Global Standards Collaboration (GSC) group annually brings together the world’s leading
telecommunications and radio standards organizations to share work programmes and other information
in a number of technical areas.

EXAMPLE
In the US, many private and public SDOs are active in all types of ICT domains. NIST is a federal agency,
of which one of the missions is to promote innovation and competitiveness. On the other hand, ANSI
serves as the coordinator of the private sector standardization system. Both organizations have signed
a MoU, which defines their respective roles and their cooperation objective to strengthen US standards.

Finally, recognized SDOs must guarantee the viability and stability of the standardization process and
of their IT infrastructure in the long run, even at times of budget restrictions. They have to handle large
volumes of data, documents, delegates and communications. They have to ensure proper funding, while
enforcing fundamental principles such as openness and impartiality through balanced governance rules.

105
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

4.2.3 CRITERIA FOR PRODUCING GOOD STANDARDS


A standard specification is made up of a set of requirements, which guarantee compliance of the products
that implement the standard. Adhering to the main principles of standard development presented in the
previous section directly impacts the requirements introduced in the standard specification. Poorly written
standards can cause additional transaction costs, reduce product safety and quality, and create barriers to
trade (Breitenberg 2009). They can also constrain innovation, entrench inferior technologies, and prevent
the development of interoperable products and systems. Accordingly, high-quality standards should fulfil
the following set of criteria for the requirements they contain:
■■ The requirements are necessary. They specify only what is required to implement and meet the
standard’s objectives, rather than how to achieve them. They do not impose a particular approach
to implementation and rather permit the development of a variety of competing implementations of
interoperable products or services.
■■ The requirements are unambiguous. They are technically credible and it is impossible to interpret the
normative parts of the standard in more than one way. Rationale statements may be associated with
the requirements to explain the criteria used in their development and provide relevant information
to the developers.
■■ The requirements are comprehensive and accurate. This is also called inclusiveness. The requirements
are of high quality. They contain all the information necessary to understand their meaning, either
directly or by reference to other documents.
■■ The requirements are precise. They are expressed clearly and concisely, written in plain language,
without unnecessary details that might confuse readers and hinder implementation.
■■ The requirements are well structured. The individual elements of the requirement are all included in
an appropriate manner and are easy to read and understand. Normative (i.e. prescriptive) parts are
clearly differentiated from informative (i.e. descriptive) parts of the standard. Designated keywords
indicate the different requirement levels.
■■ The requirements are consistent. There is no contradiction among the different requirements within
the standard, nor with any other related standards.
■■ The requirements are validated by prototype implementations and are testable. There are clear
and obvious means of devising a test to demonstrate that an implementation complies with the
requirements.
■■ The requirements are open. The standard is available to the general public and is developed, approved
and maintained via a collaborative and consensus-driven process. Policies should ensure that
patented technology or copyrighted material has been declared and is accessible in a fair manner.
■■ The requirements are up to date. The standard is well-maintained and supported by the responsible
committee. Maintenance, evolution or withdrawal needs are regularly assessed.

106
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

4.2.4 THE PROCESS OF PRODUCING STANDARDS


This section first presents the different steps for the standardization of an ICT system. A system made of
several entities typically requires the publication of several standards, including technical reports, functional
specifications, interface specifications and testing specifications. The section later focuses on the different
steps involved for the production of one standard.
The exhaustive standardization of an ICT system usually follows a well-proven methodology that includes
several stages, first described in ITU Recommendation I.130 (ITU-T 1988) and shown in Figure 4.1 below.

May not be
mandatory

Technical Report
Concept with results from preliminary
tests, simulations, recommendations
for specifications

May be
integrated
in a single
standard
document

Service Functional Detailed Requirements


description model specification for testing
attributes and architecture, flows, protocols, and
flow diagrams; actions of interfaces, format conformity
requirements at functional entities, of parameters,
service level service nodes
assessment
allocation to
physical entities

Figure 4.1: Typical methodology for the standardization of an ICT system

The purpose of the ITU Recommendation is to provide a method for the development of protocol and service
standards as well as to define the network capabilities needed. It promotes a systematic development
process. Its main objectives are to give a common framework and tools to be adopted for the service
description and to show how protocols and network resources for providing such services can be defined.
The design process is divided into three stages of activity, typically resulting in a corresponding series of
specifications.

107
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

Stage 1 is a general description of the service and objectives from the user’s perspective but does not
go into detail about the human-machine interface itself. It includes a description of the service in terms of
the perceptions of users receiving or involved in the service, a static description of the service using its
attributes, and a dynamic description of the service using flow charts, e.g., presenting all the information
that is sent to and received by the user, from activation to completion of the service.
Stage 2 develops a functional model to meet those objectives. It identifies the architecture and functional
capabilities as well as the information flows needed to support the service as described in stage 1. A
functional model is derived for each service element. The functions required to provide the service are
grouped into functional entities. Information flow diagrams are created for successful operation and may be
drawn as appropriate for other cases. The semantic meaning and information content of each information
flow is determined. The actions performed within a functional entity are represented as a list or as a
sequence of functional entity actions. The functional entities and information flows identified in previous
steps are allocated to physical entities.
Stage 3 develops a specification of the detailed implementation requirements. The information flows
obtained from stage 2 form the basis for producing detailed specifications, including the messages needed
to support these information flows as well as their detailed message elements and procedures. Stage 3
clearly lists the requirements applied to each specific function (functional entity actions).
Moreover, it is common practice to publish test specifications or conformance test suites for each of
the standards developed in stage 3, directly derived from the requirements in the standard. They are
particularly helpful for the specification developers and need to be available by the time the standard is
implemented in commercial products.
Later groups have added a preliminary stage to the ITU Recommendation, consisting of a technical study
to evaluate the different options for and feasibility of the features to be developed, using results from
the preliminary proof of concept and simulations, and to provide recommendations for the system to be
standardized. The ITU Recommendation has been taken as a reference by many groups developing ICT
systems.

STANDARDIZATION PROCESS, FROM INCEPTION TO PUBLICATION


The development of a standard follows a well-defined procedure that can be more or less formal depending
on the type of organization. For instance, a standard developed by an industrial alliance is often written and
published faster than a standard produced by a recognized SDO. Some SDOs (e.g. ISO) distinguish the
phases in the standards development process by attributing tags to documents to indicate their degree of
maturity.
The main phases of this procedure were introduced in Section 2.4, which provided an overview of the
standardization process. There are five phases: inception, conception, drafting, approval and maintenance.
These phases are presented again in Figure 4.2 below, which is reproduced from Chapter 2. The following
section explains the top-down approach for the standards development phases. The bottom-up approach
is presented in the IETF example, followed by a description of other possible models, based on an object-
oriented approach or on implementation.

108
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Identify needs Define scope and work plan Elaborate new or revised standards

Inception Conception Drafting

Obsolete superseded standards Officially issue new or revised standards

Obsolesence Approval

Figure 4.2: Overview of the standardization process

PHASE 1: INCEPTION TO IDENTIFY NEEDS


The process starts when a group of SDO members identifies the need for a concept or process to be
standardized, or for a standard to be updated. They find other interested delegates who can help focus
the scope and convince the committee that the project is worthwhile. In effect, a standard is a result of the
collaboration and consensus of a group. The tasks related to the proposed standard need to be identified
and submitted to the relevant committee. The state of maturity of the technology to be specified has to
be verified. A standard produced too early for an emergent technology may quickly become out of date
because there is little certainty about how the technology will develop, and the scope cannot be precise
enough, whereas a standard that is published too late risks being ignored in favour of earlier, competing
standards or proprietary solutions.

PHASE 2: CONCEPTION TO DEFINE THE SCOPE AND WORK PLAN


The group of initiators submits the proposal for new standardization work to the best-suited technical
body, using the appropriate form, and tries to trigger its interest. It prepares a document with a proposal
including a clear scope describing the purpose of the target document, an estimated schedule with realistic
milestones to track its progress, a named Standardization Expert (SE) who is knowledgeable about the
topic and put forward as document editor or rapporteur, as well as a sufficiently complete list of committed
supporting members. The presentation of the project includes insights on the proposed work and its
technical content.
The committee endorses the proposal as a work objective if it considers that the standard is really valuable,
or objects to the continuation of the process if certain criteria are not met. Once approved, it carefully
considers how to pursue the work, particularly which sub-committee or project team will be in charge and
what type of standard to create, based on the relevant information received. A new Work Item (WI) is then
included in the committee and in the SDO work programme.

109
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

PHASE 3: DRAFTING TO PREPARE THE NEW OR REVISED STANDARD.


The rapporteur prepares an outline of the document, describing all of the sections, i.e. the structure of the
final document. S/he distributes the work among contributors, who volunteer to write the clauses of the
outline, and later collects the contributions from interested organizations. The different contributions are
gathered in a draft standard, which should reflect the group’s decisions.
Specific drafting meetings may be needed to review and discuss details of the content. An early review of
the outline and of the draft document may be used to identify and solve potential conflicts at an early stage.
Successive versions are circulated until the delegates agree on the content. IPRs should also be declared
at an early stage to ensure that the standard is developed with a technology that is fairly accessible to all
implementers.
Test development, implementations, prototypes and field tests of the standard should be run in parallel to
its drafting. Implementers can then provide useful feedback about the standard to its developers, including
extensions, guidelines and best practices to avoid inconsistencies and ambiguities. Some SDOs organize
interoperability events, where providers interconnect prototypes and check for inconsistencies as well as
conformance to requirements. The more stable the standards are, the more valuable they are and the more
suited they are to repeated use.
At this stage, the draft usually remains internal to the sub-committee or project group and is not distributed
or published externally, but this depends on the SDO. Milestones are periodically and carefully screened
to ensure that deadlines are respected, in order to meet the market needs and keep the resources spent
at a reasonable level.

PHASE 4: APPROVAL TO ACHIEVE CONSENSUS ON THE DRAFT STANDARD.


When the draft is ready in a stable form, it is circulated within the sub-committee for comments. Raised
issues may be tracked separately to monitor their resolution. Change requests and comments are analysed
and evaluated, and their follow-up is integrated into the document. Resolution meetings and an iterative
process may be needed to achieve agreement on the content of the draft.
The final version of the draft is submitted for approval to the sub-committee and, if applicable, shared
with the parent committee. A period of time (often called ballot) is allocated to the committee members to
review the latest version of the document and make their decision: approve, comment, oppose or abstain.
The final approval decision can be obtained during a meeting or using electronic tools. The objective is to
reach a unanimous agreement or, if not possible, at least consensus. If this cannot be achieved either, a
vote is organized, while the sustained opposition from some of the committee members is recorded for
later referral.
Once approved, the draft is sent for final editing and quality check procedures. The final editor ensures
correct formulation and presentation of the text in accordance with the SDO rules, including linguistic
quality. Only editorial corrections are made at this stage, in collaboration with the rapporteur and selected
members of the drafting group. No technical updates can be made. Once this is achieved, the document
is sent for publication as a standard.

110
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

PHASE 5: STANDARD MAINTENANCE TO UPDATE, EVOLVE OR WITHDRAW STANDARD


CONTENT.
Standards have to be kept updated in order to ensure that they remain relevant in the context of changing
market or regulatory needs, and new scientific and technological developments. This is an important
part of the viability of a working standard. Some SDOs trigger an automatic review of the validity of the
standard after a pre-defined period, for instance every five or ten years. Corrections may be needed at
different levels. Such corrections may include technical or editorial corrections of inconsistences, issues
in the concept or content of the standard, extension of the standard’s domain of use, and evolution of the
technology and/or of other standards in the committee or in peer technical bodies.
If the need for corrections or maintenance of the standard is identified during the review or because flaws
are discovered, the whole process is restarted to publish an amendment, update the standard, create a
new standard, withdraw an obsolete standard, or downgrade the current standard to an inactive status.
If the standard is referenced in a regulatory text, the procedure takes into account the transition period
required to amend the reference.

EXAMPLES
Example of the CEN/CENELEC Standardization process
The standardization process at CEN/CENELEC is a typical application of the top-down standards
development approach described in the previous paragraphs. The different phases are identified as:
proposal from relevant national members, technical bodies, the EC or the EFTA secretariat; drafting and
consensus building; public enquiry from national members and partner organizations, followed by a formal
vote; consideration of comments; approval and final ratification; and finally, publication of the standard
and announcement for national endorsement (see Figure 4.3 below).

1 Proposal - evaluation and decision

2 Drafting and consensus building

3 Public enquiry

4 Consideration of comments

5 Approval of the standard

6 Publication

Figure 4.3: Standardization process at CEN/CENELEC (CEN 2016)

111
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

Example of the ETSI standards development process


The key phases of the ETSI standards development process are described in ETSI (2013) and consist of
the following steps: a) create a Work Item; b) develop the draft standard; c) validate the draft; d) submit
the draft for editorial checking; e) approve and publish the standard; f) maintain and evolve the standard.

MAINTENANCE AND EVOLUTION RESULTING IN A NEW


WORK ITEM FOR A REVISION OF THE STANDARD

FEEDBACK

FEEDBACK

FEEDBACK

Approval
Validation Editorial and
Drafting
and Review Check Publication

Published Implementation
Work Standard and use
Item

Figure 4.4: Standardization process at ETSI (ETSI 2013)

Example of the IETF development process: getting an RFC published


The IETF adopts a bottom-up process (IETF 2012; IETF 2015) where new proposals are submitted as
drafts by individuals. An Internet Draft (I-D) can be either a WG draft or an individual submission. WG
drafts are usually reviewed by the WG before being accepted as a WG item, although the chairs have
the final decision. When agreed after the "WG Last Call", the draft is sent to the Internet Engineering
Steering Group (IESG) for further updates. It is submitted for review to the entire IETF community, which
triggers discussions on remaining issues and their solutions. After approval, it is published as an RFC by
an organization named RFC Editor.

112
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Publication of the document


1 as an Internet-Draft

Commenting and editing


2 of the draft

An Area Director takes the draft


3 to the IESG

The IESG reviews the draft and


4 may request Updates

The draft is submitted for review


5 to the wider IETF community

Issues are discussed and resolved


6 with the IESG members

7 Publication by the RFC Editor

Figure 4.5: Standardization process at the IETF

Example of Health Level Seven (HL7)


HL7 is an international community of experts in healthcare subject matter and information scientists
collaborating to create standards for the exchange, management and integration of electronic healthcare
information. It was established to develop a protocol for the exchange of healthcare information in clinical
settings. HL7 adopts a different process based on the object-oriented development of information
models. Figure 4.6 below shows the diagram of the primary models and development steps specified by
the HL7 Version 3 Message Development Framework (Beeler 1998).
The first model developed is the Use Case Model, which identifies actors and events as well as how
they behave in specific use cases. It enables the identification of the key concepts, subject classes and
relevant states, which are described in the information model. This is a critical element of the process, as
it is based on a single reference model shared by all the HL7 standards. The information model is used
to create an Interaction Model, which specifies the sub-systems that communicate using HL7 messages
and how they interact. Finally, the Message Design Model specifies the message format needed to meet
the interaction requirements. The development process is cyclical, as different models developed are
refined and new features are introduced.

113
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

USE CASE MODEL INFORMATION MODEL


Actors
Events

Reference
Information
Model
Use Case Diagram Class Diagram State Diagram

MESSAGE DESIGN MODEL INTERACTION MODEL


Message Information Model Interactions and scenarios
Message Object description
Hierarchical Message Application roles
Description Trigger events
Conformance claims

Class Diagram

Interaction Diagram

Figure 4.6: Standardization process based on models and an object-oriented methodology

Example of the Integrative Design Model


The Integrative Design Model defines another standardization process based on the experience of
implementation and user-developer relations. The standards development cycle is shown as a three-
phase model that includes development, deployment and local enactment, where design activities occur
throughout all three phases (Millerand & Baker 2010).
Millerand & Baker (2010) analyse the complexity of the standards development process, summarized in
their development models and inspired by a case study. User involvement and user-developer relations
step in throughout the whole standards development life cycle.
They describe a development model together with an associated local implementation model, which
provides feedback throughout the implementation phase. The Integrative Design Model serves as
an alternative to the traditional iterative four-phase implementation process (design, development,
deployment, enactment). In the Integrative Design Model, (re)design activities occur continuously in
each of the three phases. The model also highlights that resources—and negotiation processes for their
allocation—are a critical enabling factor for successful collaborative work.

114
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Development Deployment

ce

Re
ur

sou
Reso

rces
Design

Resources

Enactment

Figure 4.7: Standardization process based on the integrative design model

4.2.5 ORGANIZATION OF AN SDO


This section explains how an SDO is typically organized, from the level of its governing entities down
to its committees and WGs. It includes a presentation of how its members are recruited. In practice,
each technical body (SDO, consortium or industry forum) has its own membership, works within its own
environment, and defines its own set of governing policies.
The governance of an SDO is usually organized as a hierarchical structure, as shown in Figure 4.8 below.
This ensures clear and assigned responsibilities for accountability within the system and for the consistency
of the different activities. The figure and text below are explained using terms inspired from some recognized
SDOs to give meaningful examples, but equivalent terminology exists in all organizations.

115
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

Members of
the SDO

General
Assembly

Management Secretariat
Committees Board (SDO staff,
(Strategy, Technical, administration)
Policy, Finance)

Standardization
Joint-SDO
Technical Strategic Groups
Working Groups
Committees

Figure 4.8: Typical organization of an SDO

The main entity of an SDO is the association of its members. The types of members vary according to its
internal organization and recruiting rules. The members are represented by the General Assembly (GA),
which meets periodically to make the governance decisions. The GA delegates the daily governance to a
Board, which manages and coordinates the SDO’s focus and strategy. The Board works in collaboration
with Management Committees for finance, strategy, etc. It is supported by the SDO Secretariat made
of SDO permanent staff. The Secretariat enables the coordination of the committees as well as the
technical and operational cooperation with other SDOs. It promotes the SDO’s activities in the external
environment and makes IT tools, platforms and solutions available. It ensures that the established process
and procedures are respected and that legal requirements are fulfilled.
The Board controls the standards programme and supervises the implementation work of the different
technical bodies such as committees, strategic groups or joint-SDO working groups. The committees
are usually quite autonomous. They create sub-committees to address specific tasks or topics. They
are responsible for preparing and disseminating the draft documents for comment, voting, appeals and
delivering the approved standardization documents. They maintain a work programme, which is reviewed
periodically. When a WG inside a committee has fulfilled all its tasks, it may cease its operations. Committees
and WGs are mainly responsible for the quality of their output. The Secretariat provides administrative and
logistical support to committees and WGs for standardization activities. It also provides capacity for the
editing, printing, publishing, sale and distribution of standards

116
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

FUNDING OF SDOS AND STANDARDIZATION


Financial options related to the development of standards, including both financial support for SDOs
and the self-funded participation of the industry sector, are important to guarantee the impartiality of the
standards development process. The financing of standardization activities should be capable of covering
all activities related to the production of standardization deliverables for products and services. It may
also cover the administrative expenses incurred by the preparation, monitoring, inspection, auditing and
evaluation necessary for the purposes of implementation.
Funding may come from different sources, such as direct funding from governing authorities, membership
fees, income from the sales of standards, and income from certification activities and their operations.

EXAMPLES
Example: ISO Structure and governance (ISO 2016; ISO 2016b)
The ISO General Assembly is attended by ISO’s Principal Officers and delegates nominated by the
member bodies or national representatives. Correspondent members and subscriber members may
attend as observers. The ISO Council governs the operations of ISO. The President’s Committee is
composed of the Principal Officers. It advises the Council on the implementation of its decisions. It also
ensures effective communication and coordination among the ISO Council, the Technical Management
Board and the two Council Standing Committees: the Strategy and Policy Committee (CSC/SPC) and
the Committee on Finance (CSC/FIN). The Technical Management Board reports to the Council and is
responsible for the overall management of the technical work. It decides on the establishment of technical
committees and appoints their secretariats and Chairs.
The ISO Central Secretariat (ISO/CS) is responsible for supporting the governance and policy, advisory
structure, and the operations of ISO. It assists the development process and publishes the standards.

General
Assembly
Reporting/responsibility
Advisory

Council President’s
Standing Council
Committee
Committees

Policy
Technical
Development
Management
Committees
Board

Technical
Committees

Figure 4.9: ISO governance structure (ISO 2016)

117
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

The IEC is a not-for-profit organization that develops International Standards and operates conformity
assessment systems in the field of electrotechnology (IEC 2017). The IEC comprises one member
National Committee per country, they each pay membership fees and in exchange can participate fully in
IEC work. The IEC works closely with ISO and adopts a similar hierarchical governance.

Example: CEN-CENELEC cooperation model


The case of the CEN and CENELEC ESOs shows how the two SDOs cooperate to avoid duplication of
standards and the correlated issues. CEN and CENELEC are two ESOs that complement each other.
They have implemented a close cooperation agreement to clearly distribute the tasks between the two
organizations: electrical and electronic engineering fields for CENELEC, all other subjects for CEN. In
parallel, each organization remains independent, with its own governance structure built according to the
hierarchical model. Figure 4.10 shows how the two structures collaborate for membership evaluation,
with one common committee reporting to the governance structure of each of the SDOs.

Membership Relations and Monitoring


Committee
Mandated by CEN & CENELEC AGs to handle: To report Presidential Committee
- Assessment processes - Cases of non-compliance
- Feedback to the Member assessed Feedback - Annual reporting to all members
- Exchange of information with each Member
- Exchange good practices

Report

CA CENELEC CA CEN

General Assembly CENELEC General Assembly CEN

p
oo
tl
n
me
f-/ Peer assess

CENELEC Members CEN Members


Implementation
Sel

CEN-CENELEC Member good practices

Figure 4.10: CEN-CENELEC governance and collaboration

118
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Example: IETF Structure and governance (IETF 2012)


The IETF is not a traditional standards organization, although many specifications that are produced
do become recognized standards. It is not a corporation and has no board of directors, no members,
and no fees. The ISOC (Internet Society) is an international membership organization that fosters the
expansion of the Internet. The ISOC supports the administrative staff directly employed by the IETF
Administrative Support Activity (IASA). The IESG (Internet Engineering Steering Group) is responsible for
the technical management of IETF activities and the Internet standards process. An important task of the
IESG is to monitor the output of all the WGs to help prevent the specification of IETF protocols that are
inconsistent with one another. The IAB (Internet Architecture Board) focuses on long-range planning and
coordination among the various areas of IETF activity. It stays informed about important long-term issues
in the Internet, through the IRSG (Internet Research Steering Group). The core registrar for the IETF’s
activities is the IANA (Internet Assigned Numbers Authority). The IETF depends on a volunteer group of
active participants.

ISOC
(Internet Society)

IASA
(IETF
Administrative
Support Activity)

IAB
(Internet
Architecture
Board)

IETF IANA
IRTF (Internet (Internet Assigned
(Internet Research Numbers
Engineering Task
Task Force) Authority)
Force)

IRSG IESG
(Internet Research (Internet Engineering
Research Groups Research Groups
Steering Group) Steering Group)

Figure 4.11: IETF governance structure

119
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

The members of an SDO are all stakeholders interested in the development of standards. Experts from
interested parties can participate in the development of standards that affect them. The members of the
standardization commissions are a diverse selection of qualified individuals.
The typical employers of attendees in ICT standardization are corporate organizations such as industrial
companies and SMEs, ICT equipment manufacturers, service providers, and network operators. Another
important group of contributors comes from research centres, academia and university staff, such as faculty
and students from engineering, business, public policy, and law departments. Consultancy companies,
testing laboratories and certification bodies are involved as well. Standards are also created by people
who will use and be impacted by them: user groups, pressure groups, societal organizations (consumer,
environmental and social), trade unions, civil society, and non-governmental organizations. Finally,
administrations and public authorities, national organizations and government agencies are recommended
to follow the standardization work. It allows them to stay informed of technological developments in the
field and evolutions around the standards relevant for them, especially those referenced by regulations,
or to give their input during the development of a standard to ensure its consistency with the regulatory
objectives pursued.
User groups hardly ever participate in standards development, even if they are the final consumers and
beneficiaries of the products and processes standardized. In addition to funding issues, they suffer from a
lack of technical background, as well as a lack of sufficient interest due to the complexity of the process.
They are often unlikely to provide meaningful input in the process. So, most often, they are represented
by corporate users or societal organizations. Recognized SDOs now develop policies to promote their
participation in standardization activities and dissemination of knowledge of standardization. Inter-
disciplinary collaboration (verticals associated with IT specialists) is important at this time of digitalization
of society and industry.
Membership also varies depending on the region. In Europe, membership in a national SDO requires the
member to be European or to have a business interest or manufacturing presence in Europe. According
to the organization, joining an SDO and becoming a member may be driven by national representations or
business interest. In India, it is based on the Public-Private Partnership mode (PPP). In the US, membership
is usually unrestricted and very often has an international scope.

120
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

End users

Administrations ICT equipment


and public manufacturers
authorities

Societal
organisations

Service
Research centres
providers

Standards
Academia and Network
Committee operators
universities

Certification
Consultancies bodies
STANDARDS

Figure 4.12: Stakeholders involved in the activities of an SDO

Similar to the SDO governance, committees adopt a hierarchical structure when they are responsible
for a large work programme requiring expertise in different topics. A committee gathers the appointed
officials, the member representatives and potentially the representatives of external organizations, which
have established a liaison with the committee/WG because they share a similar interest in the topic.
Sufficiently large committees establish sub-committees to focus on specific tasks. WGs and SCs work to
create, write and make technical decisions in the process of developing standards. The number of WGs
depends on the size of the committee. It often happens that small committees do not have sufficient
matters to create WGs. In this case, the committee adopts a flat structure, which means that there is
no sub-group created, and the entirety of the work is performed by the committee as a whole. Each
committee or sub-group is managed by a chair elected by the group members or appointed by the SDO
board. When established, the WG chair is responsible for reporting WG activity to the parent committee.

121
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

Chair
Vice-chair

Technical
Technical Committee Standardization
Officer (plenary) experts

Chair
Vice-chair
per WG

WG1 WG2 WG3 WG4 WG5


Technical Technical Technical Technical Technical
Topic 1 Topic 2 Topic 3 Topic 4 Topic 5

Rapporteur
per WI

Figure 4.13: Typical organization of a Technical Committee

EXAMPLE
Example: Organization of an IEC Committee (IEC 2017b)
The chair of an IEC technical committee (TC) is responsible for the overall management of that technical
committee, including any sub-committees and working groups. The secretary is responsible for preparing
the committee working documents and assisting with project management. In each working group, a
convenor is named who is responsible for arranging and organizing the meetings and activities of the
working group. For the development of each project, a project leader (the WG/PT convenor, a designated
expert or, if appropriate, the secretary) is appointed by the TC or SC. In the case of a project team, the
project leader reports to the parent committee. Experts in relevant technical fields for each committee are
individuals appointed by their National Committees, via an Expert Management System, and designated
to one or more working groups, maintenance teams or project teams. Experts take part in the drafting
of working documents. They are capable of advising on technical issues in the field of the committee to
which they have been appointed.

122
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Technical
Committee Chair
Secretary

Project Team Maintenance Team Working Group Subcommittee


- Project Team Leader - Convenor - Convenor Chair
- Experts - Experts - Experts Secretary

Working Group
- Convenor
- Experts

Maintenance Team
- Convenor
- Experts

Project Team
- Project Team Leader
- Experts

Figure 4.14: Typical organization of an IEC Technical Committee (IEC 2017b)

Another example of a committee structure can be found in ISO documentation (ISO 2016).

123
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

4.3 ROLES AND COMPETENCIES OF A STANDARDIZATION EXPERT

4.3.1 INTRODUCTION
This section explains the roles and competencies of a standardization expert.

DEFINITION
A standardization expert is a professional who works in a corporate organization, often in industry,
national administration, research or an academic organization, consumer or professional association,
or as a staff member of an SDO. S/he is nominated to represent her/his organization in an SDO
committee. S/he does not need to have an engineering degree but does need to be knowledgeable
about the technical matters to be standardized. S/he carries out, but also often coordinates, most
of the tasks and activities to be performed in the standardization process with the help of the other
experts and her/his company’s staff.

Usually, the production of a standard involves different types of professionals and functions. These functions
can be classified in two groups, depending on whether the expert is active: a) in the standardization
committees or b) in the SDO’s permanent staff. The expert's main responsibilities are described in the
first part of this section. Furthermore, two types of competences serve the standardization expert in her/
his daily activities. A standardization expert has to demonstrate a mix of hard, or technical, skills and soft,
or personal, competences. Indeed, the skills actually required depend on the role of the expert in the
standardization process. The standardization expert should possess some of these technical and personal
competences. The more of these skills the standardization expert has, the more likely s/he is to succeed
in the standardization activities.

4.3.2 ROLES OF PROFESSIONALS INVOLVED IN THE STANDARDS DEVELOPMENT


PROCESS
The individuals that participate in the standardization process perform different types of activities
or roles. A committee or Working Group (WG) consists of standardization experts appointed by their
respective organizations. They all play specific roles by acting as chairman (or vice-chairman) of the group,
standardization expert, standards proposer, rapporteur, or liaison representative. The work of a committee
also depends on the permanent staff of the SDO—often named the Secretariat—who take care of the
administrative and technical organization of the SDO. In the Secretariat, technical officers and final editors
are directly involved in the development of the standards.
The tasks and responsibilities of the experts in the working groups depend on the role they play in the
committee.

124
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Observer Liaison Delegate

Standard
proposer
TEAM
Standardization
experts
WORK

Chairman (Vice-chairman) Rapporteur


of the group

Figure 4.15: Roles of standardization experts involved in a technical committee

The chairman and the vice-chairman lead the activities of the Standardization Experts in the Working
Groups (WG). Together, they manage WG meetings by taking appropriate actions and decisions. They
steer the discussions towards consensus, while trying to avoid sustained opposition to a standard. They
ensure that the work programme is completed in due time, that milestones are achieved, and that the
strategy of the SDO is followed. They provide guidance to the SDO secretariat and validate the start of
the approval process for the draft standards, which are nearing publication. They are responsible for the
technical and non-technical outputs from the WG, for example sending liaison statements to peer WGs
and keeping them informed of the activities of the WG. Sometimes, they represent the WG at external
meetings to provide activity reports to the council, present the work programme in workshops, or give
technical advice on topics addressed by the WG to other groups and committees.

125
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

The experts participate in WGs, where they provide technical expertise, knowledge, and a dedicated
interest in the technology that is being standardized. They write the standards by submitting contributions
and change requests, while sticking to the planned schedule.
They are often divided into two circles: the inner circle active in the drafting of a standard and the wider
group that conducts monitoring activities due to its interest in the development of the standard (de Vries
2006). Their work must be useful for three types of stakeholders: a) the standards developers, who write
the specifications and ensure their quality; b) the implementers, who use the standard to develop their
products and are dependent on its content; and c) the customers, who buy the derived products and
expect them to work successfully. The experts discuss the content of the drafts and make technical
decisions. They accept or reject the approval of final drafts during ballots. They base their decisions on
the position of the party they are representing. When attending as observers, they follow the activities of
the WG, but do not take an active part and are not allowed to participate in the decision-making process.
Among the standardization experts, a standard proposer may detect a market need for a new standard,
usually based on information received from her/his own organization. Each standard is organized as a
specific short-term task with a clear scope and schedule. If interest can be raised for a specific development,
the standard proposer submits a proposal to the members of the committee and triggers discussion of it
during a committee meeting. S/he must receive support and interest from other members, as obtaining
approval is often a criterion to start a new standard in recognized SDOs.
The rapporteur takes responsibility for a standard under development. S/he serves as editor of the
standardization document, following the guidance of the WG in accordance with the work specifications,
guidelines, delivery schedule, and the SDO internal rules that steer its technical quality. S/he leads drafting
and comment resolution meetings, collects contributions from other experts and organizations involved
in the WG, and maintains the draft versions of the standard. S/he provides input for the assessment
and resolution of comments during the approval process and, when necessary, updates the draft. S/
he provides technical advice to the technical body on the subject/topic. Her/his objective is to obtain the
largest consensus possible on the content of the standard and resolve potential conflicts. S/he delivers the
final draft to the final editor and contributes to its editorial clean-up. Additionally, s/he may serve as a focal
point for technical questions related to the topic under standardization.
The liaison delegates serve as a link between two committees or WGs. They are appointed by both groups
after a liaison has been established. They attend WG meetings as observers. Their role is to report to each
WG on the activities and standards of the other group. Documents may also be exchanged in the liaison
process if deemed necessary by the liaison delegate.

126
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

EXAMPLE
Figure 4.16 below gives an example of the roles held by standardization experts in an ISO committee (ISO
2016). More specifically, it shows the roles of chairs, secretaries, committee members and liaison officers.

ISO/CS

Secretary Chair

P-member
Liaisons
TC
O-member P-members
O-members
Liaisons

Chair Secretary

P-member SC
P-members
O-members
ISO Liaisons International
member organization

SH* SH*
SH*

Convenor

Experts Experts
WG
Experts

Figure 4.16: Professionals involved in the standardization process (ISO 2016)

127
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

The tasks and responsibilities of the permanent staff of the SDO secretariat are to facilitate the work
of experts in the WG. From a general perspective, SDO staff monitor the standardization work, from
incubation to delivery to SDO members. They coordinate the standardization process and publish the
standard. Where relevant, they provide guidance on the testability of the requirements and the production
of test specifications. They promote the SDO’s activities by participating in workshops, seminars and
conferences, while maintaining collaboration relationships with external organizations, including governing
authorities where applicable. They support the referencing of standards in regulations and the correct
application of SDO governing policies. Within SDO staff, the technical officer and the final editor are more
closely involved in standard production and publication.
More specifically, the technical officer provides administrative support to the WG chairman, rapporteur
and experts concerning the standardization technical process, its procedure, and the work programme
schedule. S/he responds to technical queries from the group’s officials and delegates, or from third
parties relating to the group’s sphere of activity. S/he organizes the approval of the standard and enforces
compliance with SDO standardization policies. S/he performs an ongoing check of the standard on matters
such as editorial quality and project consistency during its drafting. S/he is aware of the technology being
standardized but works in strict impartiality and has no decision-making rights.
Once the standard has been approved, the final editor performs a final check of the text, including editorial,
language and terms validation and conformity with the SDO’s drafting rules. If required, the text is corrected
in collaboration with the authors/rapporteurs. The final editor is responsible for the publication of the
standard.

4.3.3 COMPETENCIES OF A STANDARDIZATION EXPERT


To explore and promote standardization as an element of formal, academic as well as vocational training,
an EC report (Blind and Drechsler 2017) dressed a comprehensive assessment of what market demand
is needed. The approach was to identify "Job profiles" for which the present European employment
market requests standardization-related competences. This section approaches the matter from an ICT
professional’s perspective. It describes which skills the ICT professional should develop and demonstrate
to be more comfortable and efficient as a standardization expert. The different skills are presented in tables,
which are organized according to the findings of the EC report (Blind and Drechsler 2017).
From a technical perspective, a standardization expert provides knowledge and technical expertise in
the ICT technologies related to the standardization topic (e.g. radio systems, short-range communication
protocols, etc.) and to the market. The reader is also referred to Table 26 "Overview about necessary
knowledge and skills (companies’ perspective)" of the EC report (Blind and Drechsler 2017) for a list of
skills applicable to the job market perspective.

128
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

GROUP OF SKILLS SPECIFIC SKILLS

skills in mathematics, sciences and engineering (technical team professionals)

learning skills to follow the rapid evolution of the technology

focus on architecture, influence the conception, development and implementation of


technical innovations

understand its impact, with professional and ethical responsibility

UNDERSTANDING AND understand and structure complex systems, respecting all sorts of technical and non-
MANAGEMENT OF TECHNICAL technical constraints
CONTENT manage the relationships and interactions between the designed systems

problem-solving skills, identify and formulate technical problems, generalize across


problems

able to find innovative approaches to resolve an issue

design and conduct experimental proofs of concept

able to analyse and interpret the resulting data

experience in the field of ICT standardization

understand the interactions and relationships between the different SDOs and their
standards

understand the international standardization strategy


UNDERSTANDING AND
understand the process, rules and good practices applied at the SDO regarding the
MANAGEMENT OF ICT
approval of a standard
STANDARDIZATION
understand the context of committee activities

able to identify gaps and visualize innovative trends and solutions

able to keep up with the pace of the work and not slow down the progress of
standardization work

experience of her/his organization and its technologies, products, business fields

apply the organization’s process management


UNDERSTANDING AND
work towards achieving strategic and operational goals by taking critical success
MANAGEMENT OF ORGANIZATION
factors into account
STRATEGY
understand customer/user needs

able to commit to the organization goals

Table 4.1: Hard/Technical skills

Technical skills are of high importance, but standardization also requires personal skills often not taught in
Higher Education curricula. A standardization expert will be more efficient, if s/he possesses certain soft/
personal skills.

129
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

GROUP OF SKILLS SPECIFIC CAPABILITIES

communicate, listen, articulate and clearly express her/his views

write clear, concise and user-friendly standards and technical documents

raise issues on drafts and suggest changes


COMMUNICATION COMPETENCES
design appropriate visual aids to prepare presentations and reports

understand and work in the language used by the SDO, i.e. the national official
languages for national bodies, which are usually English, French or German in
European and International organizations

cooperate easily with her/his organization teams and fellow standardization experts

persuade others with her/his own opinions and views, but at the same time, is able to
listen to peer delegates and respect others’ opinions

manage negotiation and cooperation, in other words how to influence people and
organizations

SOCIAL COMPETENCES re-evaluate her/his own standpoint if required, in response to external conditions and
internal needs

leadership skills to steer the group towards a satisfactory technical solution and
consensus

inspire trust in her/his decisions

coordinate the many skillsets in her/his business organization

willing to keep learning and transfer her/his skills to peer experts

firm when necessary and confident in conflict management

PERSONAL COMPETENCES flexible and able to decide whether a compromise is acceptable

remain open-minded when receiving criticism

network and collaborate easily with peer delegates

read a large number of documents, essentially the WG documents and draft standards

organize and prioritize her/his work, project management capabilities

deliver tasks and documents within the planned deadlines

METHODOLOGY COMPETENCES take initiative and work autonomously

use recent electronic and collaborative tools such as mailing lists, word processors,
web and FTP services, wikis, phone and web conferencing

willing to travel to attend meetings to discuss specific matters more directly with WG
participants

Table 4.2: Soft/Personal competences

130
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

4.4 ACTIVITIES OF A STANDARDIZATION EXPERT

4.4.1 INTRODUCTION
This section explains the main activities of a standardization expert. The expert’s tasks are split over three
periods of activities. The main activities related to standardization take place during standardization meetings
on SDO premises when participating in the meeting, but also during interim periods such as networking
breaks. Between meetings, the standardization expert writes or reviews standardization documents.
The section also explains how the standardization expert has impact and collaborates inside her/his
corporate organization. S/he interacts with her/his colleagues on company premises to discuss the
standards with relevant technical teams, as well as with marketing and management teams. The activities
to be performed by the standardization experts from consulting companies or academia may be similar to
the activities performed by industry experts.
Finally, the last part of this section introduces the specific duties of the standardization expert when s/he
representing her/his country’s interests as a national delegate.

Make a presentation Work


at SDO premises at office

standardisation expert standardisation expert

Figure 4.17: Standardization expert working at the SDO and then at the office

4.4.2 DURING WORKING GROUP MEETINGS


Standardization meetings involve the appointed experts and, where relevant, external observers and liaison
officers. This is the place where ideas are discussed and the Working Group (WG) can cooperate and
progress on the work programme, which is carefully reviewed against deadlines. Before leaving for the
meeting, the standardization expert has to read the draft documents and contributions in her/his area of

131
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

expertise.
The majority of the meeting is spent reviewing the status of the WG documents: draft standards,
contributions, and proposals for new standards. When s/he attends standardization or WG meetings and
attends as a Working Group member, the standardization expert gets involved in the discussions, while
bringing in her/his own knowledge on the topics discussed, and trying to find compromise solutions where
necessary. If a draft standard is ready for approval, the standardization expert participates in the decision-
making process. If the standardization expert has been selected as liaison officer between two WGs or
two SDOs, s/he presents the activities that are taking place at the other WGs/SDOs. Learning from these
reports enables cooperation between SDOs and the coherence of the standardization as a whole for a
given market.
As a rapporteur, the standardization expert presents the latest version of the draft standard to enable the
progress and tracking of the Work Item (WI). The rapporteur explains what changes have been made
since the previous version. A few slides can be helpful to present a status report and the main ideas to be
discussed.
Depending on the WG, meetings may include drafting sessions, where draft standards are updated, or
only reviewing sessions, where changes and open issues are discussed. The rapporteur collects questions,
while triggering discussions and trying to provide answers to clarify the topic. When competing ideas block
the progression of the work, the standardization expert suggests compromises to obtain consensus on a
possible solution that will be recorded in a status report and integrated in the revision of the draft standard.

Figure 4.18: Rapporteur presenting the draft standard to the Working Group members

A large part of the work is also performed by people talking to one another during the standardization
meetings or during breaks or networking time such as lunches and dinners. Unofficial get-together sessions
can also be organized on the fly between peers to progress on a draft, try to resolve blocking issues,
set up multilateral agreements, or agree political deals between competing interests. Working in smaller
groups allows faster progress on issues. Networking time is also a good opportunity for the standardization
expert to raise awareness about new concepts or processes to be standardized and to find supporters for
triggering a new standard.

132
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

4.4.3 BETWEEN STANDARDIZATION MEETINGS


When in her/his office, the standardization expert acting as rapporteur updates the current draft to prepare
the next version of the standard. S/he organizes drafting meetings where standardization experts discuss
the content of the draft. Drafting meetings can be organized as virtual interim meetings, where interested
parties discuss the document in more detail, or simply get involved in the process at a lower cost than if
they meet face to face. Drafting sessions can also be launched as an email discussion or an informal phone
call among a few experts.
As the main editor of a draft standard, the rapporteur collects contributions and uses the interim meetings
to obtain input from other experts, and to trigger and distribute writing tasks among the participants that
are willing to contribute. At her/his office, the rapporteur has more time to identify the IPRs related to the
topic under standardization and ensure that the SDO rules on the matter are respected in the document.
Furthermore, before the next WG meeting, the rapporteur prepares a status report of the WIs under her/
his responsibility.
If s/he is not the rapporteur, the standardization expert prepares contributions and change requests to
draft standards. S/he uses traditional and digital working tools: word processor, Instant Messaging (IM),
phone, collaborative/shared workspace and conference tools to get access to WG documents or attend
interim drafting meetings. The standardization expert can also use this period to implement the standard
in collaboration with in-house technical teams and prepare a report of inconsistencies that were found
during implementation and testing. An important part of the work related to standardization activities is
done before each WG meeting. The standardization expert reads the latest versions of the drafts and
other documents that have been submitted, while making sure that s/he understands their contents. The
standardization expert also tries to identify open points and issues to be discussed at the meeting.

4.4.4 INSIDE THE EXPERT’S CORPORATE COMPANY


Developing and standardizing a new or an evolved technology usually requires the collaborative work
of technical, marketing and managerial teams. Back at the office, the standardization expert is asked to
exchange with these teams.
Inside the company, the standardization expert exchanges with the relevant technical teams and reports
on recent standardization activities and trends, especially with respect to the latest standards approved,
and the liaison reports from other SDOs. Usually, s/he provides it as a complete meeting report. The report
also gives feedback on the interest received from other delegates about the proposed developments and
about copyright or IPR issues that may be associated with the information included in the report.
When collaborating with the development teams, the standardization expert explains the standards and
how to use them to accelerate the product-to-market process, ensuring that changes to protocols,
entities or interfaces decided by the WG on proposed technologies are retro-fitted into local prototypes
and products. In this way, the standardization expert tries to prevent the technical teams from creating
proprietary solutions. If needed, the terminology for a common understanding of the in-house projects is
defined or updated according to the terms used in the standards.

133
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

The standardization expert leads or participates in the activity of building prototypes that demonstrate the
effectiveness of the new technologies to be standardized and the correctness of the standards requirements,
while showing how existing systems must be tweaked. Implementing standards is an important activity
that helps potential problems be discovered early.
The standardization expert uses office time to extend her/his knowledge about existing and future
technologies, concepts and developments, such as ongoing research or expertise handled by other
organizations. Contributing to knowledge management and dissemination is an essential activity to achieve
innovation in the company.

SDO

Company
nformation
i
al
Extern

Figure 4.19: Standardization expert involved in the technical activities of a corporate company

Inside the company, the standardization expert exchanges with the marketing team. As the ICT market
is evolving at a fast pace, it is important to evaluate how companies can enhance existing products or
introduce new ones. Standards play an important role here, as they can foster the company’s innovation
or, on the contrary, exclude it from the market.
The standardization expert is the link between the marketing teams and the standardization committee.
S/he is able to grasp the strategy of the business units and secure it through standards.

134
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

The standardization expert understands and analyses with the marketing team the customer’s feedback
and expectations and identifies potential standardization gaps. S/he identifies the new standards required
by customers’ needs and prepares proposals to start their development. Thus, it is crucial for corporate
organizations to actively participate in the standardization process related to their market.

Client Marketing team Company


Figure 4.20: Standardization expert involved in the marketing activities of the company

Inside the company, the standardization expert exchanges with the management team, together with
the technical and marketing teams, to understand the company’s strategy with respect to its standards
portfolio. It is important for ICT companies to maintain internal coordination efforts and develop and
implement a standards strategy. Except for very large companies, the high number of consortia and SDOs
working in the various ICT domains would need too many resources if standardization experts had to
attend all of them. A careful selection needs to be made by ICT manufacturers and vendors to ensure that
the company is active at the relevant standardization groups that can help develop its own innovation.
The standardization expert together with the management team should analyse which SDO memberships
are of interest and how to organize and maintain the contributions to the company’s standard portfolio. It
may happen that the motives for this strategy are not technical, thus requiring additional effort to gain the
expert’s support.

Management team Company

Figure 4.21: Standardization expert involved in the management activities of the company

135
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

4.4.5 AS A NATIONAL DELEGATE


As has been stated before, SDO governance defines rules for membership application. Standardization
experts can contribute to the SDO in their own capacity, for example at the IETF and IEEE, even if their
activities are actually funded by their own organizations. In other cases, membership is obtained directly by
the expert’s organization and s/he is appointed by the organization to represent it. This is the case at ETSI
and ANSI for example, and in the majority of industrial alliances. SDO governance may require members
to be representatives of an organization recognized as the official standards body in the country, or as an
organization competent in the domain of the SDO in its country. CEN, CENELEC, ITU and ISO belong to
this category. In this case, a national delegate is an individual expert appointed by the national member of
an SDO where membership is attributed on a per-country basis.
A standardization expert that serves as a national delegate represents the point of view of her/his country in
the standardization group. In addition to the activities described in the previous sections, the standardization
expert has the following duties. S/he triggers at national level the adoption, promotion and dissemination
of international or regional (for example, European) standards, and the withdrawal of conflicting national
standards. S/he organizes meetings of national stakeholders, for instance in national technical mirror
committees, to collect their positions, thus acting as a facilitator and coordinator of local involvement in
the standards by all types of national players: providers, academia, societal stakeholders and national
authorities.

136
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

4.5 CASE STUDY: THE 3RD GENERATION PARTNERSHIP PROJECT


(3GPP)
The 3rd Generation Partnership Project (3GPP) covers cellular telecommunications network technologies. 3GPP
began its activities in 1998, when several ICT SDOs, including ETSI and ARIB, came together to develop a single
standard for "third-generation" mobile telecommunications, in application of the fundamental coherence principle
(3GPP 1998). A similar organization, the 3GPP2, was founded in parallel in the US to develop a competitive
technology. Both converged when the evolution of the market required an evolution for faster Internet, as well as a
global solution. It was named the Long-Term Evolution (LTE) cellular system, also known as 4G.
The 3GPP brings together telecommunications SDOs, known as "Organizational Partners" (3GPP 1998). An
Organizational Partner is an SDO that has signed the Partnership Project Agreement and that has an officially
recognized status with the capability and authority to publish standards nationally or regionally. The 3GPP makes
all approved versions of its specifications available as soon as possible after their approval on a file server (3GPP
2017), while the Organizational Partners transpose and adopt the relevant Technical Specifications (TS) as their
own deliverables through their normal procedures.
The 3GPP committee structure is made up of three Technical Specification Groups (TSGs), each addressing
a sub-system of the cellular communications system (System and Services, Radio, Core Network). Each TSG
has established WGs to address dedicated working topics. Meetings are organized periodically to measure the
progress of the work and make decisions. They take place in locations where partners are active, which means
that delegates travel all over the world. The size of the different WGs vary, and sometimes prevent the discussion of
technical topics during meetings. The large number of documents to be reviewed requires that delegates discuss
the technical issues during offline discussions, leaving room only for approval or rejection of decisions during the
meetings. 3GPP specifications and studies are contribution-driven by member companies in WGs and at the
Technical Specification Group level.
3GPP follows a three-stage methodology similar to ITU Recommendation I.130 (ITU-T 1988). Its own methodology
is defined in 3GPP TR 21.900 (3GPP 2017) clause 4.1.
At 3GPP, stage 1 (Service requirements) consists in describing the aim of the system, as seen by those for which
the service is provided, such as end users, operators, service providers, etc. Stage 2 is an overall architectural
description of the organization of the network functions to map service requirements onto network capabilities. In
stage 3, the technical implementation covers the detailed interface specifications that are needed to support the
services defined in stage 1. The architectural implications and requirements need to be identified at a very early
stage in the process.
In 3GPP, it is often seen as appropriate to first produce a feasibility report prior to the specification work. A feasibility
study may include commercial as well as technical considerations. This analysis leads to the definition of candidate
new features to be added to the existing system. This is sometimes referred to as "stage 0". Furthermore, it is
also appropriate to follow stage 3 with the production of test and certification specifications. This is referred to as
stage 4.
Delegates thus represent a very wide variety of technical skills, from system architects to specialists such as radio
or security experts. Decisions may have a very real impact on business, given the wide range of interests involved
in standardization work; as such, delegates often have well-proven negotiation skills.
The progress of 3GPP standards is measured by the milestones set when the Work Item (WI) is approved (3GPP
2017). The progress of the entire collection of 3GPP specifications is also measured as a whole, in releases. New
features are "functionality frozen" and are ready for implementation when a release is completed. 3GPP works on
a number of releases in parallel, starting future work well in advance of the completion of the current release.

137
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

4.6 SUMMARY
Standards production is a complex process that involves technical resources, but also a strong organization
and social aspects. Fair standards enabling fair competition and fair trade implies compliance with a set of
fundamental principles. A systematic development methodology for ICT systems as well as for individual
standards has been described. SDOs and technical committees generally adopt a hierarchical structure
for their governance.
The roles of standardization experts in SDOs and committees are clearly defined, even if they vary
slightly among the different SDOs. Technical skills are of prime importance, but a variety of soft/personal
competences, often not taught during Higher Education, also help make a successful standardization
expert.
Finally, the chapter addresses the fact that standardization experts work for the production of standards
not only during committee meetings, but also during breaks and between meetings when the experts are
in their offices, and that they closely collaborate with their colleagues from development, marketing and
management in their own organizations.

138
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

4.7 QUIZ

1 - WHICH PRINCIPLE BELOW IS NOT A FUNDAMENTAL PRINCIPLE OF THE


STANDARDIZATION PROCESS?
(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) Openness
b) Abstraction
c) Transparency
d) Impartiality

2 - WHAT IS THE NAME OF THE DEVELOPMENT PHASE TAKING PLACE AFTER INCEPTION?
(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) Conception
b) Approval
c) Drafting
d) Maintenance

3 - WHICH GROUP OF STAKEHOLDERS DOES NOT TAKE PART IN THE PROCESS OF


DEVELOPING ICT STANDARDS?
(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) Biology faculty members
b) Consulting company staff
c) Certification laboratory engineers
d) Users involved in environmental organizations

4 - DOES THE CHAIRMAN OF A TECHNICAL COMMITTEE BELONG TO THE SECRETARIAT


OF THE SDO?
(See Section 4.3 for hints)
a) Yes
b) No

5 - WHICH OF THE FOLLOWING IS NOT A SOFT SKILL?


(See Section 4.3 for hints)
a) Active listening
b) Fluency in English
c) Problem solving
d) Word processing proficiency

6 - IS MATHEMATICAL EXPERTISE REQUIRED TO BECOME A STANDARDIZATION EXPERT?


(See Section 4.3 for hints)
a) Yes
b) No

139
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

7 - THE STANDARDIZATION EXPERT ESTABLISHES THE COMPANY STANDARDS STRATEGY


WITH:
(See Section 4.4 for hints)
a) the marketing team
b) management
c) the product development leader

8 - THE STANDARDIZATION EXPERT HAS TO TRAVEL TO ATTEND ALL HIS MEETINGS


(See Section 4.4 for hints)
a) True
b) False

9 - NATIONAL DELEGATES REPRESENT THE POINTS OF VIEW OF THEIR COUNTRIES AS


PRESCRIBED BY:
(See Section 4.4 for hints)
a) the company CEO
b) the network operators
c) the national administration
d) the national mirror committee

10 - THE IETF RFC PROCESS IS:


(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) a top-down process
b) a bottom-up process
c) an integrative design process
d) a standardization technical committee

11 - A TYPICAL SDO IS GOVERNED ACCORDING TO:


(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) a cooperation agreement
b) a hierarchical structure
c) a horizontal model

12 - 3GPP IS:
(See Section 4.5 for hints)
a) a national SDO
b) a European SDO
c) an international SDO
d) a partnership project among telecommunications SDOs

➜ SOLUTIONS PAGE 251

140
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

4.8 GLOSSARY
■ Drafting: Iterative writing of the different clauses of a draft standard.
■ Specification: Set of rules that competing products must comply with to enable their interoperability.
■ Standardization expert: Professional working in a corporate organization, often industry, in a national
organization, in a research or academic organization, or in a consumer or professional association
and involved in standardization.
■ Standardization stakeholder: Party impacted by the publication of standards, e.g., corporate
organizations, user groups, or national authorities.
■ Standards strategy: Plan of action designed to obtain a standards portfolio in line with corporate
business goals.
■ Technical body: Generic term designating technical committees, sub-committees and working
groups that bring together delegates to produce standards.

4.9 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS


■ 3GPP: Third Generation Partnership ■ ETSI: European Telecommunication
Project Standards Institute
■ ANSI: American National Standards ■ EU: European Union
Institute ■ FIN: Finance
■ ARIB: Association of Radio Industries and ■ FTC: Federal Trade Commission
Businesses
■ FTP: File Transfer Protocol
■ ATIS: Alliance for Telecommunications
■ GA: General Assembly
Industry Solutions
■ GSC: Global Standards Collaboration
■ CA: Conseil d’Administration
■ GSMA: Global System for Mobile
(Administrative Board)
Communications (GSM) Association
■ CEN: Comité Européen de Normalisation
■ HEN: Harmonized European Standard
(European Committee for Standardization)
■ HL7: Health Level Seven
■ CENELEC: European Committee for
Electrotechnical Standardization ■ IAB: Internet Architecture Board
■ CSC: Council Standing Committee ■ IANA: Internet Assigned Numbers Authority
■ EC: European Commission ■ IASA: IETF Administrative Support Activity
■ ETFA: European Free Trade Association ■ ICT: Information and Communication
Technology
■ EN: European Standard
■ I-D: Internet-Draft
■ EPC: Evolved Packet Core
■ IEC: International Electrotechnical
■ ESO: European Standards Organization
Commission

141
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

■ IEEE: Institute of Electrical and Electronics ■ NIST: National Institute of Standards and
Engineers Technology
■ IESG: Internet Engineering Steering Group ■ NSO: National Standards Organization
■ IETF: Internet Engineering Task Force ■ PT: Project Team
■ IM: Instant Messaging ■ RFC: Request for Comments
■ IPR: Intellectual Property Rights ■ SC: Sub-Committee
■ IRTF: Internet Research Task Force ■ SDO: Standards Development Organization
■ IRSG: Internet Research Steering Group ■ SE: Standardization Expert
■ ISO: International Organization for ■ SME: Small or Medium-sized Enterprise
Standardization ■ SPC: Strategy and Policy Committee
■ ISOC: Internet Society ■ TBT: Technical Barriers to Trade
■ ISO/CS: ISO Central Secretariat ■ TC: Technical Committee
■ IT: Information Technology ■ TR: Technical Report
■ ITU: International Telecommunication Union ■ TS: Technical Specification
■ ITU-T: International Telecommunication ■ TSG: Technical Specification Group
Union—Telecommunication Sector
■ US: United States
■ LTE: Long Term Evolution
■ WG: Working Group
■ MoU: Memorandum of Understanding
■ WI: Work Item
■ WSP: Wireless Short-Packet (protocol)
■ WTO: World Trade Organization

142
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

4.10 REFERENCES
✚ 3GPP (1998). Third Generation Partnership Project (3GPP) Partnership Project Description, December
1998. http://www.3gpp.org/ftp/Inbox/2008_web_files/3GPP.ppt. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ 3GPP (2017). Technical Specification Group working methods. Technical Report. TR 21.900.
✚ Abernathy, W. J., & Utterback, J. M. (1978). Patterns of innovation in technology. Technology Review, 80(7),
1–47.
✚ Beeler GW. (1998). HL7 version 3--An object-oriented methodology for collaborative standards
development. International Journal of Medical Informatics. February 1998 (pp. 151–161).
✚ Blind, K. & Drechsler, S. (2017). European market needs for education in standardisation/standardisation-
related competence. Luxembourg: Publications Office
✚ Breitenberg, M. (2009). The ABC’s of Standards Activities. Report NISTIR 7614, NIST, August 2009.
https://www.nist.gov/document/abcs-standards-activities. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ Carnahan L. & Phelps A. (2018). ABC’s of Conformity Assessment. NIST Special Publication 2000-01, NIST,
Draft under comment. https://www.nist.gov/file/416646. Accessed 15 January 2018.
✚ CEN-CENELEC (2009). CEN and CENELEC cooperation agreement. Guide 3, Edition 2, August 2009.
✚ CEN-CENELEC (2015). Guide on the organisational structure and processes for the assessment of the
membership criteria of CEN and CENELEC. Guide 22, Edition 3, February 2015.
✚ CEN-CENELEC (2015). Guide on membership criteria of CEN and CENELEC. Guide 20, Edition 4, February
2015.
✚ CEN-CENELEC (2016) Development Shaping European Standards. StandarDays, September 2016.
✚ CEN-CENELEC (2017). Roles and Responsibilities for National Standards Bodies, the National
Electrotechnical Committees, and CEN-CENELEC Management Centre. CEN/AG Resolution 21/2017 and
CLC/AG Decision AG 57/11, Edition 1, July 2017.
✚ CEN-CENELEC (2017). Common Rules for Standardisation Work. Internal Regulations, Part 2, February
2017.
✚ Delaney, H. & van de Zande, R. (2000). A Guide to EU Standards and Conformity Assessment. Global
Standards Program, Office of Standards Services, National Institute of Standards and Technology, Order
No. 43 NANB912297, May 2000.
✚ Direction Generale des Entreprises (2016). Guide relatif au bon usage de la normalisation dans la
réglementation. June 2016.
https://www.entreprises.gouv.fr/files/files/guides/guide-pratique-du-bon-usage-de-la-normalisation-dans-la-
reglementation.pdf. Accessed 9 January 2018.
✚ Egyedi, T. M. & Sherif, M. H. (2010). Standards Dynamics through an Innovation Lens: Next-Generation
Ethernet Networks. IEEE Communications Magazine, vol. 48, no. 10, October 2010 (pp. 166-171).

143
CHAPTER 4 - The production of standards

✚ ETSI (2013). A Guide to Writing World Class Standards,


http://www.etsi.org/standards/how-does-etsi-make-standards. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ ETSI (2016). ETSI Standards Making Process,
https://portal.etsi.org/Resources/StandardsMakingProcess/Process.aspx. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ European Union (2012). Regulation (EU) No 1025/2012 of the European Parliament and of the council of
October 25, 2012 on European standardisation, November 2012.
http://eur-lex.europa.eu/legal-content/EN/TXT/PDF/?uri=CELEX:32012R1025&from=EN. Accessed 15
November 2017.
✚ R. Hovey and S. Bradner (1996). The Organisations Involved in the IETF Standards Process. IETF, RFC
2028, October 1996.
✚ IEC (2017). IEC Management structure and organigramme.
http://www.iec.ch/dyn/www/f?p=103:63:0. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ IEC (2017). Roles & responsibilities: TC/SC officers, WG/MT convenors and PT leaders and experts.
http://www.iec.ch/standardsdev/resources/tcroles. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ IEEE (2017) Develop Standards - How are standards made?
https://standards.ieee.org/develop/process.html. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ IETF (2012). The Tao of IETF: A Novice’s Guide to the Internet Engineering Task Force.
https://www.ietf.org/tao.html. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ Government of India (2016). Discussion paper on standard essential patents and their availability on FRAND
terms. Department of Industrial Policy and Promotion, Ministry of Commerce & Industry, March 2016.
✚ IETF (2015). The IETF Process: an Informal Guide.
https://www.ietf.org/about/process-docs.html. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ ISO (2016). My ISO job - What delegates and experts need to know. 2016 edition,
http://www.iso.org/iso/my_iso_job.pdf. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ ISO (2016). ISO in brief.
https://www.iso.org/publication/PUB100007.html. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ ISO (2016). How to write standards - Tips for standards writers. Brochure, November 2016.
✚ ISO (2017). Taking part, how we develop standards.
https://www.iso.org/developing-standards.html. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ ITU-T (1988). Method for the characterisation of telecommunication services supported by an ISDN and
network capabilities of an ISDN. Recommendation I.130, November 1988.
✚ ITU-T (2017). Global Standards Collaboration web site,
http://www.itu.int/en/ITU-T/gsc/Pages/default.aspx. Accessed 15 November 2017.
✚ ITU-T (2017). Definition of "Open Standards".
http://www.itu.int/en/ITU-T/ipr/Pages/open.aspx. Accessed 15 November 2017.

144
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

✚ Jakobs, K. (2008). ICT standardisation - coordinating the diversity. In 2008 First ITU-T Kaleidoscope
Academic Conference - Innovations in NGN: Future Network and Services (pp. 119–126). doi:10.1109/
KINGN.2008.4542257
✚ JISC (2013). Japan’s Standardization Policy 2013. Japanese Industrial Standards Committee Secretariat,
Ministry of Economy, Trade and Industry, March 2013.
✚ Krassadaki, E. (2017). Engineering students’ skills: What – Why and How? Events on Education (EoE),
organized by BEST, Technical University of Crete, Chania, Crete. July 2017.
✚ Millerand, F. & Baker, K.S. (2010). Who are the users? Who are the developers? Webs of users and
developers in the development process of a technical standard. Information Systems Journal, 2010 (pp.
137-161).
✚ SPF (Service public fédéral) Economie belge (2017). Référer aux normes dans les réglementations
techniques - Découvrez les avantages! May 2017.
http://economie.fgov.be/fr/binaries/Referer-aux-normes-dans-les-reglementations-techniques_tcm326-
282895.pdf. Accessed 9 January 2018.
✚ Tarafdar, M. & Gordon, S. R. (2007). Understanding the Influence of Information Systems Competencies on
Process Innovation: A Resource-Based View. Journal of Strategic Information Systems, Volume 16, Issue
4, December 2007 (pp. 353-392).
✚ de Vries, H. (2006). Advanced Topics in Information Technology Standards and Standardisation Research,
Volume 1. Hershey, PA: IGI Global. IT Standards Typology (pp. 1-26). DOI: 10.4018/978-1-59140-938-0.
ch001.
✚ Wiley - IEEE (2017). What makes a successful engineer? Wiley and IEEE survey results. March 2017.
✚ World Trade Organisation (2000). Committee on Technical Barriers to Trade - Second Triennial Review of
the Operation and Implementation of the Agreement on Technical Barriers to Trade. G/TBT/9 Annex 4, Doc
#00-4811, November 13, 2000.

145
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

5 STANDARDIZATION AND INNOVATION

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
This chapter provides students with the required knowledge on the interdependencies between
innovation and standards/standardization. Some people believe that standardization and
innovation are opposites and cannot be reconciled. We demonstrate that this claim is not true, as
standardization and standards can actually boost innovation. First, we provide a short introduction
on how standardization can foster innovation. Then, we show how technology development and
standardization are linked. An example from ICT demonstrates how standardization could contribute
to the development of next-generation Ethernet networks. Finally, we relate different types of
innovation to standardization. Readers should be able to understand the ways in which innovation
and standardization are related, and how standardization can support innovation.
In addition, we discuss the relationships between research and standardization. The research process
is explained and linked to the use of standards and/or participation in the standardization processes.
In this way, it will be clear how standardization can benefit research. This gives an insight into how
standards and standardization can be leveraged during the research process.
At the end of the chapter, based on Abdelkafi and Makhotin (2014), we show how standards and
participation in the standardization process can support invention and exploitation in companies.
Exploitation is understood in the sense of identifying market applications for inventions. Readers will
learn the ways in which standards and standardization can support innovation, both as a process
and as an output in the sense of a technology or product. In particular, readers will gain in-depth
knowledge of so-called innovation potential in standardization according to Abdelkafi and Makhotin
(2014):
■ Efficient target-oriented innovation
■ Differentiation
■ Exceeding the requirements of standards
■ Business model innovation
■ Innovation impulses
■ Innovation communication
■ Absorption of innovation

146
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

5.1 INTRODUCTION
To succeed in a competitive marketplace, companies need to be innovative. They have to constantly
look for new opportunities for innovation. So far, scientific literature has identified many innovation drivers,
such as innovation teams (e.g. interdisciplinary teams that work on a specific innovation task), innovation
cultures (e.g. company cultures that do not sanction failures and encourage learning), creative techniques
(e.g. bionics and TRIZ), and innovation competitions (also called innovation contests that give individuals
from inside or outside the organization the opportunity to work on an innovative task). Whereas innovation
is understood as the result of a creative process, standards represent stability and identification of
common grounds. Both aspects are—at least at first glance—not necessarily conducive to innovation.
In the literature, innovation has been mainly described as the output of out-of-the-box thinking, which is
rather unstructured and out of the ordinary. As such, the interactions between innovation and standards
are by no means self-explanatory.
Standards are the result of many years of knowledge gathering and structuring. As such, standards are
an important source of codified knowledge. Although they are crucial to the company’s success, many
companies do not perceive the relationships between standards/standardization and innovation.
More in-depth consideration can reveal how the two processes are, or at least should be, strictly and
effectively correlated. First, as standards are a relevant source of codified knowledge, we could think of
them as a "box" that delimits and consolidates state-of-the-art approaches. In this respect, innovative
companies (to really be innovative) would need to understand the contents of the box and then deliberately
place themselves outside of this box. Second, modern standards are flexible by design and do not have to
be solution oriented; i.e. describing a particular solution to be implemented. Standards can be requirements
oriented, thus only defining a general framework, but still allowing freedom of design and interpretation.
Third, current research, especially in the information and communications technology industry, suggests
that standardization plays a crucial role in the emergence and diffusion of innovation.
The next section provides an in-depth analysis of the interdependencies among standards, standardization
and innovation. Section 5.3 deals with the relationship between standardization and research, as research
can be a fundamental component in the quest for innovation. We will demonstrate how standards and
standardization can support the research process in an effective way. Section 5.4 shows that formal
standardization can be a useful aid to innovation. In particular, it describes the so-called innovation potential
in standardization. Finally, section 5.5 summarizes the contents of the chapter as well as the key insights.

147
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

5.2 INTERDEPENDENCIES BETWEEN STANDARDIZATION AND


INNOVATION

5.2.1 INTRODUCTION TO INNOVATION


Innovation is defined by Schumpeter (1934) as the "commercialization of all new combinations based
upon the application of new materials and components, the introduction of new processes, the opening
of new markets, and/or the introduction of new organizational forms". Innovation is actually more than an
invention; it also includes the commercialization of the invention. In addition, innovation is not only limited
to final products sold to customers. It can actually happen at different levels, such as materials, processes,
services, components, markets and/or organizational forms.
The degree of novelty is an important property of innovation. Innovation can be incremental or radical.
Incremental innovation (also called evolutionary) happens when the performance of an existing technology
improves in small steps over time. In the case where the technology achieves a high level of performance
over a very short time period, the innovation is referred to as radical or revolutionary.

a - incremental b - radical
Performance

Performance

Time Time

Figure 5.1 Incremental and radical innovation

According to OECD (2005), depending on the novelty level, there are four types of innovation: New-To-the-
Firm (NTF), New-To-the-Market (NTM), New-To-the World (NTW) and disruptive innovation. NTF innovation
means that a company adopts an existing technology. For instance, an Enterprise Resource Planning
(ERP) system that is already used by other companies in an industry sector but is implemented for the first
time by a particular company is an NTF innovation. Hence, even the adoption of an existing technology
can be understood as innovation activity. The ability of companies to accommodate existing innovation
is called absorption capacity (Cohen and Levinthal 1990). Absorption capacity is understood as a firm’s

148
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

"ability to recognize the value of new information, assimilate it, and apply it to commercial ends" (Cohen
and Levinthal 1990, p. 128). NTM innovation happens when known technologies are being transferred into
a new market, whereas NTW innovation is ground-breaking and did not exist before. Disruptive innovation
(Bower and Christensen 1996) offers less performance than an established technology with respect to
a relevant feature, around which competition has taken place thus far. Because the performance of the
disruptive technology is lower, it can be produced at lower costs than the established technology. As such,
it addresses non-consumers who did not buy the established technology before. Also, because of its lower
performance, the companies in the established market do not perceive the danger of the new technology.
But the new technology can improve over time, in such a way that its performance becomes attractive to
consumers, whose needs are overshot by the established technology. Now, because the new technology
is lower priced and its performance is sufficiently good, the consumer in the established market switches to
the new technology, leaving the companies offering the established technology in trouble. This technology
is called disruptive.

5.2.2 STANDARDS AS AN ENABLER FOR INNOVATION-DRIVEN GROWTH


"Standardization and innovation give the impression of being opposites" (Perera 2010). Standardization
appears to be about keeping things the same, whereas innovation is about the development of new things.
According to David (1995) however, standards are "the flux between freedom and order".
There are many reasons why standards may have been perceived as innovation hampering. For instance,
standards contain solutions that are intended to be used repeatedly. This is often perceived as "static", as
the solution seems to be "frozen" for a certain period of time. Only when there is the necessity to develop
another solution does the old one make place for the new one (de Vries 2006b).
But standards can also promote innovation. They allow critical mass to be achieved. Standards also ensure
compatibility, allowing for innovation to take place based on other innovations. Furthermore, standards
support the diffusion of research results, thus allowing for technology transfer (de Vries 2006b).

EXAMPLE
QWERTY vs. DVORAK keyboard

'QWERTY' 'DVORAK'

Figure 5.2: QWERTY vs. DVORAK

149
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

Developed in 1879, the QWERTY keyboard was developed to slow down the typist. The layout of the
keyboard is designed in a way that makes the keys less likely to jam. In the meantime, the computer
has replaced the mechanical typewriting machine. As such, the QWERTY keyboard does not provide
any benefit. In spite of the fact that the Dvorak layout—named after its inventor Dr August Dvorak—is
superior, this design with improved ergonomics could not establish itself in the market.
Indeed, the QWERTY standard had many innovation-hampering aspects, in particular the lock-in effect.
The lock-in-effect means that when users adopt and spend time, effort and money to learn a specific
technology, they are less likely to switch to another technology (The Independent 2010). Hardware
replacement incurs high costs for users. Learning how to use a new standard, such the DVORAK
keyboard, costs users. In addition, the old standard has a network effect. The network effect is when the
value of the technology increases the more users it has. As such, it would only be attractive for users to
switch to the new standard if others do so. Consequently, everyone is waiting for the other to go for the
new technology (penguin effect).
QWERTY, however, was somehow innovation fostering. Actually, QWERTY is only the standard for the
interface between human and machine. The typewriting machine itself has been further developed,
leading to the combined use of computer and text-processing software, based on the QWERTY standard.
QWERTY is used worldwide and enables suppliers of hardware and software to benefit from economies
of scale. An improved machine without a standardized interface would not be acceptable for customers
(de Vries 2006b).

Standards support the development of new products and services, and are the foundation upon which
markets can grow. The analogy between pruning a tree to maximize its fruitfulness and the design of the
standards system to maximize innovation-led growth is a useful way to illustrate the potential of standards
in supporting innovation and growth. So, why does a tree need pruning? Pruning is important to remove
weak, dead and damaged branches and to promote healthy growth of wood. In addition, pruning is
important to thin a dense canopy on a tree in order to increase air supply and sunlight absorption, resulting
in healthy and increased flowering and fruitfulness. The trunk and branch structure plays a key role in
determining the vigour of growth, leaves and fruit. It is dysfunctional to let all shoots grow, but through
pruning, the tree has to select a shoot and concentrate its energy into the growth of this individual shoot.
Finally, pruning gives the tree the desired shape (Swann 2000).
By analogy, like pruning, which eliminates dead and weak branches, standardization limits variety but helps
to develop a "strong tree". The tree is analogous to technology. Innovation helps to grow the tree—in other
words the technology—but standardization stops messy proliferation by holding back subsequent messy
growth.

150
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Vertical Product Differentiation

Further innovations

Horizontal Product Differentiation

Represents not just innovations but standards

Key innovation

Figure 5.3 Product innovation with standardization; adapted from Swann (2000)

When applying this analogy to the evolution of standards and innovative products or services, the structure of
the standards system can be depicted by a diagram, as shown by Figure 5.3. The diagram itself represents
the technological space, and along the axes we distinguish between vertical product differentiation, which
means the further up the diagram, the greater the performance or functionality, and horizontal product
differentiation, which means that products of different designs and configurations have roughly comparable
functionality (Abbott 1955).
Starting from the first node, for example a key innovation, standards support the development of further
innovations. The usual forces of product innovation and competition continue to build a "canopy" of
competing products and services of different characteristics. Standards enable and shape this pattern
of innovation. The closer the innovations are to a standard, the greater the confidence of consumers and
producers.

151
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

If product or service innovations are developed without standardization, the same process of innovation-
led growth takes place, but a large number of slightly differentiated innovations follow different directions
from the base point. Each stage shows a substantial amount of innovation and duplicated effort. Therefore,
the potential for economies of scale is unused. The "canopy" is very dense, but the vertical product
differentiation does not reach as far as it does with formal standardization.

Vertical Product Differentiation

Horizontal Product Differentiation

Figure 5.4 Product innovation without standardization; adapted from Swann (2000)

152
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

5.2.3 STANDARDIZATION AND THE TECHNOLOGY LIFE CYCLE


The moment in time in which standardization can take place can be related to the Technology Life Cycle
(TLC), represented by an S-curve. The TLC describes the level of commercial return and improvement
in technological performance, depending on the investments in Research and Development (R&D). At
the beginning of the TLC, investments in R&D generate an increasing improvement in performance and
commercial return. This level of improvement grows slowly at the beginning, then accelerates until it reaches
a peak (tipping point), after which the rate of growth tends to decrease. The TLC, depicted by the S-curve,
consists of four phases: introduction, growth, maturity and decline.

Base
Performance Technology

Key
Technology

Pacing
Technology

Time
Introduction Growth Maturity Decline

Life phases of a technology

Figure 5.5 Technology Life Cycle over time; translated from Brockhoff (1999)

The Technology Life Cycle starts with the Introduction phase, which is characterized by a relatively slow
progress of technology performance. In this phase, the technology is still new, and no dominant design
has been established yet. This condition leads to higher competition on the market, as every market
player aims to push through its technology to a dominant design, in other words to a de facto standard.
Therefore, companies intensively invest in R&D, resulting in improved performance. In the Growth phase,
the dominant design emerges, and the performance of the technology improves at a higher pace. In
particular, there are great advances in production processes, thereby lowering costs due to economies
of scale and learning curve effects. As the technology improves further, it approaches its physical limits
that derive from the laws of nature. At this point, the technology reaches its Maturity phase. It is almost
completely adopted by the market, and the strong competition causes the market players to spend their
resources on improving production, and lowering costs. After reaching market saturation, the curve starts
to dip in the Decline phase because of decelerated development.

153
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

At the beginning of the Technology Life Cycle, during the introduction phase, the technology is called
a pacing technology. During its growth, it is a key technology, whereas during the maturity and decline
phases, the technology is called a base technology.

Performance

New
technology Technology
transition

Existing
technology
Time
Anticipatory Enabling Responsive
standards standards standards

Figure 5.6: Standards related to the Technology Life Cycle (Sherif et al. 2005)

Standards can be related to the Technology Life Cycle. There are three types of standards that are worth
introducing in this regard: anticipatory standards, enabling standards and responsive standards. Note,
however, that while this classification of the types of standards is useful, it does not rely on terminology that
is used during the standardization making process.
Anticipatory standards are "forward-looking" answers to expected technological problems. They are
essential for successful network systems. The specification of anticipatory standards runs in parallel to the
development of prototypes, pilots and field trials to condense available theoretical and practical knowledge.
Anticipatory standards also provide a way of sharing ideas. This is crucial when the risks of not collaborating
with other competitors are high. Examples of anticipatory standards are: X.25, Integrated Services Digital
Network (ISDN), Secure Sockets Layer (SSL), Bluetooth, Universal Mobile Telecommunications System

154
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

(UMTS), etc. (Egyedi and Sherif 2008). Anticipatory standards are used during the introduction phase of the
Technology Life Cycle and can lead to the acceleration of technology development as well as the reduction
of redundant development.
Enabling standards proceed in parallel with market growth and the improvement of technology and products
to enhance the agreed-upon design by extending robustness and scale. In general, competitive forces
and the need to reduce production costs influence the direction in which the standard develops. Enabling
standards support the diffusion of technical knowledge and prevent market fragmentation. Enabling
standards support the growth phase in the Technology Life Cycle. One example of enabling standards
is the V.90 Recommendation from ITU-T for modems at 56Kbit/s, used for digital communication on
traditional analogue telephone networks. Some proprietary designs of modems operating at that rate
already existed. To avoid market fragmentation and to increase the total market size, chip manufacturers
were forced to collaborate in the standardization process at ITU to develop an implementation that
would work independently of the chipset used. Some technologies rely on a mixture of anticipatory and
enabling standards. For instance, some areas of GSM (Groupe Spécial Mobile—Global System for Mobile
communications) specifications were anticipatory to define a platform for future growth both for service
operators and manufacturers, and others were enabling, defined after getting feedback from the market
(Egyedi and Sherif 2008).
Responsive standards are created at the end of technology development, in other words during the maturity
or decline phases. Internal responsive standards are defined after the dominant design has stabilized. The
main objective is to codify best practices. The advantage of external responsive standards is that they
improve efficiency or reduce market uncertainty for auxiliary product and services. Responsive standards
may also be called "business standards", as they contribute to achieving maximum return associated with
an already established technology. For instance, Transport Layer Security (TLS) is a responsive standard
following the establishment of Secure Sockets Layer (SSL). TLS/SSL are cryptographic protocols to secure
communication over a TCP/IP computer network at transport layer (Egyedi and Sherif 2008).

155
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

5.3 RESEARCH AND STANDARDIZATION


Innovation and research are related. Research is the transformation of money into knowledge, whereas
innovation is the transformation of that created knowledge into money. A successful transfer of research
results into innovative products and processes is crucial for the economy. So far, many technology transfer
instruments have been developed and implemented. Still, standardization has not been widely recognized
as an instrument that enables the transfer of knowledge from research to a practical context. Germany, for
example, at some point achieved a leading position in nanotechnology research globally, but was not able
to leverage this advantage and occupy a leading position in European and international markets due to a
delay in national standardization activities (Blind 2009).
There are actually many reasons why research results should be integrated in standards. First, companies
that build upon these standards absorb the latest knowledge. Second, standardization constitutes an
excellent mechanism to support the transfer of research results into innovative products/services. In contrast
to patents, standards are more likely to be broadly implemented because all interested stakeholders that
participated in the standardization process reached consensus. Third, publicly funded R&D results become
public goods through standards, thus increasing the economic efficiency and the economic objectives of
research subsidies (Perera 2010).

5.3.1 TRADITIONAL VS. RECURSIVE RESEARCH EXPLOITATION


Standardization and research can be closely related. Research produces knowledge that flows into
standards (traditional technology transfer), and standards can also serve as a knowledge source for
further/new R&D projects. Consequently, there is a recursive knowledge flow from standardization back to
research. This prevents the reinvention of the wheel and stimulates ideas for new research projects (Blind
2013).

nsfer
ogy tra
ol
chn
te
al
ion
dit
Tra

R&D Standardization
er
n sf
tra
gy

o
n ol
te ch
si ve
R ec ur
Barriers

Figure 5.7: Research and standardization; adapted from Blind (2009)

156
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

5.3.2 STANDARDIZATION AS A COOPERATIVE PROCESS TO SUPPORT THE


EXPLOITATION OF RESEARCH RESULTS
Standardization enables not only the transfer process of knowledge, but also cooperation. Standardization
can provide a common platform for players from heterogeneous backgrounds such as research,
industry, government, Non-Profit Organizations (NPOs), and consumers to cooperate. For example,
the standardization process not only leads to the standard, which is the final output, but also supports
the exchange of tacit knowledge among the members of the standardization committees. The standard
combines the different perspectives of many companies and other players, as the standardization process
leads to the integration of inputs from heterogeneous sources (e.g. knowledge from producers and
consumers) (Blind 2013).
Figure 5.8 displays how research and standardization can interact in a simple technology transfer model.
Research and development activities produce knowledge, which can be codified in publications and patents.
These publications and patents combined with knowledge from experts can feed the standardization
process. The process of standardization as well as the coordination work (e.g. facilitated by an SDO)
generate standards, and these standards are then implemented in practice. The implementation of the
standards feeds back to standardization (e.g. to update the standard) and research (e.g. new research
areas or insights emerge after standards have been implemented in practice).

Research

Publications
Patents

Standardization
Codification

Knowledge Participation

Standards

Implementation
Codification

Participation
Coordination

Figure 5.8: Research and standardization in a simple technology transfer model (Blind and Gauch
2009)

157
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

5.3.3 A MODEL FOR THE INTEGRATION OF STANDARDIZATION IN RESEARCH


The research and innovation process consists of different phases. Blind (2013) identifies five phases: pure
basic research, oriented basic research, applied research, experimental development, and diffusion. The
objective of pure basic research is to conduct theoretical or experimental work to generate new knowledge
of the underlying foundations. Oriented basic research aims to produce a base of knowledge that is likely to
form the background to the solution of current or future problems. Applied research constitutes an original
investigation towards an aim or objective. It involves the practical application of science. Experimental
development represents systematic work that leverages knowledge gained from research and practical
experience, while producing additional knowledge directed at producing new products. The diffusion
process deals with spreading innovation from the first implementation to wide implementation for different
consumers, countries, regions, sectors, markets and firms (OECD 2005, 2015).

Pure Oriented
Applied Experimental
basic basic Diffusion
research development
research research

S S S S
Semantic standards Measurement and Interface standards Compatibility standards
testing standards Quality standards
Variety-reducing standards

Figure 5.9: Various roles of different types of standards in the innovation process (Blind and Gauch
2009)

Standardization and research are highly interlinked. Different standards can play different roles at several
stages of the research and innovation process. Terminology or semantic standards facilitate efficient
communication. They are required in basic research as well as in the transfer of knowledge to oriented
basic research and all subsequent research activities. Measurement and testing standards allow the first
moves to be made towards product-related developments. They can be used to check whether specific
requirements have been met (e.g. performance criteria). Furthermore, they ensure the comparability of the
results through agreed-upon test methods. Interface standards allow for the interoperability of components
integrated into products or process technology, whereas compatibility, quality and variety-reducing
standards support the transition of products into mass markets (Blind and Gauch 2009).

158
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

These types of standards will be dealt with in greater detail in Chapter 8. Semantic standards and
measurement and testing standards can reduce information and transaction costs. Interface standards
drive the interoperability among components and save adaption costs. Compatibility standards, quality
standards and variety-reducing standards lead to increased quality as well as reduced health, privacy,
and safety risks, while supporting the building of critical mass. In addition, these standards support
interoperability among products, economies of scale, and the creation of network externalities.

EXAMPLE
MP3 is an excellent example that illustrates how standardization and research can support each other. The
MP3 patent is actually included in an ISO (formal) standard. Research within the Digital Audio Broadcast
(DAB) project was conducted at the University of Erlangen-Nuremberg, Germany. The first patent
applications, based on the results of the project, were filed in 1987. Also in 1987, Fraunhofer Institute for
Integrated Circuits (Fraunhofer IIS), also based in Nuremberg, Germany, started audio encoding research
as part of the DAB project. In 1989, the Moving Picture Expert Group (MPEG) standardization committee
was founded. This committee included leading companies from the industry such as Sony, Phillips and
EMI. In 1992, MPEG released MPEG-1-Layer3, known as MP3, as a standard MP3-player format. The
MP3 standard was very successful. It led to the sale of more than 100 million MP3 players and to more
than €100 million in licensing revenue for the Fraunhofer society (Blind 2009).

In spite of the importance of standardization and standards for research, there is currently limited
awareness of the benefits of standards and standardization among researchers. The broad accessibility of
standards (in contrast to scientific publications and patents) drives free-riding, and this has resulted in too
few incentives for researchers to engage in standardization. Furthermore, as standards are often driven
by strongly business-oriented industries, there may be some scepticism against researchers and research
in general and a tendency to not acknowledge their expertise as relevant to the standardization process.
Another important aspect is that standardization is a time-consuming process that may cause delay in the
transfer process and discourage researchers from working in standardization committees. In this regard,
however, it is worth noting that patenting processes often take longer than the average standardization
process of three years (Blind 2009, 2013).

159
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

5.4 FORMAL STANDARDIZATION: A DRIVER FOR INNOVATION


"Standardization is an essential part of the microeconomic infrastructure: it enables innovation and
acts as a barrier to undesirable outcomes" (Swann 2010, p. 9). Standards and standardization can
support innovation, which is as a combination of invention and exploitation. Consequently, standards
and standardization can have a positive effect on invention and exploitation. This section is based on
research conducted by Abdelkafi and Makhotin (2014) within the scope of a project funded by the German
Institute for Standardization (DIN). It investigates how German companies, in particular SMEs, can leverage
committee standards to drive innovation.
Figure 5.10 below classifies the opportunities for the support of innovation according to two dimensions.
The first dimension distinguishes between two aspects: invention and exploitation. That is, standards and
standardization can support invention by inspiring people and triggering new ideas, or can facilitate the
exploitation process by pushing commercialization and sales. The second dimension concerns whether
the innovation opportunity is derived from the company’s work with standards or participation in the
standardization process. The quadrants in the figure show the innovation opportunities, revealing how
invention and exploitation can be concretely supported. The content of these quadrants will be specifically
discussed and expanded in the following sections.

Opportunities for the support of innovation through


standards and standardization

Invention-Support... Exploitation-Support...

• Exceeding the requirements of standards • Business model innovation


...through • Efficient and target-oriented innovation (e.g. laboratories)
standards • Stimulating innovation through update
of standards and new standards

• Stimulating innovation from • Innovation communication


...through the participation in standardization process • Absorption of innovation during
standardization (ideas/insight from customers, standardization process
process competitors and other stakeholders)

Figure 5.10: Innovation potentials in standardization; adapted from Abdelkafi and Makhotin (2014,
p.46)

5.4.1 EFFICIENT AND TARGET-ORIENTED INNOVATION


Committee standards provide a useful framework for the development of new products. Standardization
increases the effectiveness of R&D activities and enables the transfer of innovations from one sector to
another. For instance, a security company sees the set of standards as the basic prerequisite in order to
not develop products "for the trash".

160
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Standards can provide a guideline for the innovation process. They enable efficient and target-oriented
innovation. The efficiency of innovation projects depends on resource inputs such as time, material, energy
and money (Spath et al. 2010). Standards can positively influence these factors, thus decreasing the
cost of generating innovation. The use of standards in development projects improves productivity and
supports target-oriented innovation. In highly innovative technological fields, quality standards ensure
reliable documentation and traceability. Both are essential for the approval of a new product. In less-
standardized fields such as nanotechnology, setting standardized testing methods supports comparability
among products, making the developers of new products aware of the requirements to be fulfilled.

IDEA

EFFICIENT TARGETED

Figure 5.11: Efficient and target-oriented innovation

5.4.2 DIFFERENTIATION
Companies can achieve a competitive advantage, depending on how well and how quickly they can
fulfil the requirements of a new standard. Standardization creates opportunities for the development
of differentiated products. This can take place when the company synchronizes its R&D process with
the standards development process and when it differentiates its products and services through the
development of customer-tailored (but standard-compliant) portfolios.
Standards represent state-of-the-art knowledge and define the requirements that apply equally to all
stakeholders. Hence, it is paradoxical to consider standards as a means of differentiation. Nevertheless,
the standard represents the foundation upon which companies can develop their unique selling points.
In effect, by knowing the requirements of the standard solution, which can be fulfilled by virtually all
competitors, the company can select the areas in which it can be different. In these areas, it can develop
specific capabilities, particularly core competencies (Prahalad and Hamel 1990), thus differentiating itself
from the competition.
Not only standards, but also the standardization process, can support differentiation. The information
advantage that participants gain during the standardization committee can be exploited within the R&D
process to achieve product differentiation (de Vries 2006a).

161
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

Information about own product development

Information from Standards Committee


Product Standardization
Development Institute
Information about own product development
Information from Standards Committee

Figure 5.12: Synchronizing the product development and standardization activities with the objectve
of differentiating own products

5.4.3 EXCEEDING THE REQUIREMENTS OF STANDARDS


Standardization and standards can drive innovation if the company sets the standard as the minimum
requirements to be achieved and then tries to do better than what the standard actually recommends.
Good standards specify requirements and leave some degree of freedom. Knowing the basic requirements
within the standards, companies are even able to develop new solutions. For instance, one company
producing equipment for security gates at airports uses the related standards as a starting point. Let us
say that the standard proposes that people traversing security gates should not be radiated with more
than five radiation units. The company sets a target to produce equipment with much lower radiation
units, whereas most of the competitors produce equipment with five radiation units. Thus, knowing the
basic requirements, which are documented in the standards, companies are able to develop "out-of-the
box" solutions. Besides the general need of increasing competitiveness, going beyond standards may be
justified by other reasons like special-purpose customer requests, marketing reasons, previous experience
or hedging against uncertainties.

162
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Standard,
standard,
standard !

If I had only used

!?!
the STANDARD as
a reference to make
my product better !

My product
with STANDARD

Figure 5.13: Exceeding the requirements of standards

5.4.4 BUSINESS MODEL INNOVATION


Standards can lead to new business models, such as test labs, consulting firms and certification
organizations. Business models describe how an organization creates value (Linder and Cantrell 2000).
Business model innovation refers to the process of renewal or design of business models (Wright et al.
2012), and standards can represent the backbone of this process. Test laboratories, consultancies and
educational services can use standards as a core element of their business models. Test laboratories, for
instance, specialize in the application of standardized procedures. By integrating new standards in the
value proposition, they can address the requirements of new customers. As such, standards constitute an
integral part of the business model, since the decision of which standards to include in or eliminate from
the portfolio determines the cost structure (e.g. additional investments) and potential sources of revenue.
Some consultancies would never be able to do business without standards, because they entirely build
their business models around standards (e.g. quality standards). For instance, in technology areas where it
is difficult to get a good overview of the relevant standards, entrepreneurs launch new start-up companies
in the field of standards to provide advice for companies that need consultancy services in the area.

163
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

I can give you all the


information you need,
I need to know about
sir!
STANDARDS!!

Customer Consultant

Figure 5.14: Business model innovation through standardization

5.4.5 INNOVATION IMPULSES


Innovation impulses can result from the update of an existing standard or after a new one is introduced.
When standards are changed over time, companies get an incentive to comply and make their products
fit the new version of the standard. The development of a completely new standard can also drive
companies to adapt their products. Hence, this process is likely to result in innovative solutions. Changes
in standards can only be transferred to innovations if certain conditions are fulfilled. First, acceptance of
the change inside the company should be high. Second, the company should be capable of integrating
the standards in its innovation process. Thus, the change of standards released by national or international
standardization bodies can be a source for innovation. It also provides a strong incentive to companies to
actively participate in standardization processes.
However, the updates of standards can be perceived as a burden for the company because of additional
development efforts. For instance, one company in the biotechnology field stated that the change of
standards could put the company in a position where it needs to update already produced products
(stock), and this leads to extra costs that are not welcomed by the company.

164
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

IDEA

Standard 3.0
IDEA

Standard 2.0
IDEA

Standard 1.0

Figure 5.15: Innovation impulses through standardization

5.4.6 INNOVATION COMMUNICATION


Companies should actively communicate their innovation capabilities. In general, companies that
participate in standard-setting processes signal know-how and high competence to the outside, which
is especially important in the Business-to-Business (B2B) field. For instance, producers that participate in
the standard-setting process can achieve compatibility of their products with market requirements and
make their customers more confident in the company’s solutions. Customers benefit from this because
they incur no risk of the product becoming obsolete after the standard has been released. In general,
innovation communication with standards helps companies to build trust with their customers, especially in
areas with rapid technology development. A company in the field of nanotechnology continuously informs
its customers about its activities in the standard-setting process, in order for the customer to know what
the company is doing. The customers, on the other hand, are quite happy to receive this up-to-date
information. Consequently, innovation communication positively contributes to the diffusion of technology.

165
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

My innovations are developed


and produceed according
to standards

IDEA

Figure 5.16: Innovation communication through standardization

5.4.7 ABSORPTION OF INNOVATION


Standardization committees are an important instrument for increasing the absorptive capacity of
companies. Absorptive capacity describes the ability of companies to transfer and apply novel and useful
external knowledge (Teece 1998; Cohen and Levinthal 1990). Companies that are in contact with their
peers during the committee meetings can absorb important technical knowledge and can even identify
new markets. Thus, companies that participate regularly in standardization processes can leverage this
innovation potential. These companies see the process as an important opportunity to gain relevant
knowledge that supports innovation. A company that produces devices that switch off electric current to
protect machines and people from electric shocks noted that not only was the development of standards
important for the company, but also the discussions with committee members that led to the identification of
new application areas for the company’s own products. This company was able to scale up its businesses
from about 20 people in the 70s to about 700 employees currently with the help of standardization.
Note that innovation diffusion and absorption are two sides of the same coin. As the knowledge is revealed
within the standardization processes, diffusion occurs, if the companies that participate in the standard
committee absorb and adopt the innovation. In addition, the diversity of the participants in the standard
committee supports the diffusion process, as people with different backgrounds can see new areas of
application of an existing technology or product.

166
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

5.5 SUMMARY
This chapter provides a comprehensive overview on the basics of standardization and innovation. First
of all, it is important to observe that sometimes standards can hamper innovation if standardization is
not adequately managed over time or if the standard induces a lock-in effect. For instance, the keyboard
example (QWERTY vs. DVORAK) shows that people find it difficult to change an established standard
and switch to a better solution. Nevertheless, we argue that the positive contribution of standards and
standardization to innovation more than outweighs its negative impacts.
We define innovation as a process and as an output of that process. Standards and standardization can
offer an essential contribution to innovation as both a process and an output, but they are more effective
in promoting incremental and evolutionary, rather than radical and disruptive innovations. The analogy
between the pruning of a tree and standardization perfectly illustrates how and why standards can support
innovation and growth. In the same way that pruning increases the fruitfulness of a tree, standardization
supports innovation-led growth by channelling and focusing the energy that companies spend to develop
a given innovation. A business landscape without standards would lead to energy distributed over many
possible evolutionary paths, resulting in large waste of resources, redundancies, and slower progress in
general.
Standards and standardization activities can be effectively related to the technology life cycle, which consists
of four phases: introduction, growth, maturity and decline. There are three types of standards that can be
used during these phases. Anticipatory standards are forward-looking and solve expected interoperability
problems. As such, they can support the introduction phase of a technology. Enabling standards are
established during the growth phase and improvement of a technology or products to enhance robustness
and scale of an agreed-upon or a dominant design. Responsive standards are created at the end of
technology development, during the maturity and decline phase. Their aim is to pick up on and document
best practices.
Standardization and standards can be very useful during the research process. The results of the research
process can be used by the standardization process to draft new standards. The other way around is also
possible, as standards can give input for the research process. Therefore, there is a recursive knowledge
flow from standardization to research. The research and innovation process consists of five different phases:
pure basic research, oriented basic research, applied research, experimental development, and diffusion.
These phases are supported by different types of standards. Terminology standards facilitate efficient
communication and are required in basic research as well as in the transfer of knowledge to oriented basic
research. Measurement and testing standards can be used to check whether specific requirements such
as performance criteria have been met, while ensuring the comparability of the results. Interface standards
allow interoperability of components, whereas compatibility, quality and variety-reducing standards support
diffusion.

167
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

Finally, the last section focuses on the innovation potential in formal standards and standardization. In
total, standards and standardization support innovation in seven ways. Standards can promote efficient
and target-oriented innovation, as products developed in compliance with available standards are more
likely to be accepted by the market and have better chances of success. Companies that participate in
standardization committees can communicate their involvement actively, resulting in a good reputation and
positive signs to the outside that they are innovative. The update of standards can also give companies
impulses for innovation, even though some companies may find such changes bothersome and annoying.
During the standardization process, companies may gain valuable knowledge that they can use to
differentiate their products from those not involved in standardization committees. In addition, the standard
can be used as a basic requirement, and companies can deliberately decide to exceed what the standard
proposes in order to generate innovations. It is also possible for some businesses to build their business
models upon standards in a given sector, for example when consulting services are offered for standards
to give companies advice on which standards are relevant for them and what the standards say. Finally,
standardization processes enable companies to identify new knowledge that can be of high value to them.
This knowledge can be used to nurture the innovation process or to identify new markets. All of these
aspects clearly demonstrate how standards and standardization can boost innovation. Companies that are
aware of all of these advantages can actively strengthen their innovation capabilities.

168
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

5.6 QUIZ

1 - WHAT IS INNOVATION?
(See Section 5.2.1 for hints)
a) Innovation is a new invention.
b) Innovation happens only at the product and service level.
c) Innovation is the combination of invention and commercialization.
d) Innovation is incremental when there is a considerable improvement of performance within a
short period of time.

2 - AN ENTERPRISE RESOURCE PLANNING (ERP) SYSTEM THAT IS ALREADY USED BY


OTHER COMPANIES IN A SECTOR, BUT ACTUALLY IMPLEMENTED FOR THE FIRST TIME
BY A PARTICULAR COMPANY IS A …
(See Section 5.2.1 for hints)
a) New-To-the-Market (NTM) innovation
b) New-To-the-Firm (NTF) innovation
c) New-To-the-World (NTW) innovation
d) Disruptive innovation

3 - QWERTY IS…
(See Section 5.2.2 for hints)
a) superior to DVORAK.
b) a formal standard.
c) a committee standard.
d) a de facto standard.

4 - THE ANALOGY BETWEEN STANDARDIZATION AND TREE PRUNING ILLUSTRATES…


(See Section 5.2.2 for hints)
a) the potential of standards in supporting innovation and growth.
b) how standards inhibit innovation.
c) that standards lead to a waste of innovation resources.
d) the chaotic nature of the innovation process.

5 - AT WHICH PHASE IN THE TECHNOLOGY LIFE CYCLE DOES A DOMINANT DESIGN


EMERGE?
(See Section 5.2.3 for hints)
a) Introduction
b) Growth
c) Maturity
d) Decline

169
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

6 - ANTICIPATORY STANDARDS…
(See Section 5.2.3 for hints)
a) proceed in parallel with market growth and improvement of technology.
b) are "forward-looking" answers to expected interoperability problems.
c) are created at the end of technology development
d) are not conducive to innovation, as they inhibit creativity.

7 - THE INNOVATION PROCESS CONSISTS OF…


(See Section 5.3.3 for hints)
a) Pure basic research, oriented basic research, applied research, and experimental development
b) Pure basic research, oriented basic research, applied research, and diffusion
c) Pure basic research, oriented basic research, applied research, experimental development and
diffusion
d) Pure basic research, applied research, experimental development, and diffusion

8 - INNOVATION IS SUPPORTED…
(See Section 5.4 for hints)
a) only by standards.
b) neither by standards nor by standardization.
c) only by the standardization process.
d) by standards and by standardization.

9 - EXCEEDING THE REQUIREMENTS OF STANDARDS IS…


(See Section 5.4.3 for hints)
a) an innovation potential, as it provides impulses for the improvement of products and
technologies.
b) a cost-increasing factor.
c) not an innovation potential, as competitors will strive to do the same.
d) not allowed because of regulations.

➜ SOLUTIONS PAGE 253

170
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

5.7 GLOSSARY
■■ Innovation: "An innovation is the implementation of a new or significantly improved product (good or
service) or process, a new marketing method, or a new organizational method in business practices,
workplace organization or external relations" (OECD 2005, p. 46).
■■ Incremental innovation: When the performance of an existing technology improves in small steps
over time. It is also called evolutionary.
■■ Radical innovation: In the case where the technology achieves a high level of performance over a
very short time period, the innovation is referred to as radical or revolutionary.
■■ Invention: "Something that has never been made before, or the process of creating something that
has never been made before" (Cambridge Dictionary n.d.).
■■ Innovation teams: As innovation requires multiple skills, in most cases multiple people form a team
to gather a wide range of skills to keep the innovation engine running (Eckert n.d.)
■■ Absorption capacity: A firm’s "ability to recognize the value of new information, assimilate it, and
apply it to commercial ends" (Cohen and Levinthal 1990, p. 128).
■■ Technology lock-in effect: The idea that the more a user uses and learns about a specific technology,
the more unlikely it is that he switches (The Independent 2010).
■■ Penguin effect: "Even if users unanimously favour a switch, each user may prefer the other to switch
first". This is based on the following analogy: penguins who have to enter the water to look for food
often delay doing so because they fear possible predators. The penguins would prefer another
penguin to test the water first. (Farrell and Saloner 1986, p. 943)
■■ Economies of scale: The average costs per unit of output decrease with the increase in the scale of
the output being produced by a firm. (OECD 2003)
■■ Anticipatory standards: "Forward-looking" answers to expected interoperability problems. They
are essential for successful network systems. Examples of anticipatory standards are: X.25,
Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN), Secure Sockets Layer (SSL), Bluetooth, Universal Mobile
Telecommunications System (UMTS).
■■ Enabling standards: Standards that proceed in parallel with market growth and improvement of
technology and products to enhance the agreed-upon design by extending robustness and scale.
One example of enabling standards is the V.90 client modem.
■■ Responsive standards: Sometimes also called "business standards", as they contribute to achieving
maximum returns associated with an already established technology. For instance, Transport Layer
Security (TLS) is a responsive standard following the establishment of Secure Sockets Layer (SSL).
TLS/SSL are cryptographic protocols to secure communication over a computer network.

5.8 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS


■■ R&D: Research and Development ■■ NPO: Non-Profit-Organization
■■ TLC: Technology Life Cycle ■■ DAB: Digital Audio Broadcast
■■ ISDN: Integrated Services Digital Network ■■ Fraunhofer IIS: Fraunhofer Institute for
■■ SSL: Secure Sockets Layer Integrated Circuits
■■ UMTS: Universal Mobile ■■ MPEG: Moving Picture Expert Group
Telecommunications System ■■ B2B: Business-to-Business

171
CHAPTER 5 - Standardization and innovation

5.9 REFERENCES
✚✚ Abbott, L. (1955). Quality and Competition: An Essay in Economic Theory. New York: Columbia University
Press.
✚✚ Abdelkafi, N., & Makhotin, S. (2014). Seizing Opportunities for the Support of Innovation through Committee
Standards and Standardization: Insights from German Companies. International Journal of IT Standards and
Standardization Research, 12, 38–56 (2014). doi:10.4018/ijitsr.2014070103
✚✚ Blind, K. (2009). Standardisation: A catalyst for innovation (Inaugural addresses research in management
series, EIA-2009-039-LIS). Rotterdam: Rotterdam School of Management, Erasmus University Rotterdam.
✚✚ Blind, K. (2013). The Impact of Standardization and Standards on Innovation: Compendium of Evidence on
the Effectiveness of Innovation Policy Intervention.
✚✚ Blind, K., & Gauch, S. (2009). Research and standardisation in nanotechnology: Evidence from Germany.
The Journal of Technology Transfer, 34, 320–342 (2009). doi:10.1007/s10961-008-9089-8
✚✚ Bower, J. L., & Christensen, C. M. (1996). Disruptive technologies: Catching the wave. Journal of Product
Innovation Management, 1(13), 75–76.
✚✚ Brockhoff, K. (1999). Forschung und Entwicklung: Planung und Kontrolle (5th ed.). München: Oldenbourg
Wissenschaftsverlag.
✚✚ Cambridge Dictionary. (n.d.). Invention.
https://dictionary.cambridge.org/de/worterbuch/englisch/invention. Accessed 14 February 2018.
✚✚ Cohen, W. M., & Levinthal, D. A. (1990). Absorptive Capacity: A New Perspective on Learning and
Innovation. Administrative Science Quarterly, 35, 128–152 (1990). doi:10.2307/2393553
✚✚ David, P. (1995). Standardization policies for network technologies: The flux between freedom and order
revisited. In R. Hawkins, R. Mansell, & J. Skea (Eds.), Standards, Innovation and Competitiveness: The
Politics and Economics of Standards in Natural and Technical Environments.
✚✚ de Vries, H. (2006a). IT Standards Typology. In K. Jakobs (Ed.), Advanced Topics in Information Technology
Standards and Standardization Research, Volume 1 (pp. 1–26): IGI Global.
✚✚ de Vries, H. (2006b). The paradox of standardization and innovation. ISO Focus, 3(3), 40–43.
✚✚ Eckert, B. (n.d.). Top 10 Innovation Drivers.
http://innovationexcellence.com/blog/2011/12/23/top-10-innovation-drivers/. Accessed 14 March 2018.
✚✚ Egyedi, T. M., & Sherif, M. H. (2008). Standards’ dynamics through an innovation lens: Next generation
ethernet networks. In 2008 Innovations in NGN - Future Network and Services, An ITU-T Kaleidoscope
Conference (K-INGN), Geneva, Switzerland, 12.05.2008 - 13.05.2008 (pp. 127–134): IEEE. doi:10.1109/
KINGN.2008.4542258
✚✚ Farrell, J., & Saloner, G. (1986). Installed base and compatibility: Innovation, product preannouncements,
and predation. The American Economic Review, 940–955.
✚✚ Linder, J., & Cantrell, S. (2000). Changing business models: Surveying the landscape. Accenture Institute for
Strategic Change.
✚✚ OECD. (2003). Economies of Scale.
https://stats.oecd.org/glossary/detail.asp?ID=3203. Accessed 14 February 2018.
✚✚ OECD. (2005). Oslo manual: Guidelines for collecting and interpreting innovation data (3rd ed.,
SourceOECD). Paris: OECD.

172
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

✚✚ OECD. (2015). Concepts and definitions for identifying R&D. In OECD (Ed.), Frascati Manual 2015:
Guidelines for Collecting and Reporting Data on Research and Experimental Development (pp. 43–79, The
Measurement of Scientific, Technological and Innovation Activities). Paris: OECD Publishing.
✚✚ Perera, C. (2010). Standardization and Innovation. In W. Hesser, A. J. Feilzer, & H. J. de Vries (Eds.),
Standardisation in companies and markets (3rd ed., pp. 403–442). Hamburg, Rotterdam: Helmut-Schmidt-
Universität; Erasmus University of Rotterdam.
✚✚ Prahalad, C. K., & Hamel, G. (1990). The Core Competence of the Corporation. Harvard Business Review,
79–91 (1990). doi:10.1016/B978-0-7506-7088-3.50006-1
✚✚ Schumpeter, J. A. (1934). The Theory of Economic Development. Cambridge, Massachusetts: Harvard
University Press.
✚✚ Sherif, M. H., Egyedi, T. M., & Jakobs, K. (2005). Standards of quality and quality of standards for
telecommunications and information technologies. In T. M. Egyedi & M. H. Sherif (Eds.), Proceedings of the
4th International Conference on Standardization and Innovation in Information Technology: September 21-
23 2005, ITU, Geneva, Switzerland (pp. 208–217). Piscataway NJ: IEEE.
✚✚ Spath, D., Pastewski, N., & Lang-Koetz, C. (2010). Managing New Technologies for Resource Efficient
Innovations: Results from Current Studies.
✚✚ Swann, G. M. P. (2000). The Economics of Standardization. Final Report for Standards and Technical
Regulations Directorate Department of Trade and Industry. Manchester Business School.
https://www.gov.uk/government/uploads/system/uploads/attachment_data/file/16506/The_Economics_of_
Standardization_-_in_English.pdf. Accessed 1 January 2015.
✚✚ Swann, G. M. P. (2010). The Economics of Standardization: An Update. Report for the UK Department of
Business, Innovation and Skills (BIS) (Version 2.2).
✚✚ Teece, D. J. (1998). Capturing value from knowledge assets: The new economy, markets for know-how,
and intangible assets. California Management Review, 40(3), 55–79.
✚✚ The Independent. (2010). Facebook may "lock in" its internet dominance.
http://www.independent.co.uk/incoming/facebook-may-lock-in-its-internet-dominance-5519916.html.
Accessed 15 March 2018.
✚✚ Wright, C., Sturdy, A., & Wylie, N. (2012). Management innovation through standardization: Consultants
as standardizers of organizational practice. Research Policy, 41, 652–662 (2012). doi:10.1016/j.
respol.2011.12.004

173
CHAPTER 6 - A strategic perspective on standardization

6 A STRATEGIC PERSPECTIVE ON STANDARDIZATION

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
The objective of this chapter is to explain the motives and methods of participation in standardization
activities from the perspective of an interested organization, both strategically and technically.
This includes dealing with aspects such as the choice of which standards organizations, SDOs, to
participate in, and the coordination of the organization’s external and internal activities, including
internal specifications and rules.
Some explanation is given regarding the choice of suitable standards for a given application.

6.1 INTRODUCTION
This chapter looks at participation in standardization from the perspective of an organization interested in
getting involved in standardization, looking both at strategic and technical aspects.
It looks at different strategies that organizations may have for participation, and at the choice of which SDO
to join, as a function of scope of activities and of geographical location. It also looks at the more technical
aspects of standardization, including implementation of standards.
Addressed is also the operation of standardization efforts and SDOs, including voting, and the impact of
external influences.
Next, the communication aspects of standardization efforts are discussed, again from the perspective of
a participating organization.
The chapter concludes with a section with guidance on how to select standards for a given application.
It gives useful considerations for evaluating the different possibilities that should result in criteria for the
selection of the most suitable set of standards.

174
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

6.2 DIFFERENT STRATEGIES FOR PARTICIPATION


This section addresses both the organizational, technology and technical aspects of participation in
standardization, including motives, objectives and strategy.

6.2.1 ORGANIZATIONAL STRATEGIES


Organizations can be classified according to which role they play and intend to play in the standardization
ecosystem, using here a classification according to Corporate Strategic Standardization Management
(SSM).
The role that standardization plays for the organization is a function of how important standardization and/
or presence in standardization is for the overall, primarily business-oriented, strategy. Active participation
should be seen as a strategic tool that needs to be carefully managed, and needs to be aligned with the
organization’s overall, primarily business strategy. This is illustrated in Table 6.1.

LEADER CONTRIBUTOR FOLLOWER SPECTATOR

■■ Participation in standards- ■■ Active participation in ■■ Full membership privileges ■■ Main motivation:


setting activity is business standardization process wanted intelligence gathering
critical ■■ Less interested in ■■ Not interested in ■■ No active contribution to
influencing the strategic influencing the strategic the creation of a standard
direction of an SDO direction

Table 6.1: Organizations classified by their participation strategy

An organization may have a differentiated approach and may participate in different domains with different
objectives, such as the protection of its business interests, early warning for technological and market
developments, promotion of IPR and internal as well as proprietary standards, avoiding duplication between
countries or continents, etc. This also means that different roles may be taken, such as a leader in one
domain, spectator in another, etc. This in turn may lead to issues of perception by peers; for instance, an
organization might be expected to be a leader in other domains in addition to its main priorities.
The business strategy is supported by a set of technology strategies. The standardization strategy of
an organization is therefore driven by both the business strategy itself and by the derived technology
strategies. To understand the standardization strategy of an organization, it is also useful to at least know
and understand its supporting technology strategies.

6.2.2 TECHNICAL FOCUS


Where and how to participate will be a function of the technical needs and priorities of an organization.
Priority will certainly be given to standardization topics related to the core activities of the organization.
However, the market and development of these core activities may depend on the availability and
functionality of the infrastructure (telecom and non-telecom) and of related activities such as privacy and
security requirements and support. Therefore, the organization may decide to also be present in domains
of activity related to, but outside of its core activities. An example is given in the next section.

175
CHAPTER 6 - A strategic perspective on standardization

ORGANIZATION TYPICAL TECHNICAL FOCUS OF ICT ACTIVITY

ITU Interoperable telecom specifications, incl. architecture, services, protocols, addressing/numbering plans

ISO ICT, incl. architecture, services, protocols incl. application protocols

IEC Electrotechnical standards, incl. connectors, electrical safety, EMC and tests

JTC 1 ICT, incl. architecture, services, protocols incl. application protocols

ETSI Interoperable telecom specifications, incl. architecture, services, protocols and tests

CEN ICT, incl. architecture, services, protocols incl. application protocols

CENELEC Electrotechnical standards, incl. connectors, electrical safety, EMC and tests

CEN/CENELEC ICT architecture (OSI model) services, protocols incl. application protocols

IEEE A wide range of technical and electrotechnical domains, incl. all LAN specifications: IEEE 802.xx, cabled
LANs, Wireless LANs (WLAN), e.g. Wi-Fi

IETF All Internet-related specifications, including protocols, generic applications, addressing rules (IP, URL)

ECMA Media specifications, ICT specifications fed into ETSI, ISO/IEC, IEEE, etc
INTERNATIONAL

Table 6.2: A simplified, non-exhaustive overview of the ICT standardization ecosystem

Architecture, including networking architecture, is essential in standardization as well as in the technology


strategies supporting a business strategy. In standardization, for example, at ITU and ETSI, the architecture
is defined as part of the three-stage development process. And, whereas few implementations of a full
Open Systems Interconnection model (OSI) stack are still in use, the OSI reference model, including the
description of concatenation and overlay networks in the Internal Organization of the Network Layer (IONL),
is still used as reference for networking architecture.

6.2.3 LOCATIONS AND RELATIONS AMONG SDOS


In deciding in which SDOs to participate, the interrelations among the SDOs, and the status of an SDO
with respect to public authorities, may play an important role. For example, for ETSI members, the status
of ETSI as a recognized EU standardization body, and its relations with ITU, CEN/CENELEC and IEEE are
important, and have probably played their part in member organizations choosing to participate in ETSI
activities.
The geographical location, in particular in which continent, and the locations where meetings take place
also play a role in deciding in which SDO to participate.

176
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

The geographical location may create organizational complications for an organization, as this location may
not coincide with its geographic organization. For example, the standardization activity may take place in
a different continent to the geographic location of the entity with the corresponding technical responsibility
within the organization.
It is to be noted that standards organizations typically are Non-Governmental Organizations (NGOs), with
the legal status of non-profit organizations.
An exception is the ITU, which became a United Nations organization, mainly due to its long history of
existence—since 1865—as an international committee.

DOMAIN OF STANDARDS
ORGANIZATION TYPE HEADQUARTERS RECOGNITION MEMBERS
ACTIVITY "FEEDING"

Telecom + RF National
ITU UN Geneva (CH) UN > JTC 1
spectrum delegations

National
ISO NGO Geneva (CH) Multi-national ICT > ITU
delegations

National
IEC NGO Geneva (CH) Multi-national Electrotechnical (> ITU)
delegations

Joint comm. ISO National


JTC 1 NGO Geneva (CH) Multi-national > ITU
+ IEC delegations

ETSI NGO Sophia Ant (FR) Multi-nat. / EU Telecom Organizations > ITU

National
CEN NGO Brussels (BE) Multi-nat. / EU ICT > ISO
delegations

National
CENELEC NGO Brussels (BE) Multi-nat. / EU Electrotechnical > IEC
delegations

Joint comm. CEN National


CEN/CENELEC NGO Brussels (BE) Multi-nat. / EU > ISO + IEC
+ CLC delegations

ICT +
IEEE NGO New York (US) De facto Individuals > ISO
electrotechnical

IETF NGO Fremont (US) De facto ICT (Internet) Individuals (> ITU + ISO)

ECMA
NGO Geneva (CH) De facto ICT Organizations > ISO
INTERNATIONAL

Table 6.3: A simplified classification of SDOs by geographical scope and technical domain

177
CHAPTER 6 - A strategic perspective on standardization

6.2.4 TECHNOLOGY STRATEGIES


Apart from showing presence, which may be rather important from a marketing or a public relations
perspective, there are also key technology-related considerations for participation:
■ The "radar" function: standardization gives an excellent insight into technologies and applications
that may become important in the (near) future.
■ The activity of other participants may be an indication of their level of R&D activity and positioning
with respect to the state of the art, and/or an indication of the priority as well as importance that an
organization gives to a certain development.
■ The participation may be used to provide information for the formation of consortia, interest groups,
fora, etc.
■ The participation may help promote ideas and solutions, including IPR.
■ The scale of the standards development may incite dialogue with public authorities, giving a preview
of public support, measures and concerns.

As stated before, organizations may also decide to be active in standardization activities that do not
correspond to their core activities. In this case, it is unlikely that these organizations will have the same level
of competence in these domains, in comparison with their core activities and competencies, and therefore
may have more limited possibilities to contribute.

EXAMPLE
A telecom services operator targeting involvement in Intelligent Transport Systems may need to follow
standardization efforts related to telecom infrastructure, ITS infrastructure and road infrastructure.
However, the technical areas in which the operator would be able to significantly contribute on road
infrastructure, for example, may be limited.

An organization leading in a domain may take an active role in new developments, or it may take a defensive
role. It might not look favourably on standardization activities that might result in competition for standards
in which it has invested.

178
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

6.3 CONDITIONS AND EXTERNAL INFLUENCES


This section deals with factors and boundary conditions that have an impact on the standardization process,
from the perspective of a participating organization. In the following section, we will look at relations within
the standards ecosystem as well as the external factors and influences.

FACTORS AND BOUNDARY CONDITIONS THAT HAVE


AN IMPACT ON THE STANDARDISATION PROCESS:

STANDARDS SETTING ENVIRONMENT

STAKEHOLDERS

EXTERNAL
STANDARDS INFLUENCES
SETTING

STANDARD(s)

Figure 6.1: A very simple view of what influences a standard (Jakobs 2014)

6.3.1 MANAGING THE RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN STANDARDIZATION AND


MARKETS
There is a strong interrelation between standardization, technical development and market development.
Managing the relationship is challenging and needs to take into consideration, as far as possible, dynamic
market trends, developments, and market forces, as well as technology developments and their industrial
applicability and maturity.
Active participation in standardization requires good insight and knowledge about a company’s or an
organization’s objectives, policies, market and financial position, and ongoing research and development.
This also requires deep insight and a good assessment of the technology’s opportunities for development,
roadmaps, and uncertainties. Uncertainties may include "unknown unknowns". Included in the latter category
is unexpected competition developing among different technologies, i.e. the domain of application of one
technology overlapping with the domain of application of another technology. But also the application of a
given technology unexpectedly becoming more prominent in the market than was foreseen.

179
CHAPTER 6 - A strategic perspective on standardization

EXAMPLE
Here are a number of examples, cases in which most industry observers were surprised by events:
The first example is the importance of SMS and of roaming in GSM cellular wireless communications. In
follow-on technologies (3G, 4G) and in regulation this has been taken fully into consideration.
A second example is the overlap in application domains between wireless communication and fixed
network technology. Whereas there is still significant complementarity between fixed and wireless
networks, the area of overlap is much larger than had been expected initially.
Another example is the use of generic data services on modern higher speed networks (fixed as well as
wireless) to support services such as voice over IP and conferencing over IP, strongly competing with the
equivalent dedicated services such as voice, audio, video conferencing, etc.
A final example is the user interface, evolving from character mode to graphic mode, to colour graphic
mode, then to touch and voice recognition.

6.3.2 MANAGING COOPERATION


Standardization is a competitive domain, but one that requires cooperation to produce results. This requires
competitors to work together as partners. Such cooperation can take two modes of operation: active
cooperation and passive cooperation.
Active cooperation requires partners and competitors to work actively together on the development of
a standard or specification, including technical details, as well as promotion outside of the SDO. This
often reveals different visions, different product strategies, and interests that go well beyond the personal
preferences of individuals or organizations.
As such, tensions may arise when working on technical issues, some of which may be related to diverging
product strategies. For example, during the development of the specification for a carrier service, the
requirements may be perceived differently by participants intending to use it for film and TV distribution and
by participants targeting general "Internet" services, where the latter may accept much higher tolerances
in quality-of-service parameters.
Passive cooperation may be a pragmatic and "honourable" attitude in standardization; it does not, however,
give any indication of commitment for the support and adoption of the results, and therefore does not
prevent less successful standards nor the proliferation of standards ("you have your standard; I have my
standard").

6.3.3 MANAGING SYNCHRONIZATION


Standardization may be considered as leading, in sync or following with regard to developments, including
technology developments and trends, market developments and value chain ordering, market push and
pull, societal trends and developments, and last but not least, the legal and regulatory environment.
Leading, i.e. early standardization, means that not all issues and requirements are fully known or understood.
This results in standards of the anticipatory type (see Chapter 4)
In sync, i.e. "just-in-time" standardization, needs the process to be agile and may need flexibility to adapt
to and stay in sync with technological development. By staying in sync, standards of the enabling type are
produced (see Chapter 4)

180
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Following, i.e. "late" standardization, may mean a catch-up with a de facto situation, or with a dominant
design. This leads to the generation of standards of the so-called responsive type (see Chapter 4)

EXAMPLE
An analysis of these principles can be made by taking GSM as an example. GSM consists of a rather
complex system of a range of functions; for each function, one or more standards were developed.
A detailed evaluation of different technical aspects of the relevant GSM standards versus market
developments, including unforeseen developments in the market, gives differentiated results.
It must be stressed that this evaluation is based on what we know now, and how we look at it now, in
other words, roughly 30 years after the development (hindsight).
The subjects of leading, and therefore rather anticipatory, standardization were the included data services
and roaming, for which respectively limited data rates and limited usage were expected.
The subject of in sync, and therefore enabling, standardization was, and is, cellular organization, including
handover, etc.
The subject of following standardization, but mainly in the sense of adopting elements of dominant design
and existing standards, in particular ISDN, was the 64 kbit/s virtual circuit channel structure, while coding
techniques had advanced to a level allowing for example an 8 kbit/s virtual circuit channel structure.

6.3.4 VOTING AND VOTING RULES


This section deals with the conditions and voting rules applied in different organizations. Different standards
organizations have different voting rules, such as:
■■ weighted voting, based on category, size, etc.; for example: ETSI, CEN/CENELEC
■■ individual expert vote, based on regular attendance; for example: IEEE802, IETF

At ETSI, the issue of a possible imbalance between the total votes of different categories of members has been
raised because of the weighted voting rights being linked to the declared size of the telecommunications-
related revenues of member organizations. Large organizations represented by delegations from different
countries accumulate significant amounts of weighted, revenue-linked voting rights (while at the same time
paying a large accumulated fee or contribution).
Also, the interests of an SDO as an organization itself may play a role in how it handles standardization
developments. The SDO’s operational entities, in other words its secretariat and governance entities, likely
have a role in relations with members, other SDOs and with public authorities. The organization’s overall
vision, roadmaps and interests may play a role in the evaluation to accept or reject proposals for new
standards. This might even play a role in the voting on the acceptance or rejection of a standard, for example
whether the standard fits in with the organization’s views and cooperation with partner organizations.
Public authorities address their communications and requests mainly to an SDO as an organization. For
example, the European Commission as a customer and as a sponsor addresses its communications first
to the ETSI and CEN/CENELEC secretariats, giving them a clear role, at least in terms of communication,
between the European Commission and the respective membership.

181
CHAPTER 6 - A strategic perspective on standardization

6.3.5 "BACKDOOR POLICY"


The so-called "backdoor policy" is when a group of stakeholders decide to switch to another SDO when
a first-choice SDO and its members are not favourable when it comes to undertaking or accepting a new
standardization activity. This brings with it opportunities and issues. While the "backdoor" circumvents
blockage of new or different approaches, it carries with it the risk of duplication of efforts and the proliferation
of standards.
Ecma International has played a role as an alternative standards route of this type. For example, industry
standards for "private telecommunications" such as X.25 and ISDN found a more advanced and flexible
alternative to the more restrictive public SDOs.
However, a "backdoor policy" together with passive cooperation may also lead to significant issues, as was
demonstrated in the case of ECMA-376.

EXAMPLE
A standard for "Office Open XML File Formats" was developed at Ecma International on the basis of
material submitted by Microsoft, and was adopted as ECMA-376.
ECMA-376 was then submitted to Joint Technical Committee 1 (JTC 1), using the "fast-track" procedure
(a simplified voting procedure for standard proposals that have already passed an adoption procedure,
considered indicative of the level of consensus).
ECMA-376 initially failed to pass, was amended, and, not without controversy, became ISO/IEC 29500.
The controversy stems from this standard being considered to overlap with ISO/IEC 26300, OASIS (Open
Document Format for Office Applications), in other words, Microsoft-originating file formats versus "Open
Office" / "Open Document" formats.

6.3.6 STANDARDS PORTFOLIO MANAGEMENT / TECHNOLOGY DEVELOPMENT


Ideally, standardization takes place "just in time" (or better, "in sync"), i.e. when technological development
and market requirements have arrived at a complementary and supportive level of expected maturity. This
is not always achieved, resulting in initial and possible "growing pains" between the evolving technological
state-of-the-art and/or market requirements, and the developed standard.
It may be considered normal, however, during the lifetime of a standard, for "stress" to develop between
a standard and technological advances and/or changing market requirements, resulting in standards
needing updating and amending, or eventually losing importance or being withdrawn.
Today, we all consider that technology and markets are developing at a fast pace. However, this is only
partially applicable to infrastructure, which has a greatly delayed connection to the fast developments
of technology, as deployment and roll-out of infrastructure takes significantly more time. Therefore,
equipment that interfaces with infrastructure will be developed in synchronization with the development of
the underlying technology, at least for the interface and related parts.

182
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

EXAMPLE
As an example, in most Western European countries there is still work ongoing to complete the coverage
of the territory with 2G/GSM. In fact, operators may be working in parallel to deploy 2G, 3G, 4G, and
soon 5G, infrastructure and services. Mobile phones need still to support 2G, as it still has the widest
coverage. Similarly, standardization in 3GPP needs to consider maintenance of 2G and 3G, bug fixes in
4G and requirements for 5G.
The strict adherence to (sub-)layer independence, as stipulated and promoted by, among others, the ISO
model, has allowed "legacy" infrastructure to be used with protocols and coding techniques that were
not known when the infrastructure was designed. A more extreme example is that of telecommunication
satellites, launched decades ago, now transmitting digitally coded signals. It is indeed rather difficult to do
repairs and upgrades on satellites.

6.3.7 MANAGING PHASES OF STANDARDIZATION


Standardization needs to consider the following external aspects of management.
Standards need to comply with legal, regulatory and other requirements concerning materials, safety, safe
practices, security, etc.
Standards need to coexist with existing systems or those developing in parallel. The concept of coexistence
is relatively new and increasingly important. In particular, coexistence is of importance for access to the
frequency spectrum. In the past, radio systems were mostly allocated unique frequency bands; however,
due to the sharp increase in the cumulative bandwidth required for wireless systems, frequency spectrum
management now accepts reuse, overlap with and sharing of frequency bands, which introduces significant
coexistence requirements.
Although this may be achieved only partially, standards need to achieve interoperability among the different
implementations of equipment and services using them.

6.3.8 OTHER ACTIVITIES


SDOs may be initiated by an industry or industry groups with other related activities. They may also be
enablers of platforms for related activities, and may take on other roles for the benefit of their members. An
initiative at ETSI to address the concerns of the European Commission regarding the timing and conditions
of the introduction of the Radio Equipment Directive (RED) is an example of what could be considered a
natural consequence of the presence of the stakeholders, and therefore as a natural extension of ETSI’s
role.

183
CHAPTER 6 - A strategic perspective on standardization

6.4 COMMUNICATION WITHIN STANDARDIZATION ACTIVITIES


The requirements for senior standardization experts include the right mix of leadership, technical and/
or market vision, technical competence, communication skills and representativeness, diplomacy and
negotiation skills.
Meeting all these requirements requires highly skilled and communicative persons with full support from
top management. This requires the organization to recruit or train senior standardization experts and give
them the means to communicate with all levels of the organization.
Often, however, only some of these conditions are met and, consequently, standardization experts may
lack some of the critical support needed to fully perform their tasks.
One of the reasons for this is that senior standards experts would need access to top-level persons in a
large part of the organization, as a "non-resident"; this requires privileges that, in an organization, may be
restricted to high-level officials, e.g. vice-presidents and higher.
An alternative would be for the individual expert or for the internal standardization entity to obtain a high
level of recognition from other entities in the organization. However, this may lead to incomplete access to
the necessary information and to informal exchange of information.
The best solution is to have a "standardization champion" in top management to coordinate and stimulate
the support and effectiveness of standardization activities.

6.5 CHOOSING YOUR STANDARD(S)

6.5.1 THE STANDARDIZATION PROCESS FROM AN IMPLEMENTATION


PERSPECTIVE
The ultimate goal of standardization is the implementation of the resulting standards in products and
services, for the benefit of users and industry as a whole.
Excellent examples of successful standardization are the sets of standards for 2G, 3G and 4G mobile
networks (with 5G under development). These sets of standards have achieved wide acceptance in global
markets. Technically, these standards excel in achieving interoperability, as is demonstrated by almost
flawless international roaming capabilities.

6.5.2 WHAT TO TAKE INTO CONSIDERATION


Selecting standards and/or specifications for your application.
Since the need for compliance with numerous standards and specifications is increasing, and the perception
of the distinction between committee standards and de facto standards is diminishing, this section gives
some practical considerations and steps to select the most suitable set of standards and specifications to
adhere to when implementing a given application.
In some cases, choosing the standards you will need to adhere to may be rather simple. For example,
when the intention is to bring to the market products supporting access to 2G, 3G and 4G networks, the
choice is obvious (even though in practice there are many optional features). There is a complete suite of
standards and tests available.

184
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Less clear, however, is the choice when, for example, products are aimed at the "smart anything
everywhere" market, where there is a choice of many different wireless networks (including supporting
access to "LPWANs" such as LoRa, Sigfox, Ingenu, in addition to 2G, 3G, 4G or the forthcoming 5G).
In the following pages, some considerations, criteria and guidance for selecting the standard(s) in such
cases are provided. Note, however, that these criteria are only intended to help and provide guidance, and
are not be used as, a "1-2-3 decision machine". Furthermore, to be comprehensive, a simplified overview
is given.
Interest in standards in a specific case may range from the need to specify compatibility and/or interoperability
in procurement, purchasing sub-systems or systems required to implement certain standards, to
developing "in-house" products or services that need to comply with standards and interoperate with other
implementations. The issue of "developing products that comply with standards" is particularly challenging.
In the following, we provide some important criteria by means of questions that should help organizations
in the standards evaluation task.
Completeness: is this standard / set of standards all that is needed, or is it the tip of the iceberg; what other
standards are needed to support or complement this/these standard(s)?
Stability: is this standard new and still developing; is it mature and widely adopted and tested; is it aging
and needs to be brought up to date (legacy components, coexistence and interoperability with more recent
systems); is there an installed base, and what is its influence (stability, but also inertia)?
Maintenance: is maintenance of the standards ensured; are there other mechanisms to learn about issues,
workarounds, and de-facto reference implementations?
Interoperability and conformance: are good conformance tests and test facilities available; what is the
required level of interoperability, does it need to be demonstrated, is it a condition sine qua non; what
is the scope of the required interoperability: some functions, a subset, all functions; is interoperability
required with the standard or with a dominant implementation (that itself may be only partially compliant
with the standard or specification); are good interoperability tests and test facilities available; what level of
interoperability is demonstrated by products on the market?
Assuming that implementation of the standard(s) is targeted, then interoperability is of key importance.
Interoperability is often achieved only partially. Conformance is a prerequisite, but not a sufficient condition
for interoperability. Complementary "plugtest" testing is a very useful addition, but by itself may not
guarantee general interoperability either.
The next step in the evaluation process would be to attribute a weight to these parameters, which may
range from less important to a condition sine qua non, in other words, a blocking factor if not met.
6.5.3 Supporting standard "X": what next?
After making a choice, you implement a specific set of standards and specifications. This choice, but
equally the results of the detailed evaluation that led to this choice, may influence your position: you are
now a stakeholder with an interest in a specific standard "X". And this then may be an argument to change
some of your priorities in participation in standardization. This may include increased participation, or more
focused participation.
For example, the interest may now be on increased involvement, supporting, improving or completing the
selected standard(s) and specifications, adding or improving interoperability tests and testing, etc.

185
CHAPTER 6 - A strategic perspective on standardization

6.5.3 WHAT IF A SUITABLE SET OF STANDARDS OR SPECIFICATIONS CANNOT BE


FOUND?
If, after your internal evaluation, you cannot come up with a suitable set of standards or specifications, it is
recommended that you consult with your partners (suppliers, customers and competitors). If the subject
appears suitable for an existing SDO, then direct your request, along with your reasons, to what you
consider to be the most suitable standards organization. If the subject appears less suitable for an existing
SDO, then consider pitching it to a suitable industry forum.
If the subject does not appear to fit anywhere, then consider setting up your own forum, together with
partners, including competitors. An industry specification developed in this manner could later gain the
status of a "publicly available specification". It could also become a committee standard if, in the meantime,
interest in the subject has increased and become more widespread.

6.6 SUMMARY
In this chapter, participation in standardization is dealt with from the perspective of an organization interested
in getting involved.
In addition to the different reasons that organizations may have to participate, this chapter examined how
to choose a standards organization (SDO) to participate in, as a function of the domain of activities and
possibly of geographical location. It also dealt with technology aspects.
This chapter also addressed the operation of standardization efforts and organizations, including voting
systems and rights, and external influences. Among the important external influences are market trends
and developments, which may also be considered the most difficult influences to deal with. It is also
considered that standardization in general is closely linked to technological development. However, this
is not a guarantee that each standard has taken all relevant technological development sufficiently into
account. The relevance may evolve, or become visible only (long) after a standard has been published.
As presented, participation in standardization requires internal and external communication within
an organization. It also requires in-house company rules and specifications to be linked with external
standardization. To succeed in their tasks, standardization experts should have the possibility to
communicate with virtually everybody anywhere in the organization.
Finally, the chapter discussed some considerations to help evaluate and choose standards for a certain
application. It also dealt with the consequences of both the evaluation and the resulting choices. Effectively,
a stakeholder that takes a different perspective can influence certain standards activities.

186
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

6.7 QUIZ

1 - WHEN IS AN ORGANIZATION PARTICIPATING IN STANDARDIZATION CONSIDERED A


"LEADER"?
(See Section 6.2 for hints)
a) When it develops more standards than others
b) When other organizations use its ideas
c) When standardization is business critical for the organization
d) When it pays the highest membership fees

2 - WHAT IS THE FORMAL STATUS OF MOST STANDARDIZATION ORGANIZATIONS?


(See Section 6.2 for hints)
a) They are part of the ministry of internal affairs
b) They are part of the ministry for trade and foreign affairs
c) They are, non-governmental organizations (NGOs) registered as legal entities, like non-profits
d) They are part of United Nations organizations, like the IMF and WHO

3 - CAN AN ORGANIZATION BE A MEMBER OF BOTH CEN/CENELEC AND ETSI?


(See Section 6.2 for hints)
a) No, CEN/CENELEC has national organizations as members, ETSI only accepts companies
b) Yes, but only national standards organizations can be a member of both CEN/CENELEC and
ETSI
c) No, because ETSI only accepts commercial organizations that pay a membership fee
d) Yes, because commercial organizations can be members of both CEN/CENELEC and ETSI

4 - WHICH STANDARDS ORGANIZATIONS HAVE A "ONE MAN, ONE VOTE" RULE?


(See Section 6.3 for hints)
a) CEN/CENELEC, because each member organization can vote only once
b) ETSI, as only one person can vote from each organization
c) IEEE and the IETF, as votes are given to individuals with regular attendance
d) ITU, as only the Director is allowed to vote

5 - IS IT EASIER TO OBTAIN A LARGE VOTING RIGHT IN ETSI THAN IN THE IETF?


(See Section 6.3 for hints)
a) Yes, because you can "buy" votes by accumulating high membership fees
b) No, because in the IETF an organization can send many people to a few meetings
c) They are about the same, as both require resources: in the IETF an organization could send more
people, in ETSI an organization would need a significant amount of revenue and fees
d) Yes, because in the IETF an organization gets disqualified if it sends too many people

187
CHAPTER 6 - A strategic perspective on standardization

6 - WHAT MAKES A STANDARD PROPRIETARY?


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) It is widely used
b) An organization holds an essential patent limiting its use by others
c) It is very comprehensive and comes with a complete test suite
d) It has been developed in isolation by a single or a closed group of organizations

7 - WHO IS RESPONSIBLE FOR THE MAINTENANCE OF STANDARDS?


(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) In the EU, the European Commission
b) ETSI and CEN/CENELEC
c) Strictly speaking, nobody: there is a moral but no legal obligation for the organization that has
developed and/or adopted and published a standard to maintain the standard
d) The users, as they represent the biggest test environment

8 - TO TEST INTEROPERABILITY, IS ONE-TO-ONE TESTING SUCH AS "PLUGTEST" BETTER


THAN CONFORMANCE AND INTEROPERABILITY TESTING?
(See Section 6.5 for hints)
a) One-to-one testing, such as "plugtest", and interoperability testing are equivalent
b) One-to-one testing, such as "plugtest", and interoperability are complementary
c) One-to-one testing, such as "plugtest", is better because it tests two systems connected to each
other
d) Interoperability testing is better as it tests against a reference implementation

➜ SOLUTIONS PAGE 255

188
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

6.8 GLOSSARY
■■ Backdoor policy: To switch to another SDO when a first-choice SDO does not want to undertake or
accept a new standardization activity.
■■ Proprietary standard: A standard developed and controlled by a single or a small group of organizations

6.9 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS


■■ SDO: Standards Development Organization ■■ IEC: International Electrotechnical
■■ SSM: (Corporate) Strategic Standardization Commission
Management ■■ JTC 1: Joint Technical Committee 1 (an
■■ ISO: International Organization for ISO/IEC joint technical committee)
Standardization

6.10 REFERENCES
✚✚ Abdelkafi, N., & Makhotin, S. (2012). Seizing Opportunities for the Support of Innovation through Committee
Standards and Standardization – Insights from German Companies. (12), pp. 38-56.
✚✚ Jakobs, K. (2007). ICT Standards Development — Finding the Best Platform. In G. Doumeingts, J. Müller,
G. Morel, & B. Vallespir, Enterprise Interoperability (pp. 543-552). London: Springer.
✚✚ Jakobs, K. (2013). Success in ICT standards setting. A closer look at some influencing factors. 8th
International Conference on Standardization and Innovation in Information Technology (SIIT), pp. 1-10.
✚✚ Jakobs, K. (06 2014). Managing corporate participation in international ICT standards setting. International
ICE Conference on Engineering, Technology and Innovation (ICE), pp. 1-9.
✚✚ Office Open XML. Wikipedia.
https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Office_Open_XML. Accessed May 2018.

189
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

7 A BUSINESS PERSPECTIVE: IPR AND STANDARDIZATION

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
This chapter provides readers with the required knowledge of the business perspective on standards,
in particular the relationship between Intellectual Property Rights (IPR) and standardization. As IPR can
play a crucial role in the context of standardization, readers should understand how standardization
and IPR interact.
IPR issues will be discussed in general (e.g. the disclosure of IPR) and with respect to standardization.
Different IPR instruments and mechanisms, such as secrecy, patents, standard-essential patents,
standard types, and mere publication of contents, will be discussed and linked to a company’s goals
and strategy. In addition, readers will get an overview of the different protective mechanisms and
instruments that are available in this context.
The chapter also compares the benefits and risks of standards and standardization to those of
patenting. For example, standards and standardization may help companies open up new markets
and achieve positive network effects and compatibility between products. There are also many risks
associated with standards and standardization, such as knowledge spillovers, free riding, and the
inability to fully control the outcome of a standardization process. Thus, readers will gain important
knowledge on when a company can benefit from a specific instrument and when it cannot.
In this regard, a decision tree can guide managers in selecting an adequate instrument. The tree
explains the main influencing factors that have an impact on decision making. The decision tree
enables readers to make informed decisions concerning existing options. After reading this chapter,
they will know when it is advantageous to go for standardization and when it makes more sense to
apply for a patent, or to keep knowledge secret.
To illustrate the decision-making process, different case studies from the ICT sector will be
presented. The case studies consist of general information such as a description of the company,
its technologies, etc. Readers can use the decision tree to go through the decision process. In this
way, they can experience the complexity of the decision process, while applying their knowledge to
real company situations and technologies.

190
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

7.1 INTRODUCTION
Decisions related to Intellectual Property Rights (IPR) have a significant impact on a company’s business
success. Given a new technology, companies can select from a menu of possible options: patenting,
standardization, mixed strategy, or keep their technology secret. When companies make the right decision,
they can achieve commercial success and be competitive in the marketplace.
Protecting intellectual property through patents is an often-used instrument among companies. But setting
standards through national and international standardization bodies is also a valuable option that can
enable companies to achieve technology diffusion, discover new market applications, and identify new
partners with whom they can cooperate. However, the benefits of standardization and patenting, or a
combination of both, come at a price. The processes of patenting and standardization require high up-
front costs that firms have to incur. In addition, defending against patent infringements, which leads to high
litigation costs, and the relatively long time required for the development of standards, are considerable
constraints that increase the cost level. To be successful in the market, companies have to make the right
decisions in order to capture the value of their innovations: to patent, to standardize, or to pursue a mixed
strategy?
This chapter tackles this issue. It is structured as follows. First, we present the basics of IPR, while dealing
with the main instruments in this regard: committee standards, patents, and secrecy. Then, a tool is
presented that helps companies make an informed decision when they have a new product or technology.
Finally, case studies from the ICT sector illustrate how this tool can be used in practical contexts.

7.2 IPR AND SDO-SUPPORTED STANDARDIZATION: TWO VALUABLE


INSTRUMENTS

7.2.1 BASICS OF IPR


Intellectual property (IP) refers to creations of the mind, such as inventions, literary and artistic works, designs
and symbols, and names and images used in commerce. IP is protected by law to safeguard the integrity
of intellectual objects. Intellectual property rights (IPR) are critical to fostering innovation, since without the
protection of ideas, businesses would not be able to reap the full benefits of their inventions and would focus
less on research and development (WIPO - World Intellectual Property Organization n.d.b).
As illustrated by Figure 7.1, there are five types of IPRs:
■■ Copyright: "The exclusive and assignable legal right, given to the originator for a fixed number of years,
to print, publish, perform, film, or record literary, artistic, or musical material" (e.g. software). (Oxford
Living Dictionaries n.d.a)
■■ Trademark: "A symbol, word, or words legally registered or established by use as representing a
company or product" (e.g. "Just do itTM" by Nike). (Oxford Living Dictionaries n.d.e)
■■ Industrial design: "The art or process of designing manufactured products" (e.g. car design). (Oxford
Living Dictionaries n.d.b)
■■ Patent: "A government authority or licence conferring a right or title for a set period, especially the
sole right to exclude others from making, using, or selling an invention" (e.g. Dropbox, GoPro). (Oxford
Living Dictionaries n.d.c)
■■ Trade secrets: "A secret device or technique used by a company in manufacturing its products" (e.g.
R&D information, software algorithms, inventions, formulas, ingredients—for instance the Coca-Cola
formula). (Oxford Living Dictionaries n.d.d)

191
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

Patents

Industrial Copyrights
designs

IPR

Trade Trademarks
secrets

Figure 7.1: Types of IPR

7.2.2 COMMITTEE STANDARDS


Companies can choose from different types of standardization. They can either establish a dominant
design, in other words a de facto standard in their industries, or choose to join an SDO to actively or
passively participate in committee standardization. In turn, there are two types of standardization: formal
standardization, facilitated by SDOs, and non-official standardization, such as standardization in consortia.

INTERNAL INFLUENCING FACTORS EXTERNAL INFLUENCING FACTORS

COMPANY CHARACTERISTICS COMPANY ENVIRONMENT

■■ Available resources ■■ Dynamics


■■ Short-term and middle-term goals ■■ Complexity
■■ Company size and growth ■■ Competition intensity
■■ Products/services and technology ■■ Specifics of the sector, such as regulations
■■ Marketing and impact

DECISION MAKER(S) STAKEHOLDERS

■■ Previous knowledge ■■ Standards Development Organizations (SDOs)


■■ Experience ■■ Customers
■■ Perception and acceptance of the instruments ■■ Competitors
■■ Other business partners

Table 7.1: Selected external and internal factors influencing decision making with respect to patenting
and standardization; based on Abdelkafi et al. (2016)

192
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

During the early stages of technology development, different solutions compete with one another until
one solution prevails. Frequently, technological superiority is not a necessary requirement, as the winning
technology may not be the best one. The battles that happen between companies are called standard
wars, because each company intends to push through its own technology.

EXAMPLE
In the home video market, there have been two well-known standard wars: the first, with video tape
cassettes, between VHS by JVC and Betamax by Sony, and the second, with laser disks for HD content,
between Blu-Ray by Sony and High Definition Digital Versatile Disk (HD DVD) by Toshiba.

A dominant design is a technology that achieves market dominance; it is then a de facto standard
(Narayanan and Chen 2012). Companies that succeed in establishing dominant designs in their market
have the power to make a profit out of their R&D investments and also have full control over the standard’s
contents. Dominant designs enable companies to appropriate value from technologies, as explained by
Teece (1986). In contrast to a dominant design, committee standardization can serve as a “low-cost” option
to conquer a market, but committee standardization is actually much more than that. Note, however, that
when it comes to consumer standards, there is a thin line (or none at all) between dominant designs and
committee standards.

EXAMPLE
One example is Firewire vs. USB2. Firewire is a formal standard: IEEE 1394. USB2 has de facto standards
behind it. Apple and Sony, for instance, were the big backers of Firewire. But apparently, they wanted too
much in royalty payments for the IPR behind Firewire (even if it was FRAND). So the PC and peripheral
industry ignored it and went with USB2, which was not quite as capable. Even Firewire 800, twice as fast
as Firewire and USB2, and years ahead of USB3, also failed, probably for the same reason.

As opposed to a dominant design, committee standards call for the cooperation of many market participants
to establish a standard based on consensus.

DEFINITION
A committee standard is “a document established by a consensus that provides, for common
and repeated use, rules, guidelines or characteristics for activities or their results, aimed at the
achievement of the optimum degree of order in a given context” (Egyedi and Blind 2008).

The standardization process is facilitated by the SDO that provides (more or less) “neutral grounds” for
the negotiation process. Note, however, that companies still benefit greatly from participating actively
or passively in a technical committee, in spite of the fact that they do not have full control over the
standardization outcome.

193
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

There are two types of committee standardization: formal and non-official standardization. Formal
standardization leads to the development of standards with wide consensus or specifications such as PAS
at the European level or DIN Specifications in Germany, which do not actually call for wide consensus, as
the number of involved participants is limited. Formal standardization is carried out by recognized SDOs.
The real distinction between formal and non-official standardization documents is the nature of recognition
of the SDO. CEN, CENELEC, ETSI, ISO, IEC, ITU, DIN, AFNOR, BSI and IEEE have formal recognition as an
SDO, at one level or another (national, European, international). W3C, IETF, Bluetooth SIG, etc. do not have
any formal recognition. The IETF and W3C are not even legal entities. In some areas, the establishment of
standards is more common (e.g. telecommunication), and in others, non-official standardization, especially
through consortia, is the norm (e.g. internet technologies).
High

Committee Standards
Open body of experts
DEGREE OF CONSENSUS

PAS, DIN Specification

Closed body of experts De-facto standards


Low

Innovation DEVELOPMENT TIME Market Readiness

Figure 7.2: Standard types; translated and adapted from Zeitz (2017)

194
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Figure 7.3: Standards connect market participants

The benefits of committee standardization are manifold. Companies that participate in the development of
standards gain a competitive advantage over those that do not. Technical committees provide companies
with a good opportunity to scan the environment, and thus to identify new market opportunities and
competitors. Companies can gain insider knowledge and early access to information, while having the
chance to increase the diffusion of (own) integrated technologies/knowledge and to influence future
technologies proactively. Furthermore, as seen in Chapter 5, participation in standardization committees
helps companies to develop new markets and increase their market shares for products, services and
technologies, as well as to strategically position themselves within those markets. On almost any given
day, a working group or technical committee is meeting and making decisions that could affect "our"
bottom line (Caldas 2017).
In general, the active participation of companies in committee standardization results in many benefits. It
fosters social networking, alliance building and the identification of new business partners, while supporting
personal trust and connections on a one-to-one-basis. According to Blind (2006), this can be seen as a
special form of R&D collaboration.

195
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

Active participation in committee standardization has a positive effect on customer confidence. The
endorsement of a technology by an SDO is perceived as a proof of quality, and association with the
standards committee can enhance a company’s reputation. In addition, committee standards are freely
available to other market participants. This can reduce the dependence on specific suppliers by avoiding
vendor lock-in, while enabling customers to make better comparisons between products.
Standards and standardization can support cost efficiency. As standardization reduces variety, it leads to
the achievement of economies of scale. Standards can also facilitate coordination among several economic
players, thus decreasing transaction costs. In particular, in the case of complex technologies, standards
can ensure compatibility and interoperability between technologies and complementary devices from
different producers. This can decrease bargaining costs, as standards can serve as a basis for contracts
between companies. Therefore, standards have the potential to provide legal security.
Nevertheless, committee standardization bears some risks for companies. Because of IP disclosure,
technologies and knowledge are integrated in the standard, leading companies to lose exclusive rights
of using their own IP. It is also possible for knowledge spillovers to happen unintentionally during the
standardization process. As seen in Chapter 5, companies cannot fully influence the standardization
process. Consequently, they must accept compromises. Furthermore, companies may back the wrong
horse, as there is no guarantee that a standard will be implemented and diffused successfully in a market
(e.g. Open Systems Interconnection [OSI] standard). Although participation in standardization processes is
recommended over not participating, companies that are not active in standardization can still benefit from
committee standards (free riding), while saving the costs of participation.

EXAMPLE
Intergraph is a company that originally focused on the American market. Intergraph had plans to expand
in Europe. Its headquarters in Europe are based in The Netherlands. Intergraph’s product family consists
of a wide range of software and hardware solutions, as well as computers for graphical applications.
Intergraph produced dedicated keyboards for graphical computers. These keyboards were equipped
with function keys that had a status indicator for which Light Emitting Diodes (LEDs) were used. In the
United States, the Underwriters Laboratories (UL) requirements applied, whereas in Europe the European
Committee for Electrotechnical Standardization (CENELEC) standards were relevant. To get informed
about the requirements in Europe, Intergraph Europe participated in the Dutch standardization committee.
Intergraph noticed, however, that the red colour used for the LEDs in the keyboards dedicated for the
American market did not meet the international standard IEC 60073 as well as its European equivalent
EN-IEC 60073. The main problem was that the colour red should be used exclusively to indicate danger.
To introduce the required changes, the total costs were estimated to be about €19,000. As a member
of the Dutch committee, Intergraph was informed that the IEC standard was going to be modified by
adding the text: "Where colours are used for functional controls or indicators, any colour, including red,
is permitted provided that it is clear that safety is not involved". Just by knowing that this statement
was going to be included in the standard, the company could recover the cost of its participation in the
standardization committee (de Vries 2006).

196
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

EXAMPLE
Another interesting example with respect to committee standardization is Tyco Electronics. Tyco
Electronics works in the field of electrical and electronic connectors. Tyco’s product family is
composed of fibre-optic products, switches, Integrated Circuit (IC) sockets, and application tooling.
Tyco Electronics could achieve an increased market share by participating in standardization.
Published in 1991, the ANSI/EIA/TIA 568 standard was at that time the dominant standard for
commercial building telecommunications wiring on the US market. In the same period, the
development of a similar standard in Europe by CENELEC and an international standard was
initiated. Tyco Electronics joined the standardization process and managed to get the new standards
to refer to its SC connector. However, this did not mean that the company had exclusive rights
to produce the technology, since the rules and regulations of CENELEC and the International
Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) forbid such exclusive rights, but the company could achieve a
competitive advantage and benefit in terms of knowledge, time to market, and economies of scale.
In the period between 1995 and 2004, the additional profits have been estimated to amount to
between US$50,000,000 and US$100,000,000, whereas costs of the company’s participation were
in the range of US$100,000 to US$200,000. Consequently, the attained cost-to-benefit ratio was
about 1:500. (de Vries 2006)

7.2.3 PATENTS
"Patents denote an exclusive right granted for an invention (product or process) that provides a new way
of doing something, or offers a new technical solution to a problem" (WIPO - World Intellectual Property
Organization n.d.a). The benefits and risks of patents are summarized in Table 7.2 below.

BENEFITS RISKS

++ Capitalizing IP through royalty fees -- Includes the disclosure of patent contents (even if the patent
++ Temporary monopoly/ exclusive rights (20 years) has not been granted yet)
++ Serves as a form of signalling for potential customers and -- In many cases, the imitation of patents can be hidden very
investors well and is hard to detect
++ Patenting protects -- The easier a patent can be bypassed, the more limited its
effectiveness
-- Often, companies—especially young companies and
SMEs—do not possess the resources to pursue patent
infringements
-- Duration of the process: 1.5–3 years, often more
(disadvantageous in markets with a high pace of

Table 7.2: Benefits and risks of patents

An important category of patent is the Standard-Essential Patent (SEPs). SEPs claim an invention that must
be applied by all companies in order to comply with a technical standard. Most of the formal SDOs only
allow the inclusion of patented technology in a standard if patent holders disclose the presence of patented
technology. In addition, patent holders have to license their relevant IPR to standard implementers on Fair,
Reasonable, and Non-Discriminatory (FRAND) terms. Fair is related to the licensing terms, which should
not be anti-competitive or against the law. Reasonable addresses the fees that the licensor would charge

197
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

the licensee, in order to use its SEP. Non-discriminatory means that all individual licensees are treated
in the same manner (Teece 2013). Note, however, that while some SDOs are satisfied with a FRAND
commitment, in other words that the SEP owner is willing to license his technology in return for a fee, other
SDOs seek royalty-free commitments (Bekkers 2017). FRAND does not necessarily mean that licensing
incomes will be lower, as standardization supports the diffusion and wide usage of the patent claims,
making a higher number of licensees more likely.

EXAMPLE
The MP3 example of the Fraunhofer Society shows that FRAND licences can be very lucrative. About
€100 million in royalty income has been generated for the Fraunhofer Society (Blind 2009). In the case of
Qualcomm, with UMTS / Long Term Evolution (LTE), in 2013 around 3% of a smartphone’s price went to
the company as licence fees (Forbes 2014).

Because of the immense power that patents can have when implemented in standards, SDOs and standard
implementers/developers fear monopoly and lock-in situations in the context of SEPs.

7.2.4 SECRECY
A trade secret denotes any type of confidential knowledge or business information that gives the owner of
a secret an opportunity to obtain an advantage over competitors who do not know or use the secret. Thus,
trade secrets protect information, knowledge and technologies that are critical to the firm. In particular,
technologies that can be easily imitated can benefit from secrecy. The unauthorized use of such information
by third parties is regarded as unfair practice and a violation of the trade secret. The protection of trade
secrets depends on the legal system. Either it forms part of the general concept of protection against unfair
competition, or it is based on specific provisions or case law.

7.2.5 THE INTERPLAY BETWEEN STANDARDIZATION AND IPR


Standards define the common characteristics and requirements of a technology. They open up new markets
for innovative products that comply with these requirements, whereas patents define unique inventions and
secure the exclusive rights of inventors, the protection of intellectual property, and competitive advantage.
Patents play a key role in standardization. Standardization encourages widespread take-up of inventions
codified by standards, and companies can incorporate patented inventions into standards (Standard-
Essential Patents) or use them in parallel.
IPR should be considered in the standardization work facilitated by SDOs. The integration of technology,
knowledge or other content in a standard often involves a company’s IPR. Therefore, SDOs have developed
policies and rules to deal with IPR issues during the standard-setting process. For instance, International
Telecommunication Union (ITU) has issued IPR guidelines concerning patents, software copyrights and
trademarks.

198
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Companies that participate in standard setting, at least in the formal organizations, are obliged to disclose
any existing patents that are essential to the standard. Patents should be licensed under FRAND (Fair,
Reasonable and Non-Discriminatory) conditions, as standards are a form of common property. This gives
a higher level of security to companies implementing the standard. FRAND should also function as an
incentive for companies, as they can retain their IPR.
When companies do not disclose relevant patents when they work on a standard, this is called "patent
holdup", which refers to the situation where the owner of a patent requires the payment of more than
"reasonable and non-discriminatory" royalties or other fees from implementers of a standard. When the
owner of the patent wants to maximize the yield, it will wait until the standard has already become widely
adopted, and therefore difficult or impossible to change (to render it non-infringing) without great expense,
before disclosing his patent. When this happens, this is referred to as a "submarine patent", because the
hostile party takes everyone by surprise when it suddenly emerges onto the scene (Updegrove 2011).

EXAMPLE
The example of Sun Microsystems (SUNM) with respect to Java is a case in point to illustrate the
interaction between intellectual property and standardization. SUNM recognized that rapid and significant
investments in new technology are accompanied by the industry’s desire to protect their investments.
For SUNM, the best way was to move Java into a stable, experienced, formal SDO that is recognized
worldwide by government, industry and other SDOs. SUNM chose to apply for a Publicly Available
Specification (PAS), which it submitted to ISO/IEC JTC 1 and was granted in 1999.

DEFINITION
Note, however, that a Publicly Available Specification is different to a standard. A PAS is
published in response to an urgent market need. The objective of a PAS is to speed up
standardization in areas of rapidly evolving technology. A simple majority of the participating
members of a Technical Committee or Subcommittee approves the document. PAS has a
maximum life of six years. If, during these six years, it is not transformed into an International
Standard, the PAS should be withdrawn (ISO/IEC n.d.).

SUNM wanted to retain its patents (although no fees are asked), its copyrights (joint copyright ownership
was suggested, no fees asked), and trademarks (e.g. control over compatibility logo). It also wanted to stay
in charge of the maintenance of the standard (Schoechle 2009). SUNM wanted to get the endorsement
of a standards organization, but it was not willing to give up control over the technology, especially over
the trademark and maintenance. SUNM’s model of competition strongly conflicted with the cooperative
standard-setting policy of ISO. As a result, SUNM declared its plans to have ISO adopt Java over and
turned to other SDOs.

199
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

7.3 A DECISION-MAKING TOOL: IPR VS. STANDARDIZATION

7.3.1 THE BASIC PROCESS


Blind (2013) proposes a procedure to help decide when to standardize and when to patent. Once research
findings have been made, the first question to be asked by managers or researchers is whether the
results are patentable or not. If they are, then the benefits of patenting should be compared to the costs
and fees incurred in filing a patent. If the benefits outweigh the costs, then patenting is an option, and
subsequently the company or research institution should go for patent registration and wait for the patent
to be granted. If it works, then the patent is granted to the inventors. Blind (2013) proposes that if, during
the patenting process, something does not function, standardization remains an interesting and serious
option. If the patent is granted, companies may still proceed with standardization by integrating their
patents into standards as an SEP.

Idea/research
findings

Patentable?

Yes No

Cost for patenting


process < benefit
No Standardization
of patent?

Yes

Patent No
registration?

Yes

Patent grant? No

Yes

Reference of essential
Patent
patents possible

Figure 7.4: Relationship between patenting and standardization decisions; translated from Blind (2013)

7.3.2 THE DECISION TREE: AN OVERVIEW


In the following section, we present a decision tree to help companies choose between standardization and
patenting. The decision-making process is highly complex, as it involves many variables and has to take
into account many factors. Companies actually have many options. They can choose between secrecy,
patenting, active participation in formal or non-official standardization, a combination of standardization
and patents, or SEPs. The decision tree can be used by entrepreneurs or technology managers in
companies; it provides them with a strategic decision-support tool to choose an adequate instrument,
given a technology they have developed.

200
Start

Is the technology No
Yes
patentable?

How important
Important Less Important Less
is the protection important important
of internal know how?

Figure 7.5: Decision tree (Abdelkafi et al. 2016)


How high is the need
for an additional network High Low High Low
of users, customers, etc.?

How high is the pace


of innovation High Low High Low High Low High Low
in the market?

Active
Active
Active Active participation in
participation in Active Active
participation in participation formal Active Active
Patent standardization participation in participation
standardization in formal standardization participation in participation
or (e.g.DIN-Specs), Secrecy standardization in formal
(e.g.DIN-Specs), standardization if standardization in formal
secrecy if advantageous (e.g.DIN-Specs), standardization,
and/or patents and/or patents advantageous (e.g.DIN-Specs) standardization
and/or patents if advantageous if advantageous
for signalling for signalling and/or patents
for signalling
for signalling

201
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

7.3.3 DECISION CRITERIA


The four levels of the decision tree refer to relevant questions that entrepreneurs have to answer in order to be
guided to the right instrument to be implemented. These questions are related to four aspects: patentability
of technologies, importance of protection of internal know-how, need for additional networks of users,
customers and other stakeholders, as well as the pace of innovation in the market.

THE PATENTABILITY OF TECHNOLOGIES


The first question that a company has to ask is, as mentioned in the framework by Blind (2013), whether
the technology is patentable or not? This is actually not an easy question. In the ICT sector, patenting
concerns hardware and computer-implemented inventions, and the patent office is capable of assessing the
patentability of an invention based on three necessary requirements:
■■ First, the invention has to be a novelty, in other words no prior use of anything similar in the market.
■■ Second, it should also involve an inventive step that is not readily discovered.
■■ Third, the invention should be suitable for industrial application.
Answering the question of patentability is not a straightforward process. It calls for extensive research and
often needs the support of a professional patent attorney. Note, however, that even if patenting is possible, it
is not necessarily the best option (EPO 2013).

THE IMPORTANCE OF THE PROTECTION OF INTERNAL KNOW-HOW


The level of importance of protection of internal know-how depends on the specific goals of a company, in
particular its business model. A company that is not planning to implement its technology itself, but to sell
it or license it for a fee, evaluates the relevance of internal know-how differently to a company that aims to
implement its technology.
The effectiveness of a specific instrument (secrecy, patenting or standardization) also depends on the
(geographical) context. The appropriability regime (Teece 1986), in other words the ability of a company to
capture value from its innovation, depends on the region. For instance, IPR enforcement in China is weak,
compared to western countries such as Germany. A company may decide to keep its technology secret in
a region where the appropriability regime is weak instead of filing a patent. The competitive environment also
plays an important role. For example, knowledge protection is very important if there are many competitors
in the market with the ability to imitate the technology.
Further aspects, such as the type and characteristics of a technology, determine the importance of knowledge
protection. For instance, a company producing measurement instruments can standardize the procedure
according to which measurements take place, whereas it may patent the core technology of the device that
takes the measurement. This actually requires the technology to be divided into different parts, of which
some are suitable for patenting and some for standardization. In addition, when the technology in question
cannot be seen by competitors, for example a new internal manufacturing process, the importance of internal
protection can be evaluated as high. Patents may not help in this case, as patents are published, thus
providing competitors with the required knowledge to imitate the process. Also, it would not be easy to detect
patent infringement, with it being an internal process.

THE NEED FOR ADDITIONAL NETWORKS OF USERS, CUSTOMERS AND OTHER STAKEHOLDERS
To decide whether to standardize or to patent, a company should also ask to what extent it is required to
integrate additional networks of relevant stakeholders. ICT technologies and systems are often too complex
to develop in isolation, and therefore cooperation is required. For young, small and medium enterprises,
however, the development of a business network may turn out to be challenging, and the standardization
process can be especially helpful for them.

202
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Standardization supports networking. In technical committees, competitors, suppliers, users, and other
important stakeholders work together to develop standards. The participants gain insight and knowledge
related to the standard during its development. In addition, the standardization process facilitates knowledge
exchange among all participants, thus fostering R&D through target-oriented development of technologies, for
instance by getting feedback from other stakeholders. According to Blind (2006), because standards support
compatibility and the diffusion of a technology, they can be seen as a special form of R&D collaboration.
Furthermore, the endorsement of a technology by an SDO is perceived as proof of quality, thus enhancing
the reputation of a company associated with building the standard, and making others more willing to interact
and cooperate with the company.
Thus, standardization clearly supports companies in extending their networks. Compared to standardization,
the advantage of patents in this regard is rather low. Patenting is a way of signalling to the outside that the
company is innovative. Investors especially see patents as an important indicator of how well a company can
capture value from its innovation. Patents often play a key role in helping companies gain access to investor
networks.
The following questions can help companies assess whether their need for additional networks is high or low:
■■ Is signalling important for the company (in the sense of reputation and visibility)?
■■ Is it difficult to make contact with "big players" in a given technology area?
■■ Is compatibility with other systems or technologies important?
■■ Does the technology benefit highly from positive network effects?
■■ Is additional knowledge needed?
■■ Are there SDOs active in the area of the company’s technology?
■■ How likely is it that potential business partners and/or competitors will participate in a specific SDO?

THE PACE OF INNOVATION IN THE MARKET


The pace of innovation of a technology can influence the decision to patent or to standardize. The development
of patents as well as formal standards is tedious, time consuming and can take many years. Consequently,
the technology life cycle is an important factor in the decision process.
Formal standardization is not suitable if the technology changes—perhaps many times—before the standard
is released. In a fast-changing innovation environment, standardization could prove inefficient, as the standard
would already be out of date when it is published. The same also applies for patenting. Patenting is also not
only a time-consuming, but also a costly process, especially if the patent is filed in many regions worldwide.
If the technology life cycle is short, market uncertainties are high, and therefore the development of publicly
available specifications (PAS), or consortium standards are more favourable, as these standards can be
generated much faster (in approximately six months). A wide consensus is not required. In general, short
product life cycles and a high number of competitors indicate a high pace of innovation in the market.
Companies may use the following questions to evaluate the pace of innovation in their industries:
■■ How high is the market uncertainty concerning future developments?
■■ How long is the life cycle of own products or products in the market?
■■ How many competitors exist in the market?

7.3.4 USING THE TREE FOR DECISION MAKING


Depending on the path that decision makers take through the decision tree, they can choose from different
instruments. In Figure 7.6, the left part (L) describes solutions where patenting is possible, whereas the right
part (R) focuses only on standardization.

203
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

On the left side of the tree, the technology is patentable. The company still has plenty of instruments that it
can use. The company may deliberately decide upon secrecy, especially if it turns out that it cannot prove
patent infringement in the event that a competitor illegally uses its technology.
If the protection of internal know-how is less important for the company, patenting and secrecy are no longer
the first choices. Instead, standardization is a much better instrument, since the company can additionally
benefit from the networking advantage that results from the standardization process. When the pace of
innovation as well as the resulting market uncertainties are high, it is advisable to go for the drafting of
specifications, because the process is relatively fast to complete, whereas when the pace of innovation is
slow, formal standards based on a larger level of consensus turns out to be the most adequate instrument.
Note, however, that since the technology is patentable, companies may still supplement their standardization
endeavours through patenting. In this way, they use a combined strategy. This can make sense in situations
where the company wants to signal innovative capabilities to the outside, for example when looking for
external investment money.
As discussed previously, there are many possible combinations of standardization and patenting:
■■ Technologies could be integrated into standards in form of SEPs, while charging licensing fees.
■■ Including patents in the standard without charging licensing fees. In this way, companies put their IP in
the public domain to achieve a wide level of diffusion.
■■ Companies could patent their technologies and participate independently in standardization (patents
based around a standard are more likely to generate increased licensing income).
■■ If a company cannot fight patent infringements, it may be advisable (if the IPR rules of an SDO allow
so) to not disclose relevant IPR
The difference between the left and right sides of the decision tree is that on the right side the technology is
not patentable, and therefore patenting is no longer an option for the company. The decision tree shows that
standardization is an important instrument that is actually as valuable as patenting and, if well used, can help
companies achieve many advantages.
Finally, it is worth noting that the term "if advantageous" is found on both sides of the decision tree when
the need for additional networks is evaluated as low. It indicates that active participation in standardization
should be carefully evaluated, because its positive effect is actually lower than in other end nodes of the
tree. In effect, when the need of an additional network is low, a company must have other good reasons to
participate. This could be the case if a company intends to integrate a technology in a standard to support
its diffusion.

Start

Is the technology patentable? Yes No


L R
How important is the protection Important Lesss Important Lesss
of internal know how? important important

How high is the need for an additional


onal High Low High Low
network of users, customers, etc.?

How high is the pace of innovation


n High High High High
in the market? Low Low Low Low

Active Active Active


Active
participation in participation in participation in Active Active
participation in Active Active
Patent standardization standardization formal participation in participation in
formal participation in participation in
Instruments or (e.g.DIN-Specs), (e.g.DIN-Specs), standardization Secrecy standardization formal
standardization standardization formal
secrecy and/or patents if advantageous if advantageous (e.g.DIN-Specs), standardization, if
and/or patents for (e.g.DIN-Specs) standardization
for signalling and/or patents and/or patents if advantageous advantageous
signalling
for signalling for signalling

Figure 7.6: Decision tree (Abdelkafi et al. 2016)

204
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

7.4 CASE STUDIES: TO STANDARDIZE OR TO PATENT?

7.4.1 CASE STUDY: SECURE DATA GMBH - IT SECURITY SOFTWARE,


INFRASTRUCTURE AND CONSULTING

Secure Data is a company founded in 2008 that offers IT security software, infrastructure and
consulting services to support its customers in achieving secure communication. The company
currently has 25 employees and serves the German market, which is very dynamic and characterized
by a high innovation potential. Secure Data drew up a DIN SPEC for a technology it developed in the
area of IT network security.

DEFINITION
A DIN Specification, or DIN SPEC, is a document that specifies requirements for products,
services and/or processes. However, in contrast to standards, DIN SPECs do not require
full consensus and the involvement of all stakeholders. They are drawn up in temporary
bodies called workshops. DIN SPECs are a trusted strategic instrument for quickly and
easily establishing and disseminating innovative solutions on the market. (DIN Deutsches
Institut für Normung e. V n.d.)

Why this choice? The company’s reasoning was as follows: the technology is patentable and superior
to available solutions. The company mentioned in this regard, "There is nothing comparable [to our
product]. This had been checked extensively." Nevertheless, a patent does not make sense. Firstly,
patenting is expensive (> €150,000 estimated costs) for the company, and defence against patent
infringements would be costly. As a small company, it does not have the resources to deal with
the cost of patenting. Secondly, the company would not be able to discover patent infringements.
The newly invented process technology works in the background, so there is no way to prove that
a competitor is using it. In the words of the company’s owner: "Patents have as much value as you
can enforce by law".
Because of this, secrecy and standardization appear to be more promising. Firstly, the company does
not believe in keeping the technology secret, particularly because of the owner’s personal conviction
that it would not be fair to hide a technology from parties that may benefit from it. Secondly, DIN, as
an SDO, was very interested in the technology. Thirdly, the company aims to offer and promote new
services such as consultancy and certification around their technology in the future, as explained by
the owner: "The advantage of the standard is that others might want to get certified and we can earn
money from that. With the patent, we most probably would not have a chance to do so, because
people would simply use it without us ever noticing it". Fourthly, standardization leads to a stronger
reputation and better diffusion, as the DIN SPEC is sent to a large number of SDO partners. The
owner says in this regard, "Thanks to DIN, the solution becomes more popular. […] It used to be a
niche product. But because of the publication process we got some extra requests for it."

205
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

Start

Is the technology patentable? Yes No

How important is the protection Important Less Important Less


of internal know how? important important

How high is the need for an additional High Low High Low
network of users, customers, etc.?

How high is the pace of innovation High High High High


in the market? Low Low Low Low

Active Active Active


Active
participation in participation in participation in Active Active
participation in Active Active
Patent standardization standardization formal participation in participation in
formal participation in participation in
or (e.g.DIN-Specs), (e.g.DIN-Specs), standardization Secrecy standardization formal
standardization standardization formal
secrecy and/or patents if advantageous if advantageous (e.g.DIN-Specs), standardization, if
and/or patents for (e.g.DIN-Specs) standardization
for signalling and/or patents and/or patents if advantageous advantageous
signalling
for signalling for signalling

Figure 7.7: Decisions of Secure Data GmbH (Abdelkafi et al. 2016)

7.4.2 CASE STUDY: LOCATOR GMBH - EMBEDDED LOCATION PLATFORM


SERVICES AND DEVICES

Locator GmbH offers an embedded location platform (hardware and software), which enables a
robust, energy-efficient location service. The company has been operating in the ICT sector for
about 25 years. Locator has about 25 employees, and the product portfolio is composed of IC
wireless modules, tags, anchors, and location engine software. The market situation of the company
is very dynamic and exhibits a high innovation potential. Furthermore, formal and non-official
standardization documents and standards are of high importance in the industry. The company
patented its embedded location platform, which is also standardized in IEC/ISO 24730-5: Real-Time
Locating System (RTLS) air interface (global tracking).
The company opted for a mixed approach that combines formal standardization and patenting. Why
this choice? The company made such a choice for two reasons: firstly to ensure exclusive rights,
while generating licence revenues, especially from standardization activities (SEPs), and secondly to
achieve wide dissemination of the company’s patented technology and to conquer new markets.
The CEO of the company said in this regard, "We developed intellectual property, and we wanted
to make it the standard". In addition, the objective of the company is "to not just write the patent,
but also to develop the strategy around it. I ask myself, what is the overall strategy for innovation? It
consists of both patents and standards".

206
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

In this case, the technology is patentable. The patent portfolio covers the inventions and constitutes
an important asset of the company in order to attract investors. Because of its size, the company’s
resources are limited, and there is a need for external investment money. Investors needed to be
convinced about the standardization activities. In the CEO’s words, "Patents are generally needed
when I search for investors. Until now I could not manage to make investors enthusiastic about my
company, by pushing standardization."

All in all, IP protection was essential for Locator GmbH, although the company would not be able
to fight against patent infringements. Standardization was used as a tool to distribute the patented
technology at an international level (SEP). The essential patent was licensed under fair, reasonable,
and non-discriminatory terms (FRAND). The importance of standardization in achieving international
take-up of the technology is summarized by the following statement from the CEO: "I do not choose
the countries because of the standardization activities, but I take standardization to approach the
countries."

Start
Yes

Is the technology patentable? Yes No


Yes

How important is the protection Important


Important Less Important
Important Less
of internal know how? important
important important
important

How high is the need for an additional High


Hight Low High
Hight Low
network of users, customers, etc.?

How high is the pace of innovation High High High High


in the market?
Hight Low Hight Low Hight Low Hight Low

Active
Active Active
Active Active
Active
Active Active
participation
participation inin participation
participation inin participation in Active
Active Active
Active
participation
participation inin participation in Active
Active Active
Active
Patent
Patent standardization
standardization standardization
standardization formal Patent participation in
participation in participation in
participation in
formal
formal formal participation in
participation in participation in
participation in
or
or (e.g.DIN-Specs),
(e.g.DIN-Specs), if (e.g.DIN-Specs),if
(e.g.DIN-Specs), standardization or
Secrecy standardization
standardization formal
formal
standardization
standardization standardization standardization
standardization formal
formal
secrecy
secrecy advantageous
and/or patents and/or patentsfor if advantageous
advantageous ifand/or
advantageous
patents
secrecy
(e.g.DIN-Specs) standardization
(e.g.DIN-Specs),
(e.g.DIN-Specs),if standardization, if
standardization,
and/or patents and/or patents and/or patents
patents (e.g.DIN-Specs) standardization ifadvantageous
advantageous
for signalling for signalling
signalling
and/or and/or patents
for signalling if advantageous
advantageous
for signalling for signalling
for signalling
for signalling

Figure 7.8: Decision tree branch for Locator GmbH (Abdelkafi et al. 2016)

207
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

7.5 SUMMARY
Intellectual property (IP) refers to creations of the mind such as inventions, literary and artistic works,
designs and symbols, and names and images used in commerce. In this chapter, we dealt with three
main instruments by which companies can deal with their IP: committee standards, patents and secrecy.
Companies can choose to join an SDO to actively or passively participate in committee standardization.
There are two types of committee standardization: formal standardization, which is facilitated by recognized
SDOs such as ISO or ETSI, formal standards or specifications according to the PAS process; and non-
official standardization, such as standardization in consortia.
Patents grant an exclusive right for an invention (product or process) that provides a new way of doing
something or offers a new technical solution to a problem. IPR should be taken into consideration in
standardization. Companies participating in standard setting, at least in the formal organizations, are obliged
to disclose any existing patents that are related to the standard. Patents should be licensed under FRAND
(Fair, Reasonable and Non-Discriminatory) conditions, as standards are a form of common property.
A trade secret denotes any type of confidential knowledge or business information that gives the owner
of a secret an opportunity to obtain an advantage over competitors that do not know or use the secret. In
particular, technologies that can be easily imitated can benefit from secrecy.
Committee standards, patents and trade secrets have benefits and risks. For instance, committee
standards enable companies to gain insider knowledge and early access to information, while increasing the
distribution of their technologies and proactively influencing future technologies. Furthermore, participation
in standardization committees helps companies to develop new markets. But committee standards can
take a long time to complete. Patents are also advantageous for companies, as they generate licensing
fees, allocate temporary monopoly/exclusive rights for a specific period of time and serve as a way of
signalling innovation to potential customers and investors. There are some inherent risks in patenting for
the company, as the patent contents need to be disclosed, even if the patent has not been granted yet. In
many cases, imitation of patents can be very well hidden and is hard to detect. Furthermore, the process
to register a patent can be long and costly. The process of defending against patent infringement can also
cost the company a lot of time and money. A trade secret is beneficial when the IP in question is related to
an internal process that is not visible from the outside. However, secrecy in itself cannot grant any rights to
the company if a technology is imitated.
A decision tree was introduced that helps companies make an informed and systematic decision whether
to patent, to standardize, to combine both, or to keep a technology secret. The decision tree consists of
four levels. At the first level, companies have to ask whether the technology is patentable. Subsequently,
the company should consider how important the protection of internal know-how is. The third level is about
how high the need is for additional networks of users, customers, etc. The final question is about the pace
of innovation in the market. When these questions are answered, the decision tree gives recommendations
on which instrument to implement. Two case studies from the ICT sector have explained in detail how to
use the decision tree to support decision making.

208
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

7.6 QUIZ

1 - WHICH ONE OF THE FOLLOWING INSTRUMENTS IS NOT CONSIDERED A TYPE OF IPR?


(See Section 7.2.1 for hints)
a) Patents
b) Trademarks
c) Standards
d) Copyright

2 - STANDARD ESSENTIAL PATENTS ARE…


(See Section 7.2.3 for hints)
a) Patents that are standardized.
b) Patented standards.
c) Patents that compete with standards.
d) Patents that are required for the implementation of the standards.

3 - PATENTS SHOULD BE LICENSED UNDER FRAND CONDITIONS. WHAT DOES THE


ABBREVIATION FRAND STAND FOR?
(See Section 7.2.1 for hints)
a) Free, Rational and Non-Discriminatory
b) Fair, Rational and Non-Discriminatory
c) Free, Reasonable and Non-Discriminatory
d) Fair, Reasonable and Non-Discriminatory

4 - PARTICIPATION IN COMMITTEE STANDARDS…


(See Section 7.2.2 for hints)
a) is only active.
b) can be active or passive.
c) is only passive.
d) is neither active nor passive.

5 - THE STANDARD WAR BETWEEN VHS AND BETAMAX RESULTED IN…


(See Section 7.2.2 for hints)
a) Betamax winning the battle because it had better performance.
b) VHS winning the battle because it was supported by an SDO.
c) Betamax losing the battle because VHS had the technological superiority.
d) VHS becoming a de facto standard.

209
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

6 - A PUBLICLY AVAILABLE SPECIFICATION (PAS)…


(See Section 7.2.1 for hints)
a) is a de facto standard.
b) is a committee standard.
c) has a maximum life of 10 years.
d) is not relevant for companies operating in areas of rapidly evolving technologies.

7 - WHICH OF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS DENOTES A PATENT RISK?


(See Section 7.2.3 for hints)
a) Patents grant their owner a temporary monopoly/exclusive rights for about 20 years.
b) The easier a patent can be bypassed, the more limited is its efficiency.
c) A patent serves as a form of signalling for potential customers and investors.
d) Patenting protects IP in the standardization process.

8 - SECRECY IS A FORM OF IP PROTECTION THAT IS SUITABLE FOR…


(See Section 7.2.4 for hints)
a) Products that can be easily imitated.
b) Process technologies that are not visible to competitors.
c) Technologies that are visible to competitors.
d) Most high-tech products.

9 - THE FOLLOWING CRITERIA ARE IMPORTANT IN ORDER FOR A COMPANY TO CHOOSE


WHETHER TO STANDARDIZE, PATENT, OR FOLLOW A MIXED STRATEGY.
(See Section 7.3.2 for hints)
a) Patentability, importance of protection of internal know-how, need for an additional network of
partners, and the pace of innovation
b) Patentability, the ownership of standards essential patents, need for an additional network of
partners, and the pace of innovation
c) Patentability, importance of protection of internal know-how, need for additional investments, and
the pace of innovation
d) Importance of protection of internal know-how, need for an additional network of partners, and
the pace of innovation in a given industry

10 - THE APPROPRIABILITY REGIME DENOTES…


(See Section 7.3.2 for hints)
a) The ability of a company to acquire resources
b) The ability of a company to accommodate innovations from the outside and integrate new
technologies
c) The ability of a company to capture value from its innovation
d) The ability of company to patent its technologies

➜ SOLUTIONS PAGE 257

210
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

7.7 GLOSSARY
■■ Intellectual Property Rights: "Intellectual property rights refers to the general term for the assignment
of property rights through patents, copyrights and trademarks. These property rights allow the holder
to exercise a monopoly on the use of the item for a specified period." (OECD 2005)
■■ Patent: "A government authority or licence conferring a right or title for a set period, especially the
sole right to exclude others from making, using, or selling an invention" (e.g. Dropbox, GoPro).
(Oxford Living Dictionaries n.d.c)
■■ Standard-Essential Patents (SEPs): Claim an invention that must be applied by all companies in
order to comply with a technical standard (Aldrich and Auster 1986).
■■ Network effect (or network externality): Can be direct or indirect. A direct network effect is when
the value of a given product, software or technology increases with the number of people and
organizations using it. Examples are the telephone, fax, Facebook and Twitter. For instance, the value
of the telephone depends of the size of the network of people that can be reached via telephone.
Indirect network effects arise when the value of a good/service does not depend directly on the
number of users, but rather on the availability of complementary and compatible components. For
instance, the value of video game consoles depends on the availability of video games. The more
games, the greater the choice, and the better for the consumer.
■■ Copyright: "The exclusive and assignable legal right, given to the originator for a fixed number of
years, to print, publish, perform, film, or record literary, artistic, or musical material" (e.g. software).
(Oxford Living Dictionaries n.d.a)
■■ Trademark: "A symbol, word, or words legally registered or established by use as representing a
company or product" (e.g. "just do it" by Nike). (Oxford Living Dictionaries n.d.d)
■■ Trade secrets: A secret device or technique used by a company in manufacturing its products" (e.g.
R&D information, software algorithms, inventions, formulas, ingredients). (Oxford Living Dictionaries
n.d.c)
■■ Publicly Available Specification (PAS): Different from a standard. A PAS is published to respond to
an urgent market need. The objective of a PAS is to speed up standardization in areas of rapidly
evolving technology. A simple majority of the participating members of a Technical Committee or
Subcommittee approves the document. PAS has a maximum life of six years. If, during these six
years, it is not transformed into an International Standard, the PAS should be withdrawn. (ISO/IEC
n.d.)
■■ Dominant design: A dominant design is a technology that achieves market dominance.
■■ De facto standard: When a technology achieves market dominance, it is then a de facto standard
(Narayanan and Chen 2012).
■■ Committee standard: "A document established by a consensus that provides, for common and
repeated use, rules, guidelines or characteristics for activities or their results, aimed at the achievement
of the optimum degree of order in a given context" (Egyedi and Blind 2008).
■■ DIN SPEC (DIN Specification): A document that specifies requirements for products, services and/
or processes. However, in contrast to standards, DIN SPECs do not require full consensus and
the involvement of all stakeholders. They are drawn up in temporary bodies called workshops.
DIN SPECs are a trusted strategic instrument for quickly and easily establishing and disseminating
innovative solutions on the market. (DIN Deutsches Institut für Normung e. V n.d.)

211
CHAPTER 7 - A business perspective: IPR and standardization

7.8 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS


■■ IPR: Intellectual Property Rights ■■ HD DVD: High Definition Digital Versatile
■■ IP: Intellectual Property Disk
■■ SDO: Standards Development ■■ LED: Light Emitting Diode
Organizations ■■ UL: Underwriters Laboratories
■■ ITU: International Telecommunication Union ■■ CENELEC: European Committee for
■■ FRAND: Fair, Reasonable and Non- Electrotechnical Standardization
Discriminatory ■■ AMP: Accelerated Mobile Pages
■■ SUNM: Sun Microsystems ■■ IC: Integrated Circuit
■■ PAS: Publicly Available Specification ■■ IEC: International Electrotechnical
■■ SEP: Standard-Essential Patent Commission
■■ VHS: Video Home System ■■ LTE: Long Term Evolution
■■ RTLS: Real-Time Locating System

7.9 REFERENCES
✚✚ Abdelkafi, N., Makhotin, S., Thuns, M., Pohle, A., & Blind, K. (2016). To Standardize or to Patent?:
Development of a Decision Making Tool and Recommendations for Young Companies. International Journal
of Innovation Management, 20, 1640020 (2016). doi:10.1142/S136391961640020X
✚✚ Aldrich, H. E., & Auster, E. (1986). Even Dwarfs Started Small: Liabilities of Age and Size and Their Strategic
Implications. SSRN Scholarly Paper. Rochester, NY.
✚✚ Bekkers, R. (2017). Where Patents and Standards Come Together, in: R. Hawkins, K. Blind, R. Page (Eds.):
Handbook of Innovation and Standards, Cheltenham & Northampton: Edward Elgar, pp. 227-251.
✚✚ Blind, K. (2006). Explanatory factors for participation in formal standardisation processes: Empirical
evidence at firm level. Economics of Innovation and New Technology, 15, 157–170 (2006).
doi:10.1080/10438590500143970
✚✚ Blind, K. (2009). Standardisation: A catalyst for innovation (Inaugural addresses research in management
series, EIA-2009-039-LIS). Rotterdam: Rotterdam School of Management, Erasmus University Rotterdam.
✚✚ Blind, K. (2013). Rolle von Normen und Patenten – Chancen der Standardisierung für junge Unternehmen,
Berlin, January, 22.
✚✚ Caldas, A. (2017). What is an American National Standard (ANS) anyway, 19 June 2017.
https://asb.aafs.org/wp-content/uploads/2017/08/What-is-an-ANS_July-2017_072417.pdf. Accessed 17
September 2018.
✚✚ de Vries, H. (2006). International standardization as a strategic tool: Standards for business - How
companies benefit from participation in international standards setting. International Standardization as a
Strategic Tool–Commended Papers from the IEC Centenary Challenge 2006, 131–137.
✚✚ DIN Deutsches Institut für Normung e. V. (n.d.). Der Sprung in den Markt: Briefing für START-UPS.
http://www.din.de/blob/63576/d519c2c3ad6d102be5d37ffa5386fe09/startup-flyer-data.pdf. Accessed 13
June 2017.
✚✚ Egyedi, T. M., & Blind, K. (Eds.). (2008). The dynamics of standards. Cheltenham: Edward Elgar.
✚✚ EPO. (2013). Patents for software?: European law and practice.
https://www.epo.org/news-issues/issues/software.html. Accessed 13 June 2017.

212
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

✚✚ Forbes. (2014). Why Qualcomm’s Royalty Rate Will Continue To Decline.


https://www.forbes.com/sites/greatspeculations/2014/06/10/why-qualcomms-royalty-revenue-will-
continue-to-decline/#54a7bf913beb. Accessed 15 March 2018.
✚✚ ISO/IEC. (n.d.). ISO deliverables: The different types of ISO publications.
https://www.iso.org/deliverables-all.html. Accessed 4 October 2017.
✚✚ Narayanan, V. K., & Chen, T. (2012). Research on technology standards: Accomplishment and challenges.
Research Policy, 41, 1375–1406 (2012). doi:10.1016/j.respol.2012.02.006
✚✚ OECD. (2005). Intellectual Property Rights (IPR).
https://stats.oecd.org/glossary/detail.asp?ID=3236. Accessed 14 February 2018.
✚✚ Oxford Living Dictionaries. (n.d.a). Copyright.
https://en.oxforddictionaries.com/definition/copyright. Accessed 13 June 2017.
✚✚ Oxford Living Dictionaries. (n.d.b). Industrial design.
https://en.oxforddictionaries.com/definition/industrial_design. Accessed 13 June 2017.
✚✚ Oxford Living Dictionaries. (n.d.c). Patent.
https://en.oxforddictionaries.com/definition/patent. Accessed 13 June 2017.
✚✚ Oxford Living Dictionaries. (n.d.d). Trade secrets.
https://en.oxforddictionaries.com/definition/trade_secret. Accessed 13 June 2017.
✚✚ Oxford Living Dictionaries. (n.d.e). Trademark. Source:
https://en.oxforddictionaries.com/definition/trademark. Accessed 13 June 2017.
✚✚ Schoechle, T. D. (2009). Standardization and digital enclosure: The privatization of standards, knowledge,
and policy in the age of global information technology (Advances in IT standards and standardization
research (AISSR) series). Hershey, Pa: IGI Global (701 E. Chocolate Avenue Hershey Pennsylvania 17033
USA).
✚✚ Teece, D. J. (1986). Profiting from technological innovation: Implications for integration, collaboration,
licensing and public policy. Research Policy, 15, 285–305.
✚✚ Teece, D. J. (2013). Standards Essential Patent Disputes and Antitrust Law: Evaluating Patent Hold-up (and
Hold-out) Theories.
https://www.judiciary.senate.gov/imo/media/doc/073013RecordSub-Klobuchar.pdf. Accessed 10 July
2018.
✚✚ Updegrove, A. (2011). FTC Seeks Input on Patent Holdup in Standards Development.
http://www.consortiuminfo.org/standardsblog/articles/ftc-seeks-input-patent-holdup-standards-
development. Accessed 9 January 2018.
✚✚ WIPO - World Intellectual Property Organization. (n.d.a). Patents: What is a patent?
http://www.wipo.int/patents/en/. Accessed 11 September 2017.
✚✚ WIPO - World Intellectual Property Organization. (n.d.b). What is Intellectual Property?
http://www.wipo.int/about-ip/en/. Accessed 16 January 2018.
✚✚ Zeitz, E. (2017). Der Normungsprozess und die Möglichkeiten zur Mitwirkung, Strategische Normung, Berlin,
April, 27.

213
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

8 AN ECONOMIC PERSPECTIVE ON STANDARDIZATION

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
This chapter shows the relevance of standards and standardization from a macroeconomic perspective,
in particular the contribution of standards to the Gross Domestic Product (GDP). Students should
understand that standards and standardization are an important basis for a functioning economic
system.
This chapter also gives an answer to the question of how standards can be beneficial to the overall
economy. In particular, it discusses the relationships among standardization and costs, productivity,
market entry, competition, innovation, trade, outsourcing, market failure and related effects (e.g.,
network effects, switching costs) that are typical for IT. Some examples of successful IT standards are
provided. In this way, readers can get valuable insights into the far-reaching impacts of standardization
on our economy, and how different stakeholders benefit from them.
Standardization can also be an important tool for governments, for instance to achieve quality or
cost objectives. Therefore, this chapter covers the governmental perspective of ICT standardization
by focusing on public procurement in particular. We introduce public procurement, while providing a
real example. In addition, we identify and describe key legal frameworks and policies. Subsequently,
we deal with the contribution of standardization to public procurement, as an enabler of innovation
and interoperability, as well as the benefits of standardization for governments and stakeholders
such as citizens and companies. After reading the dedicated section, students should be able to
explain the impact of standardization on public procurement. They should also be able to recall the
most important policy and legal frameworks in this area and link the benefits of standardization to
different stakeholders such as citizens and businesses.

214
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

8.1 INTRODUCTION
Standards are an important instrument in the diffusion of new technologies and technological know-
how. Their resulting contribution to economic growth is well documented in various empirical studies.
For instance, in the period between 2002 and 2006, standards and technical rules were responsible for
the generation of 0.7 to 0.8% of Germany’s Gross Domestic Product (GDP). In addition, the impact of
standards has been studied in the context of trade. Swann (2010a, p. 2) reviewed many empirical studies
in this regard and found "that there is often, but not always, a positive relationship between international
standards and exports or imports". In an empirical analysis by Blind et al. (2018), the authors found that
ISO 9000 certification intensity in the exporting country signals a certain quality performance to potential
buyers. As such, ISO 9000 can lower information asymmetries between sellers and buyers, decrease
transaction costs, and increase trade among countries.
Although our world is heavily reliant on standards, their actual effects on the economy are less obvious.
Similar to patents, standards are carriers of codified knowledge and can provide companies with state-of-
the-art knowledge. Especially when standards are open and not controlled by a single company, all market
players can benefit from and trust the same knowledge. Thus, standards foster competition and prevent
the occurrence of lock-in effects or high switching costs.
Standards also support the compatibility between different technical platforms and systems. Without
interface standards, the flourishing industries based on complementary products, such as the various apps
we can find in app stores or the wide range of video games for our game consoles, would not be possible.
Moreover, standards help us to assess the quality of products and services that we can buy and prevent
an unmanageable number of different product variants. They support companies in achieving focus in
markets and building up critical mass.
Governments use standards in the context of public procurement to guarantee a high quality of public
services. Companies that are willing to apply for public tenders need to comply with the indicated standards.
Thus, the government can indirectly encourage the adoption of standards by companies and therefore
support the innovative strength and technological progress of a nation.
This chapter provides an in-depth analysis of the economic contribution of standards and their role in
public procurement. Whereas Section 8.2 focuses on the economic contribution of standards to the GDP,
Section 8.3 highlights the real economic effects of standards. Subsequently, Section 8.4 addresses the
topic of public procurement and explains how governments can benefit from standardization. Finally,
Section 8.5 summarizes the contents of the chapter.

215
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

8.2 THE ECONOMIC CONTRIBUTION OF STANDARDS


Several studies have dealt with the contribution of standards to economic growth in different countries
such as the United Kingdom (DTI 2005), Germany (Blind et al. 2011), France (Miotti 2009) and Canada
(Haimowitz and Warren 2007). The effects of standards on economic growth have been calculated using
regression analysis (a statistical process for estimating relationships among variables).

8.2.1 CONTRIBUTION OF STANDARDS TO THE GDP


In Germany, Blind et al. (2011) estimated the contribution of standards to GDP. They used the Cobb-
Douglas production function to represent the relationship between economic input (e.g. capital and labour)
and output (e.g. products and services).
Total Factor Productivity (TFP) is an essential parameter that determines the quantity of output produced
in a country. TFP is a function of technical progress, which increases with the number of companies that
incorporate technological knowledge. In other words, economic growth depends on the generation of
knowledge and inventions as well as the wide dissemination of this knowledge among companies. The
more companies can use that knowledge to improve their production output, the better (Blind et al. 2011).
Consequently, TFP is dependent on three factors:
■■ Technological knowledge generated in a country (e.g. number of patents)
■■ Technological knowledge imported from abroad (e.g. number of technological licence payments
abroad)
■■ The level of diffusion of this technological knowledge (e.g. number of standards)
Thus, it is clear that standards contribute to economic input. As opposed to codified knowledge in
patents, the use of standards is accessible to all. Furthermore, in the best case, committee standards
are developed in consensus with the participation of all relevant market players. Therefore, the benefits of
standardization for economic growth lie in the dissemination of technological knowledge by increasing the
innovative strength and technological progress of a national economy and counteracting the diminishing
marginal returns in capital and labour. This is the concept of "knowledge economy": rather than in terms
of production, the growth of an economy depends on the quality, quantity and accessibility of information
available (Oxford Living Dictionaries n.d.). It is also worth noting that national economies are generally
affected by external political factors such as oil crises and "new economy" bubbles, which should be taken
into account.

216
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Relationship
Economic input Economic output

Capital (gross fixed assets)


Gross value added and/or
Labour (persons
employed) Gross domestic product
(GDP)
Technical progress (total
factor productivity (TFP))

Figure 8.1: Correlation between economic input and output

Blind et al. (2011) found that standards had an increasing contribution to GDP throughout the 1970s.
Between 1986 and 1990, the available standard collection was adjusted, in the sense of harmonizing or
updating standards. Since the German reunification, however, the contribution of standards has been
estimated to have stabilized at a level of between 0.7 and 0.8%. In monetary terms, this equates to some
€16.77 billion a year (from 2002 to 2006 in Germany). Table 8.1 shows the contribution to growth of various
production factors, including standards, in Germany, whereas Table 8.2 summarizes data regarding the
contribution of standards to GDP in other countries: France, United Kingdom, Canada, and Australia.

1961- 1966- 1971- 1976- 1981- 1986- 1992*- 1997- 2002-


1965 1970 1975 1980 1985 1990 1996 2001 2006

CAPITAL 2.30% 1.70% 1.60% 1.10% 0.90% 0.90% 0.90% 0.50% 0.30%

LABOUR 0.70% 0.10% -0.50% 0.60% -0.40% 1.20% -0.70% 0.60% -0.30%

PATENTS 0.50% 0.50% -0.60% 0.60% 1.00% 0.00% -0.70% -0.60% -0.60%

LICENCES 0.90% 0.80% 0.90% 0.30% 0.50% 2.00% 1.70% 0.10% 0.50%

STANDARDS 0.40% 0.60% 1.80% 1.20% 0.70% -0.02% 0.70% 0.80% 0.70%

SPECIAL
0.01% 0.01% -0.70% -0.20% -1.30% 0.01% 0.01% -1.10% 1.10%
FACTORS

* There is no reliable data for 1991 due to German reunification.

Table 8.1: Contribution to growth of various production factors, in %; based on Blind et al. (2011)

217
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

GROWTH RATE CONTRIBUTION


COUNTRY PUBLISHER PERIOD
OF GDP OF STANDARDS

Association Française de Normalisation


FRANCE 1950–2007 5.4% 0.8%
(AFNOR) (2009)

Department of Trade and Industry (DTI)


UNITED KINGDOM 1948–2002 2.5% 0.3%
(2005)

CANADA Standards Council of Canada (2007) 1981–2004 2.7% 0.2%

AUSTRALIA Standards Australia (2006) 1962–2003 3.6% 0.8%

Note: The table covers different periods, as no consistent data was available.

Table 8.2: Contribution of standards to GDP in countries other than Germany; based on Blind et al.
(2011)

8.2.2 COSTS OF STANDARDIZATION AND STANDARDS FROM THE COMPANY’S


PERSPECTIVE
This section focuses on the costs of standardization and standards from the perspective of a company.
Therefore, we do not look at the costs of the development of standards as such. To calculate this, we need
to evaluate the contribution of companies and other stakeholders to the drafting of the standards. From the
company’s perspective, the costs of standards may be divided into the cost of purchasing the standards
from the SDOs and the costs of resources spent on developing standards, in other words the process
of standardization. Standards can generally be bought for a small amount of money from SDOs. For
instance, in Germany, DIN has Beuth Verlag, which is the publisher that releases and distributes standards
documents. Standardization costs are those required to develop the standard, to achieve consensus and
to maintain it. These costs are generally incurred by participants such as companies or academia, which
have to finance standardization activities themselves in terms of membership fees (e.g. ETSI’s €6000/year
for SMEs), travel costs, and staff costs (working hours of institution representatives in the standardization
committees). Sometimes, standardization costs are subsidized with public funds, e.g. WIPANO (German
abbreviation for "knowledge and technology transfer via patents and standards") in Germany. This project
gives financial support to SMEs to support them in safeguarding and utilizing their innovative ideas (German
Federal Ministry for Economic Affairs and Energy BMWi n.d.). The SDOs themselves can financially support
the generation of standards. For instance, the "DIN Connect" programme launched by DIN to promote
R&D in innovative areas funds the development of DIN SPECs (DIN Deutsches Institut für Normung e. V
2016). However, the long-term benefits of standardization more than compensate for the incurred costs.

218
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

8.3 THE ECONOMIC EFFECTS OF STANDARDIZATION


The table below summarizes the positive and negative effects of four of the most important types of
standards from an economic perspective. They are grouped by their main purpose, for example to ensure
compatibility or distribute knowledge (information/measurement standards). The occurrence of the listed
positive and negative effects is highly linked to a standard’s characteristics such as open vs. proprietary or
formal vs. de facto. Moreover, the market structure, in terms of the number and size of market players, as
well as competitive aspects play a major role when it comes to determining the probability of occurrence
of the effects.

POSITIVE EFFECTS NEGATIVE EFFECTS

COMPATIBILITY/INTERFACE ■■ Network externalities ■■ Anti-competitive, leading to monopoly


STANDARDS ■■ Avoiding lock-in in old technologies ■■ Lock-in in old technologies in case of
■■ Increased variety of system products strong network externalities
■■ Efficiency in supply chains

MINIMUM QUALITY/SAFETY ■■ Avoiding adverse selection ■■ Regulatory capture


STANDARDS ■■ Creating trust ■■ Raising rivals’ costs
■■ Reducing transaction costs

VARIETY-REDUCING ■■ Economies of scale ■■ Reduced choice


STANDARDS ■■ Building focus and critical mass ■■ Leading to monopoly, market access
barriers

INFORMATION/MEASUREMENT ■■ Facilitating trade ■■ Regulatory capture


STANDARDS ■■ Reduced transaction costs
■■ Providing codified knowledge

Table 8.3: Effects of standards; based on Swann (2000); Pham (2006); Blind (2013)

In the following sections, we deal with the four different types of standards and describe their economic
benefits. These standards are compatibility/interface standards, minimum quality/safety standards, variety-
reducing standards, and information measurement standards.

8.3.1 COMPATIBILITY/INTERFACE STANDARDS


A key role of standards is to ensure compatibility, which according to ISO (25010) consists of two
components: coexistence and interoperability. Coexistence means that an IT service/product shares a
common environment as well as resources with other independent services/products without adverse side
effects, whereas interoperability is the ability of components to work constructively with one another.
In the ICT sector, compatibility/interface standards play a crucial role. Two economic phenomena that can
influence customers and producers are relevant in such a sector: switching costs, and network effects.
Switching costs are incurred when a user switches from one technology or product to another. Recall
the example of QWERTY and DVORAK keyboards. The switching costs of learning to type quickly using
the DVORAK keyboard are high for users, so most of them prefer to continue using the old standard.
Producers or customers that have invested a large amount of money into the integration of particular
interface standards would incur high costs if they have to switch to another standard.

219
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

Examples of switching costs (Parr et al. 2005) are:


■■ Acquisition costs: when new equipment has to be bought or adapted.
■■ Training costs: associated with learning to use a new product
■■ Testing costs: if there is uncertainty with respect to the suitability of alternative products/services

The second economic effect is called the network effect, which can be direct or indirect. A direct network
effect is when the value of a given product, software or technology increases with the number of people
and organizations using it. Examples are the telephone, fax, Facebook and Twitter. For instance, the value
of the telephone depends on the size of the network of people that can be reached via telephone. Indirect
network effects arise when the value of a good/service does not depend directly on the number of users,
but rather on the availability of complementary and compatible components. For instance, the value of
video game consoles depends on the availability of video games. The more there are, the greater the
choice, and the better for the consumer.
If the switching costs and network effects are high, then there is a risk of so-called lock-in effects.
Sometimes, markets get locked in with inferior products, services or technologies because producers and
customers will only switch to a better design when everyone else does so too. If nobody moves on to the
next standard, everybody stays with the current solution or standards. In addition, the lock-in effect will
dominate if the players that operate in the market cannot afford the switching costs
There are different ways in which a standard can achieve dominance in the market. This also differs for
formal and de facto standards (Table 8.4).

FORMAL STANDARD DE FACTO STANDARD

■■ Developed in SDOs ■■ Dominant design through a standard war or natural selection.


■■ Open and consensus oriented with the option of opposition, E.g. a company achieves a dominant position by public
which may sometimes lead to lengthy decision procedures acceptance or market forces
■■ Clear and transparent participation and voting rules ■■ Standardization process with restricted access;
■■ IPR policy has to follow FRAND licensing rules homogeneous environment may allow fast decisions
■■ Direct participation of company alliances (e.g. consortia) and
individual companies
■■ Flexible IPR rules according to the preferences of the initiators
and technological/market contexts, which may favour
exploitation of IPR

Table 8.4: Comparison of formal and de facto standards (Blind 2008)

Note, however, that the winners of standard races do not necessarily possess the technology with the best
performance, but are those that are most effective in building a wide network and attracting suppliers of
complementary products.
When a standard is proprietary, lock-in is more likely to happen, because one party has full control over the
standard. For the market, lock-ins also mean high barriers to market entry. These barriers arise because
of the high costs imposed by the owner of the proprietary standard or the patents in terms of licensing
fees. In addition, switching to another environment would not be possible, because of the large critical
mass of users that is required in order to escape the lock-in. Lock-ins can result in monopolies that are not
conducive to competition (according to antitrust and competition laws) (de Vries et al. 2008).

220
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

EXAMPLE
A case in point is the Microsoft Windows operating system. The Microsoft Windows Application
Programming Interface (API) supports vendor lock-in by using proprietary file formats. In terms of the
Windows API, Microsoft’s general manager for C++ development, Aaron Contorer, stated in an internal
Microsoft memo drafted for Bill Gates: "The Windows API […] is so deeply embedded in the source code
of many Windows apps that there is a huge switching cost to using a different operating system instead"
(European Commission 2004, pp. 126–127). Through a Microsoft-exclusive franchise, Microsoft grants
other suppliers the right to use the Windows API to produce systems according to its specifications. This
allows the development of many third-party programs, which increase the Windows platform’s value. The
strategic role of API is to maintain the network effect and prevent competition. Thus, the use of proprietary
file formats in Microsoft’s application software exhibits lock-in (Deek and McHugh 2007).

EXAMPLE
Another case is Apple’s iPod. Digital music files with Digital Rights Management (DRM) are purchased from
Apple’s iTunes store. Advanced Audio Coding (AAC) format is only compatible with Apple’s iTunes media
player software. Consequently, users could not play purchased music in other software environments.
After the launch of the iPod in 2001 and a licence deal with major music companies, Apple controlled
almost 75% of the US market for paid music downloads. However, the DRM conditions and incompatibility
with other music players caused conflicts with consumer rights. Since 2009, and after several suits for
"unlawful bundling", DRM has been removed from digital music files (Raustiala and Sprigman 2012).

Open standards are the opposite of proprietary standards and have several positive effects. They attract
producers of complementary products as well as customers who want to avoid being dependent on one
company. Furthermore, they promote competition among multiple producers using the same standards, in
contrast to proprietary ones, which enhance the market power of a single producer (leading to a monopoly). In
this regard, Swann (2000, p. 5) comments that "it is better to have a share of a large market than a monopoly
of a tiny one". With an open standard, the risk of lock-in is reduced, because the standard is more freely
available, leading to lower barriers to entry and lower switching costs for consumers. Note that companies
that are seeking first-mover advantage will be more interested in closed and proprietary standards, whereas
later entrants will favour open ones.
In general, compatibility standards help companies to reduce transaction costs. If buyers know that a particular
piece of software is compatible with a specific operating system, the burden to verify that the software will
run as expected is low. This reduction in transaction costs facilitates the division of labour, as low transaction
costs support market coordination (Coase 1937; Williamson 1989; Picot et al. 2013). The computer industry
is a good example of the division of labour that is supported by standardized interfaces. A computer consists
of components with predefined interfaces that are outsourced to suppliers all over the world. The globalization
of the industry has been possible only because of internationally accepted compatibility standards. In this
way, suppliers can focus on small portions of the value chain to achieve economies of scale and, for instance,
sell computer components to an international market.
Generally accepted compatibility standards reduce the barriers to entry for small-scale entrants producing
"add-on" products. For example, in recent years, we have witnessed a growth of cottage industries producing
iPhone "apps". Many of these companies are micro-entities that would not be able to enter the software
market at all in the absence of well-established platforms with accepted compatibility standards.

221
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

In summary, the previous discussion has several implications for companies. Compatibility or interface
standards support network effects, which in turn enable companies to reach a critical mass on the market.
If the network effects are important to buyers, suppliers will likely produce goods or services that conform to
the prevailing compatibility standard in the market. Consequently, companies that set the dominant standard
have a high chance of being successful, as other market players will be interested in adopting that standard.
However, if the technology or product is still in the introduction phase—in other words, at the beginning of
the technology life cycle—and the market is still fragmented, standard races can occur. In the case of open
standards, producers may face higher competition, since others will also use the same standard, but they
equally have to deal with a much lower level of risk than in the case of proprietary closed standards.

8.3.2 MINIMUM QUALITY/SAFETY STANDARDS


Minimum quality standards refer to the minimum acceptable level of requirements. These standards can be
related to the reliability, durability, or secondary effects and safety of products and services, as well as to
other fields such as working conditions. They can have a welfare-improving effect on the economy, as they
are also applied in the in the fields of health and natural environment. With these standards, it is possible
to help reduce the level of risk felt by buyers, thus improving trust between traders. For instance, in the
commodity market, traders must be in a position to buy and sell large volumes without even seeing their
goods. This assumes the existence of clearly designed standards and possibly certifications that confirm that
the traded commodities meet certain levels of quality or requirements. However, these kinds of standards can
be misused and may have a negative effect. For instance, if they are set at an unnecessarily high level, they
can function as a barrier to entry (Swinnen 2015; Locksley 1990).
Because customers face a huge variety of different products, they often find it difficult to assess which option
is best suited for their purpose. Furthermore, when buyers cannot distinguish between different product
variants, the quality sellers may not be able sustain a price premium, as their costs are likely to exceed those
of lower quality sellers. This is called Gresham’s law: "bad drives out the good". Bad sellers who only sell
lower quality products drive out good-quality sellers by undercutting them. In the worst case, the market will
break down, leading to market failure (Swann 2000).

FAT
FREE

FUDGE DOUBLE
COVERED CHOCOLATE

TWICE
CHOOSE TEENY

YOUR
THE FAT TINY

COOKIES
CHOCOLAT REDUCE
CREME FAT

TRIPLE
CREME

Figure 8.2: Customer confronted with a large variety of products

222
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

This problem is a clear example of information asymmetries between buyers and sellers. Information
asymmetry is when one party has more or better information (in this case, the seller) than the other (the
buyer), which makes it hard for the one with less information to make an informed decision. Leland (1979)
showed that minimum quality standards could help overcome information asymmetries, as they function
as a reference and define the minimum requirements a product should have. In this way, buyers can
make faster and easier decisions. Some companies even trade on their reputation and can sustain a price
premium for their products that are of a quality well above the minimum threshold in the relevant standard.
The standard functions in this way as reference for the distinguishing feature (see Chapter 5 in the context
of innovation). For instance, "ex post restitution" (e.g. a guarantee) can also work as a substitute for a
certified minimum quality standard.

Product
Developer
My product

Standard

Figure 8.3: Standards set a target level for quality

Minimum quality standards exhibit many advantages. They reduce transaction and search costs caused
by economic exchange. Furthermore, they make it possible to define products in a way that reduces buyer
uncertainty. Thus, the buyer’s risk is reduced, and there is less need for the buyer to spend money and time
evaluating different products before a purchase. In the case of product certification, this can function as a
shortcut for buyers, as certification constitutes proof of compliance with a standard (Pham 2006; Swann
2000, 2010a)
For market entry, the effects of minimum quality standards are uncertain. When the characteristics of
products are documented in an open standard, the playing field between incumbent and entrant gets
levelled. However, in its absence, incumbents may have an information advantage over entrants. Some
quality standards can be set at an unnecessarily high level in order to deter newcomers from entering a
market. Note that even though these standards may impose a cost burden on incumbents, this strategy
can be very effective when the cost burden on entrants is even greater. This is an effective approach to
increase barriers to market entry, referred to as "raising rivals’ costs" (Salop and Scheffman 1983).

223
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

The concept of "regulatory capture" can be considered a variant of the "raising rivals’ costs" concept.
Some producers may lobby to persuade the regulator to define regulations in their interest rather than
in the interest of the buyer/customer (original intention of standards). "Some high-cost and high-quality
producers may find it in their interest to lobby for an unnecessarily high minimum quality standard, because
that will in effect exclude their lower cost, lower quality rivals from the market" (Swann 2000, p. 8). Therefore,
minimum quality standards should be open and defined cooperatively to ensure that all parties benefit,
and to overcome Gresham’s Law. Minimum quality standards can also protect third parties, such as in the
area of health or environment to reduce the negative impacts that can result during production or product
consumption.

8.3.3 VARIETY-REDUCING STANDARDS


Variety-reducing standards reduce the variability of key product characteristics. These standards have two
main functions: to support the achievement of economies of scale and to prevent market fragmentation.
They support economies of scale by minimizing the proliferation of minimally differentiated models. For
instance, standard clothing sizes also mean compromises for non-standard customer sizes and individual
wishes, thus constraining choice. However, these standards have a positive effect on price and transaction
costs on the customer’s side, since customers do not have to choose from a large number of product
variants.
Variety reduction can also prevent market fragmentation and support a joint vision. In effect, some
technologies get stuck in the pre-paradigmatic stage because suppliers and users are too dispersed. A
lack of focus or critical mass prevents the development of a market (Swann and Watts 2002). Therefore,
standards can play an important role in achieving focus and cohesion amongst pioneers—especially in the
formative stages of a market (Moore and Benbasat 1991).
In this way, standards can shape future technological trajectories, and consequently constitute an
instrument for the development of new markets (Dosi 1982; Swann and Gill 1993).
For suppliers, less fragmentation also means reduced risk (even if they face more competition). Variety-
reducing standards can lower the barriers to entry, as it acts against variety proliferation, which incumbents
can use to limit competition from small-scale entrants who cannot provide the same degree of variety.
Variety-reducing standards do not need to be defined publicly because economies of scale, which is the
best-known function of this type of standard, can also be obtained with an idiosyncratic model range.
Note, however, that a store selling clothes in idiosyncratic sizes may not able to succeed (Swann 2000;
Pham 2006).

224
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

8.3.4 INFORMATION/MEASUREMENT STANDARDS


Information and measurement standards contain codified knowledge and product descriptions. They
constitute an important instrument for technology transfer, as they codify the work and experience of
generations of experts in their specific fields, and support the dissemination of best practices. As such,
they have a positive effect on the market by diffusing knowledge (Temple and Williams 2002).

EXAMPLE
Digital image compression (ANSI n.d.)
With the rapid diffusion of image and video processing applications and the further advancement of
multimedia technologies, compression methods became more and more important during the early
1990s. International standardization noticed this trend and released several standards describing different
compression methods, such as JPEG (Joint Photographic Experts Group). These standards offered the
industry new solutions for saving storage space and reducing transmission rate requirements. Thus,
compression standards laid the foundation for innovative applications, services, and even markets. Many
companies of all sizes have based their software products on these compression methods, which are
used by millions of users worldwide today. The JPEG standard itself and its descendants are comprised
in various applications, such as the sharing of digital images, remote sensing, archiving, digital cinema,
and image search and retrieval.

Measurement standards describe "those devices, artefacts, procedures, instruments, systems, protocols,
or processes that are used to define (or to realize) measurement units and on which all lower echelon (less
accurate) measurements depend" (Sharp 1999). They can enable advances in process control, thereby
supporting the achievement of economies of scale. Especially in the area of manufacturing, they foster the
precision of production, and support market players producing products and services of higher quality to
demonstrate their superiority. Measurement standards can lead to lower transaction costs and less risk
between trading partners, as they can build on widely used and accepted standard methods that help to
assess the quality of raw materials, products and services. Thus, measurement standards also support the
effective division of labour (Swann 2010a).
Standards that primarily carry information or codified knowledge have various economic effects on the
market. Without a doubt, they support capacity building via their main function of spreading state-of-the-
art knowledge. When information standards are publicly available (open), they can foster equal competitive
conditions in markets—even between incumbents and entrants. As a result, information standards prevent
information asymmetries between market players, and lower the barriers to entry. In addition, companies
often refer to standards in contracts or job offers by using the link as a shortcut to a specific description
of products or skills. Hence, information standards support the reduction of transaction costs and the
achievement of a feasible division of labour (Swann 2000, 2010a, 2010b; Blind 2013)
Although measurement and information standards are usually treated as a separate category of standards,
they could also be seen as hybrids of the three aforementioned types, as all standards contain the two
types of codified knowledge to at least some extent (Swann 2000).

225
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

Knowledge Knowledge Knowledge Knowledge

BEST PRACTICES
Figure 8.4: Exchange of implicit knowledge

8.3.5 SUMMARY
It is clear that all standards have many advantages and that they are conducive to economic growth.
However, from the buyer and user’s perspective, the four types of standards (compatibility/interoperability,
minimum quality/safety, variety reducing, and information) do not seem to contribute equally to demand-
side effects: network effects, economies of scale, reduction of information asymmetries, and lowering
uncertainty and risk. Whereas compatibility and interoperability standards are particularly suited to
supporting network effects, variety-reducing standards have a special positive impact on economies of
scale. Minimum quality and safety standards lead to less uncertainty and risk, while information standards
are particularly effective in reducing information asymmetries (Table 8.5).

DIFFERENT TYPES OF STANDARDS AND THEIR MAJOR DEMAND-SIDE EFFECTS


FOR INNOVATION

GENERATION ACHIEVEMENT OF REDUCTION OF LOWERING


OF NETWORK ECONOMIES OF INFORMATION UNCERTAINTY
EFFECTS SCALE ASYMMETRIES AND RISK

COMPATIBILITY/
X
INTEROPERABILITY

MINIMUM QUALITY/SAFETY X

VARIETY REDUCING X

INFORMATION X

Table 8.5: Different types of standards and their demand-side effects (Blind 2013)

226
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

8.4 PUBLIC PROCUREMENT AND STANDARDIZATION


The public sector can use standards in the context of public procurement (e.g. in tender specifications)
to foster demand-side effects. This way, governments can diffuse innovations to the private sector, as
companies and other organizations applying for public tenders have to comply with specific standards.

DEFINITION
Public procurement is the process by which public authorities (e.g. government departments or local
authorities) purchase work, goods or services from companies, for example, the building of a state
school, purchasing of furniture for a public prosecutor’s office, or contracting cleaning services for a
public university (Blind 2013).

In the context of public procurement, standards yield many positive effects. They improve the quality of
public services and infrastructures, leading to high customer and citizen satisfaction. The improvement of
public services generates more competition among regions, and this can increase regional attractiveness.
Furthermore, by integrating innovations in the public sector, cost savings can be made, such as lower
maintenance and repair costs or lower energy consumption.

EXAMPLE
Disseminating accessibility standards through public procurement
Without access to ICT, persons with disabilities cannot get equal access to education, everyday services,
and social and other areas of life. To achieve an inclusive society, ETSI released a new standard (EN 301
549) that is intended in particular for use in public procurement to ensure that software products, web
applications and digital devices satisfy basic accessibility requirements. By referencing the standard in
public tenders, governments can improve the accessibility of ICT for their own employees and the public
(e.g. ticket vending machines, websites). Companies applying for these tenders need to comply with the
accessibility criteria laid down in the standard, thus promoting the spread of the standard (ETSI 2014;
Rice 2015).
Note that in general, industry can be strongly influenced by the rules of governments. Christy Hubbard,
product marketing manager for Adobe’s ePaper Solutions Group, once stressed the following in an
interview:
"When government says you need to build technology a certain way, for vendors like ourselves that’s
a very compelling maxim. We need to build products that can be sold to the government. It’s not very
practical for us to build multiple versions of our products." (Marsan 2001)

Negative effects, however, can result from the fact that new features or improved functionalities trigger
higher purchasing prices. Innovative technologies bear higher risks for the user but also, for instance, for
the environment, and they can increase maintenance costs due to less operational experience. In addition,
there may be very limited competition, since the innovation to be purchased by the public sector may only
be produced by a small number of companies (or even just one).

227
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

According to Blind (2013), standards referenced in public tenders lead to the creation of innovative products
that can reduce production costs, while lowering the price to be paid by public procurers. Furthermore, they
secure the interoperability of the purchased innovation with already existing infrastructure and can push
competition, thus increasing the innovation pressure among competitors for public tenders. In addition,
they reduce the risk of lock-in to a specific supplier and trigger direct innovation effects for companies
through the implementation of newly released standards. In general, this results in reduced risk related
to costs, health, environment and safety, and facilitates positive spillovers through innovation supporting
procurement processes in the private sector.
Standards come into play at various stages of the procurement process (Figure 8.5). Before procurement,
appropriate standards should be analysed and then referenced. During procurement, they support the
selection of proposals, as only those proposals that comply with the standards are retained. In addition,
possible conflicts can be solved with the help of standards. After procurement, standards can reduce
transaction costs by identifying possible deviations and enable easier monitoring of technology by taking
newly released standards into account (Blind 2013).

Business
case

Establish
need
Before Procurement
Involving supplier earlier
Develop Communicating long-term plans to the market
need Solving IPR issues
Specifying input and output characteristics
Procurement
strategy

Pre-
qualification

Tender
preparation
During Procurement
Selecting eligible proposals
Selection,
Award
Evaluating bids
Reducing risks

Implementation

After Procurement
Manage Contract,
Evaluation
Sharing risks and rewards
Managing incentives
Improving continuously

Figure 8.5: The procurement process (Blind 2013)

228
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

8.5 SUMMARY
Standards play an essential role in the dissemination of technologies and know-how and, as such,
contribute to a nation’s GDP. In this chapter, we took a closer look at the positive and negative economic
effects of standards. We dealt with the four most relevant types: compatibility/interface, minimum quality/
safety, variety-reducing and information/measurement standards.
Compatibility standards in particular have a wide range of effects on the economy. They can support
network externalities, avoid lock-ins and foster an increased variety of system products as well as more
efficiency in supply chains. On the negative side, especially when a standard is proprietary, compatibility
standards can lead to monopolies and, in the case of strong network externalities, to lock-in effects.
Minimum quality or safety standards support the avoidance of adverse selection, help increase trust between
different market players and reduce transaction costs. If minimum quality criteria are set unnecessarily
high, i.e. inspired by lobbyists, quality standards can also function as a market barrier.
Variety-reducing standards can lead to increased economies of scale and can support a company in building
focus in markets and achieving critical mass. An obvious negative side effect is the general reduction of
choice. At the same time, variety-reducing standards can lead to monopolies or market barriers if a market
player misuses the standard to limit competition, e.g. incumbents against small-scale entrants who cannot
provide the same degree of variety.
Information/measurement standards that provide codified knowledge can facilitate trade and reduce
transaction costs when publicly available to all market players. Like minimum quality/safety standards,
they are vulnerable to the effect of regulatory capture. All in all, standards have an influence on a variety of
economic effects, such as prices, productivity, market entry, competition, innovation, trade, outsourcing,
and market failure.
Finally, governments can use standards in the context of public procurement to foster demand-side effects.
This way, governments can diffuse innovations to the private sector, as companies and other organizations
that apply for public tenders have to comply with those standards. However, this procedure can lead to
negative effects: new features or improved functionalities in standards can trigger higher purchasing prices.
In addition, innovative technologies bear higher risks for users and also, for instance, the environment, and
they can increase maintenance costs due to little operational experience.

229
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

8.6 QUIZ

1 - TO WHAT EXTENT DID STANDARDS CONTRIBUTE TO GERMANY’S GDP BETWEEN 2002


AND 2006?
(See Section 8.2.1 for hints)
a) Between 0.07 and 0.08%
b) There is no evidence that standards contributed to the GDP
c) Between 0.7 and 0.8%
d) Between 7 and 8%

2 - TOTAL FACTOR PRODUCTIVITY (TFP) IS AN ESSENTIAL PARAMETER THAT DETERMINES


THE QUANTITY OF ECONOMIC OUTPUT PRODUCED IN A COUNTRY. IT PLAYS AN
IMPORTANT ROLE IN ESTIMATING THE CONTRIBUTION OF STANDARDS TO THE GDP.
ON WHICH FACTORS DOES THE TFP DEPEND?
(See Section 8.2.1 for hints)
a) Technological knowledge generated in a country (number of patents),
b) Technological knowledge imported from abroad (number of technological licence payments
abroad)
c) The level of diffusion of this technological knowledge (number of standards)
d) Technological knowledge generated in a country (number of papers)

3 - WHO BEARS THE COSTS OF DEVELOPING, UPDATING AND DISTRIBUTING STANDARDS?


(See Section 8.2.2 for hints)
a) Standardization is financed by governments as the resulting standards contribute to the economy
as a whole
b) The costs are generally incurred by companies, academia and other organizations by
participating in the standard-setting process, or by purchasing standards
c) 50% of the costs are covered by the state and the remaining 50% are covered by companies
participating in standard setting
d) SDOs cover the costs via crowdfunding initiatives and voluntary donations

4 - VARIETY-REDUCING STANDARDS REDUCE THE VARIABILITY OF KEY PRODUCT


CHARACTERISTICS. WHICH ECONOMIC EFFECTS ARE MAINLY ASSOCIATED WITH THIS
TYPE OF STANDARD?
(See Section 8.3.3 for hints)
a) They support economies of scale
b) They support network effects
c) They prevent lock-ins into old technologies
d) They can prevent market fragmentation

5 - HOW DOES A FORMAL STANDARD DIFFER FROM A DE FACTO STANDARD?


(See Section 8.3.1 for hints)
a) a) It is developed by recognized SDOs
b) b) The standard is proprietary and not open to the public
c) c) All interested parties are invited to participate in the standard-setting process
d) d) It is developed by a single company

230
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

6 - WHAT ARE THE RISKS OF PROPRIETARY STANDARDS FROM A MACROECONOMIC


PERSPECTIVE?
(See Section 8.3.1 for hints)
a) They bear the risk of inferior knowledge being disseminated, as most proprietary standards are of
poor quality
b) There might be high costs imposed by the owner of the proprietary standard, which could hinder
its wide diffusion in the market
c) When a standard is proprietary, lock-ins are more likely to happen, which can result in
monopolies that are not conducive to competition
d) Proprietary standards are not recognized at an international level and therefore hinder
international trade

7 - WHAT ARE THE MAIN POSITIVE EFFECTS OF VARIETY-REDUCING STANDARDS FROM A


MACROECONOMIC PERSPECTIVE?
(See Section 8.3 for hints)
a) They reduce choice
b) They foster economies of scale
c) They help achieve a critical mass
d) They help achieve a focus in the market

8 - THE GLOBALIZATION OF THE COMPUTER INDUSTRY HAS ONLY BEEN POSSIBLE


BECAUSE OF INTERNATIONALLY ACCEPTED COMPATIBILITY STANDARDS. HOW DO
COMPATIBILITY STANDARDS SUPPORT THE DIVISION OF LABOUR IN THE COMPUTER
INDUSTRY?
(See Section 8.3.1 for hints)
a) They stipulate the exact tasks for all market players in the value chain
b) Through predefined interfaces, the production of computer components can be outsourced to
suppliers all over the world
c) Suppliers can focus on small portions of the value chain to achieve economies of scale and sell
computer components to an international market
d) They describe which activity of the value chain should be conducted in a certain geographic area
for environmental protection reasons

9 - MINIMUM QUALITY STANDARDS REFER TO THE MINIMUM ACCEPTABLE LEVEL OF


REQUIREMENTS. WHAT ARE THE EFFECTS OF MINIMUM QUALITY STANDARDS FROM
THE CUSTOMER/CONSUMER PERSPECTIVE?
(See Section 8.3.2 for hints)
a) They make it easy to assess which product is best suited for their purposes
b) They make it harder to distinguish between different product variants
c) They help in assessing if a certain product is worth a certain price
d) They foster information asymmetries between buyers and sellers

231
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

10 - WHICH STATEMENTS ARE TRUE?


(See Sections 8.3.1 and 8.3.2 for hints)
a) Open standards attract producers of complementary products who want to avoid dependence
on one company
b) Open standards are especially attractive for enterprises seeking first-mover advantage
c) Open standards make it more likely for the market to get locked-in in inferior technology
d) Open standards enhance the market power of a single producer, leading to a monopoly

11 - HOW DO DIFFERENT TYPES OF STANDARDS POSITIVELY INFLUENCE TRADE?


(See Section 8.3 for hints)
a) Minimum quality standards can foster trust between trading partners
b) Information standards that provide codified knowledge can facilitate trade
c) Minimum quality standards help reduce the level of risk felt by buyers
d) Measurement standards can lead to lower transaction costs and less risk between trading
partners

12 - WHY DO GOVERNMENTS REFER TO STANDARDS IN OPEN TENDERS?


(See Section 8.4 for hints)
a) To limit the number of applications to a manageable number, as only companies complying with
the standard can apply
b) To improve the quality of public services and infrastructures
c) So that they can diffuse innovations to the private sector
d) They are legally obliged to refer to standards whenever possible

13 - WHAT IS THE MAJOR DEMAND-SIDE EFFECT ON INNOVATION OF COMPATIBILITY


STANDARDS?
(See Section 8.3.5 for hints)
a) Achievement of economies of scale
b) Reduction of information asymmetries
c) Generation of network effects
d) Lowering uncertainty and risk

14 - HOW CAN A TECHNOLOGY ACHIEVE DOMINANCE IN THE MARKET?


(See Section 8.3.1 for hints)
a) By natural selection
b) By winning a standard race
c) By being released by an SDO officially recognized by a government
d) Only a technology defined in a patent can achieve dominance in a market

15 - WHAT ARE THE MAIN NEGATIVE EFFECTS OF MINIMUM QUALITY STANDARDS?


(See Section 8.3 for hints)
a) Reduced choice
b) Regulatory capture
c) Raising rivals’ costs
d) Avoiding adverse selection

➜ SOLUTIONS PAGE 259

232
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

8.7 GLOSSARY
■■ Gross Domestic Product: The OECD defines the Gross Domestic Product or GDP as "an aggregate
measure of production equal to the sum of the gross values added of all resident and institutional
units engaged in production (plus any taxes, and minus any subsidies, on products not included in
the value of their outputs)." (OECD 2001)
■■ Trade: "Trade is the activity of buying, selling, or exchanging goods or services between people,
firms, or countries." (Collins dictionary n.d.)
■■ Outsourcing: Outsourcing is the action of "delegating (part of) activities to an outside contractor"
(OECD 2002).
■■ Switching costs: A consumer faces switching costs when changing a brand, supplier or a product
(Investopedia n.d.). Examples of switching costs are:
• Acquisition costs: when new equipment has to be bought or adapted
• Training costs: associated with learning to use a new product
• Testing costs: if there is uncertainty as to the suitability of alternative products/services (Parr et
al. 2005)
■■ Public Procurement: The process by which public authorities (e.g. government departments or local
authorities) purchase work, goods or services from companies, for example, the building of a state
school, purchasing of furniture for a public prosecutor’s office, or contracting cleaning services for a
public university (Blind 2013).
■■ Lock-in effect: When a user of a product or service is dependent on a particular vendor because
of prohibitive switching costs, therefore the effect is also called vendor lock-in. (Deek and McHugh
2007)
■■ Transaction costs: "The costs involved in market exchange. These include the costs of discovering
market prices and the costs of writing and enforcing contracts." (OECD 2003)
■■ Gresham’s law: The assertion that "bad drives out good". The presence of "bad" products in a
market, and the inability of the buyer to distinguish bad from good from the outset, means that the
supplier of good products withdraws from the market, as he cannot get a satisfactory price (Akerlof
1970; Swann 2000, p. 35).
■■ Division of labour: "Specialization in work, which may be effected by breaking an activity into
component tasks, or by assigning specific groups of persons to certain jobs or outputs." (OECD
2013)
■■ Information asymmetry: When one party in an economic transaction is more or better informed than
the other.
■■ Public tender: "A bidding process that is open to all qualified bidders and where the sealed bids
are opened in public for scrutiny and are chosen on the basis of price and quality." Also called
competitive tender or open tender. (Business Dictionary n.d.)
■■ Regulatory capture: Some producers may lobby so skilfully that they persuade the regulatory agency
to define regulations in the interest of the producers rather than in the interest of the customer.
(Swann 2000, p. 8)

233
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

8.8 LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS


■■ GDP: Gross Domestic Product ■■ JPEG: Joint Photographic Experts Group
■■ DTI: Department of Trade and Industry ■■ API: Application Programming Interface
(United Kingdom) ■■ DRM: Digital Rights Management
■■ TFP: Total Factor Productivity ■■ AAC: Advanced Audio Coding
■■ AFNOR: Association Française de
Normalisation

8.9 REFERENCES
✚✚ Akerlof, G. A. (1970). The market for "lemons": Quality uncertainty and the market mechanism. The quarterly
journal of economics, 488–500.
✚✚ ANSI. (n.d.). Joint Photographic Expert Group (JPEG) Image Coding Standard.
https://share.ansi.org/shared%20documents/Other%20Services/SBB/JPEG_Case_Study.pdf. Accessed
16 February 2018.
✚✚ Blind, K. (2008). The Influence of Companies’ Patenting Motives on their Standardisation Strategies. 13th
EURAS Workshop, Sweden, June, 16.
✚✚ Blind, K. (2013). The Impact of Standardization and Standards on Innovation: Compendium of Evidence on
the Effectiveness of Innovation Policy Intervention.
✚✚ Blind, K., Jungmittag, A., & Mangelsdorf, A. (2011). The Economic Benefits of Standardization: An update of
the study carried out by DIN in 2000.
https://www.din.de/blob/89552/68849fab0eeeaafb56c5a3ffee9959c5/economic-benefits-of-
standardization-en-data.pdf. Accessed 10 July 2018.
✚✚ Blind, K., Mangelsdorf, A., & Pohlisch, J. (2018). The effects of cooperation in accreditation on international
trade: Empirical evidence on ISO 9000 certifications. International Journal of Production Economics, 198,
50–59 (2018). doi:10.1016/j.ijpe.2018.01.033
✚✚ Business Dictionary. (n.d.). Open Tender.
http://www.businessdictionary.com/definition/open-tender.html. Accessed 14 February 2018.
✚✚ Coase, R. H. (1937). The nature of the firm. Economica, 4(16), 386–405.
✚✚ Collins dictionary. (n.d.). Definition of "trade".
https://www.collinsdictionary.com/dictionary/english/trade. Accessed 26 January 2018.
✚✚ de Vries, H., de Vries, H., & Oshri, I. (2008). Standards Battles in Open Source Software. London: Palgrave
Macmillan UK.
✚✚ Deek, F. P., & McHugh, J. A.M. (2007). Open source: Technology and policy. Cambridge University Press.
✚✚ DIN Deutsches Institut für Normung e. V. (2016). DIN launches innovation funding programme.
https://www.din.de/en/din-and-our-partners/press/press-releases/din-launches-innovation-funding-
programme-187120. Accessed 22 January 2018.
✚✚ Dosi, G. (1982). Technological paradigms and technological trajectories: A suggested interpretation of the
determinants and directions of technical change. Research Policy, 11(3), 147–162.
✚✚ DTI. (2005). The Empirical Economics of Standards.
✚✚ ETSI. (2014). New European Standard on accessibility requirements for public procurement of ICT products

234
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

and services.
http://www.etsi.org/news-events/news/754-new-european-standard-on-accessibility-requirements-for-
public-procurement-of-ict-products-and-services. Accessed 16 February 2018.
✚✚ European Commission. (2004). Commission Decision of 24.03.2004: relating to a proceeding under Article
82 of the EC Treaty (Case COMP/C-3/37.792 Microsoft).
✚✚ German Federal Ministry for Economic Affairs and Energy BMWi. (n.d.). Patents.
http://www.bmwi.de/Redaktion/EN/Artikel/Technology/patents.html. Accessed 22 January 2018.
✚✚ Haimowitz, J., & Warren, J. (2007). Economic Value of Standardization.
✚✚ Investopedia. (n.d.). Switching Costs.
https://www.investopedia.com/terms/s/switchingcosts.asp. Accessed 26 January 2018.
✚✚ Leland, H. E. (1979). Quacks, lemons, and licensing: A theory of minimum quality standards. Journal of
political economy, 87(6), 1328–1346.
✚✚ Locksley, G. (Ed.). (1990). The single European market and the information and communication
technologies (Studies in the information economy Urban and regional development). London: Belhaven Pr.
✚✚ Marsan, C. D. (2001). Web site accessibility goes mainstream.
http://edition.cnn.com/2001/TECH/industry/06/15/web.site.accessibility.idg/index.html. Accessed 16
February 2018.
✚✚ Miotti, H. (2009). The Economic Impact of standardization: Technological Change, Standards Growth in
France.
✚✚ Moore, G. C., & Benbasat, I. (1991). Development of an instrument to measure the perceptions of adopting
an information technology innovation. Information systems research, 2(3), 192–222.
✚✚ OECD. (2001). Gross Domestic Product (GDP).
https://stats.oecd.org/glossary/detail.asp?ID=1163. Accessed 21 January 2018.
✚✚ OECD. (2002). Outsourcing.
https://stats.oecd.org/glossary/detail.asp?ID=4950. Accessed 26 January 2018.
✚✚ OECD. (2003). Transaction Costs.
https://stats.oecd.org/glossary/detail.asp?ID=3324. Accessed 14 February 2018.
✚✚ OECD. (2013). Division of Labour.
https://stats.oecd.org/glossary/detail.asp?ID=6812. Accessed 17 September 2018.
✚✚ Oxford Living Dictionaries. (n.d.). Knowledge economy.
https://en.oxforddictionaries.com/definition/knowledge_economy. Accessed 22 January 2018.
✚✚ Parr, A. N., Finbow, R. J., & Hughes, M. J. (2005). UK merger control: Law and practice (2nd ed.). London:
Sweet & Maxwell.

235
CHAPTER 8 - An economic perspective on standardization

✚✚ Pham, T. H. (2006). Economic Aspects of Standardization. In W. Hesser (Ed.), Standardisation in companies


and markets (pp. 61–99). Hamburg: Helmut-Schmidt-University.
✚✚ Picot, A., Reichwald, R., & Wigand, R. T. (2013). Die grenzenlose Unternehmung: Information, Organisation
und Management. Lehrbuch zur Unternehmensführung im Informationszeitalter. Berlin: Springer-Verlag.
✚✚ Raustiala, K., & Sprigman, C. J. (2012). The knockoff economy: How imitation sparks innovation. Oxford,
New York: Oxford University Press.
✚✚ Rice, D. (2015). Public Procurement. Belgrade, 2015.
✚✚ Salop, S. C., & Scheffman, D. T. (1983). Raising Rivals’ Costs. The American Economic Review, 73, 267–
271.
✚✚ Sharp, D. B. (1999). Measurement Standards. The Measurement, Instrumentation, and Sensors Handbook,
JG Webster, ed., CRC Press, Boca Raton, 5-1.
✚✚ Swann, G. M. P. (2000). The Economics of Standardization. Final Report for Standards and Technical
Regulations Directorate Department of Trade and Industry. Manchester Business School.
https://www.gov.uk/government/uploads/system/uploads/attachment_data/file/16506/The_Economics_of_
Standardization_-_in_English.pdf. Accessed 1 January 2015.
✚✚ Swann, G. M. P. (2010a). International Standards and Trade: A Review of the Empirical Literature. OECD
Trade Policy Working Papers, No. 97, OECD Publishing.
✚✚ Swann, G. M. P. (2010b). The Economics of Standardization: An Update. Report for the UK Department of
Business, Innovation and Skills (BIS) (Version 2.2).
✚✚ Swann, G. M. P., & Gill, J. (1993). Corporate vision and rapid technological change: The evolution of market
structure. New York, N.Y: Routledge.
✚✚ Swann, G. M. P., & Watts, T. (2002). Visualisation needs vision: The pre-paradigmatic character of virtual
reality. Virtual society, 41–60.
✚✚ Swinnen, J. F. M. (2015). Quality standards, value chains, and international development: Economic and
political theory. Cambridge University Press.
✚✚ Temple, P., & Williams, G. (2002). The Benefits of standards: Trading with and within Europe. Brussels. CEN
Management Centre Publication.
✚✚ Williamson, O. E. (1989). Transaction cost economics. Handbook of industrial organization, 1, 135–182.

236
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

9 CONCLUSION

This textbook introduces the key concepts and examples that enable readers to orientate themselves in the
tricky landscape of standardization. It describes the main types of standards development organizations
(SDOs), as well as several classifications for the standards they produce.
Standards production is a complex process that involves technical resources, but also a strong organization,
and social elements. Fair standards enable fair competition, and fair trade implies compliance with a set of
fundamental principles.
The roles of standardization experts in SDOs and committees are clearly defined, even if they vary slightly
among the different SDOs. Technical competence is of prime importance, but a wide variety of soft and
personal skills also help make a successful standardization expert.
Chapter 5 provides a comprehensive overview of the basics of standardization and innovation. It is important
to observe that sometimes standards can hamper innovation if standardization is not adequately managed
over time or if the standard induces a lock in effect. For instance, the keyboard example (QWERTY vs.
DVORAK) shows that people find it difficult to change an established standard and switch to a better
solution. Nevertheless, we argue that the positive contributions of standards and standardization to
innovation more than outweigh their negative impacts. Furthermore, standardization and standards can be
very useful during the research process. The results of the research process can be used in standardization
to draw up new standards. The other way around is also possible, as standards can give input for the
research process. In addition, it is demonstrated that standards and standardization are conducive to
innovation. Hence, contrary to popular belief, standards and standardization do support companies in
improving their innovation capabilities.
In Chapter 6, participation in standardization was dealt with from the perspective of an organization interested
in getting involved. In addition to the different interests that organizations may have in participating, the
chapter provides essential knowledge on how to choose a standards organization to participate in, as
a function of the domain of activities and of geographical location. It also dealt with the close links to
technology and market developments, requiring a high level of internal communication for successful
participation in standardization. Furthermore, it dealt with the operation of SDOs. Finally, the chapter
discussed some considerations to help evaluate and choose standards for a certain application.
Intellectual property (IP) refers to creations of the mind, such as inventions, literary and artistic works,
designs and symbols, and names and images used in commerce. In Chapter 7, we focused on three
main instruments by which companies can deal with their IP: committee standards, patents, and secrecy.
Committee standards, patents and trade secrets have benefits and risks. For instance, committee
standards enable companies to gain insider knowledge and early access to information, and sometimes
even to discover new applications for their technologies and to develop new markets. A decision tree
was introduced that helps companies make an informed decision on whether to patent, to standardize,
to combine both, or to keep a technology secret. Two case studies from the ICT sector explained in detail
how to use the decision tree to support decision making.
Standards play an essential role in the dissemination of technologies and know-how and, as such, contribute
to a nation’s GDP. In Chapter 8, we took a closer look at the positive and negative economic effects
of standards. We dealt with the four most relevant types of standards: compatibility/interface, minimum
quality/safety, variety-reducing, and information/measurement standards. Furthermore, governments can
use standards in the context of public procurement to foster demand-side effects. This way, governments
can diffuse innovations to the private sector, as companies and other organizations applying for public
tenders have to comply with those standards.

237
About the authors

ABOUT THE AUTHORS

Dr. habil. Nizar Abdelkafi is head of the research unit “Business Models: Engineering and Innovation”
at Fraunhofer for International Management and Knowledge Economy (IMW) and senior researcher at the
department of Innovation Management and Innovation Economics at the University of Leipzig. He holds an
Industrial Engineering diploma from the National Engineering School Tunis, a Master’s degree in Business
Administration from the Technische Universität München (TUM), a PhD degree from the Hamburg University
of Technology (TUHH), and a habilitation degree from the University of Leipzig. Nizar Abdelkafi has lead
many research projects on standardization funded by the German Institute for Standardization (DIN), ETSI,
and the German Federal Ministry for Economic Affairs and Energy (BMWi) such as (1) innovation potentials
in standardization (IPONORM), (2) ensuring the success of innovative startups with standardization (Start-
Mit-Norm) and (3) electronic standards for the digital transformation of business models. Nizar Abdelkafi’s
research is focused on (digital) business models, along with standardization and intellectual property
management as well as innovation and sustainability management. He published his research in two
books, several international journals such as International Journal of Innovation Management, Creativity
and Innovation Management, International Journal of Technology Management, IEEE transactions on
Engineering Management, Journal of Cleaner Production, and Supply Chain Management: An International
Journal, as well as over 40 conference papers and book chapters.

Prof. Raffaele Bolla is Full Professor of Telecommunications Networks at the Department of Naval,
Electrical, Electronic and Telecommunications Engineering (DITEN) of the University of Genoa and he is also
Vice-Director and member of the Board of Directors of the Italian National University Telecommunications
Consortium (CNIT). Prof. Bolla is the founder and the leader of a laboratory and a research group called
Telecommunications Networks and Telematics (TNT, www.tnt-lab.unige.it), supported jointly by DITEN and
CNIT. Prof. Bolla has been and is responsible for many important research projects and contracts, both
from the European Community (FP7, H2020) and telecommunication companies. He is involved in many
standardization activities, and he is acting as CNIT reference person in ETSI and ITU_T. He is co-author
of more than 200 scientific publications in international journals, books and congresses, and his current
research interests and activities are mainly focused on: i) mechanisms and techniques for the reduction
of energy consumption in telecommunications networks using virtualized paradigms (Network Function
Virtualization), ii) the approaches for the "Softwarization" of networks through NFV and Software Defined
Networking (SDN), with particular focus on the 5G context, iii) integration between Fog, Edge Computing
and telecommunications networks, iv) security in virtualized environments.

238
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

Cees J.M. Lanting is Senior Consultant at DATSA Belgium (Leuven, Belgium), focusing on innovation
management, project development, management and evaluation of in particular IoT, Digital Society and
Smart Cities & Communities. He also heads DATSA Belgium’s IDEAlab (IoT Development of Electronics
and Applications lab). At SiMPLInext S.A. (Neuchatel, Switzerland), he is Member of the Board, he heads
the R&D activities and he heads the IDA-lab (IoT & Data Acquisition lab, operated by DATSA Belgium). He
worked for CSEM (Swiss Centre Suisse d'Electronique et de Microtechnique), where he was responsible
for coordination, development and running of research projects under European Commission managed
programmes, incl. H2020. He worked for Hewlett Packard as European Networking Standards Co-
ordinator, as Senior Consultant in ICT, CEN, the European Commission and the Hermes Partnership (a
telecom research network). He studied applied physics at the University of Amsterdam, where he developed
computer based electro-optical measurement equipment. He is involved in WssTP (Water Supply and
Sanitation Technology Platform), the Swiss Telecom Committee CS4 and the networks Muniskies.com and
DigitalEnlightenment.org. He was Co-Chair at EPoSS (European technology Platform on Smart Systems
integration), at their working group Smart Communications and IoT, and working group Manufacturing and
(Industrial) Robotics.

Dr. Alejandro Rodriguez-Ascaso has a PhD. in Telecommunication Engineering. He is a lecturer at


the Department of Artificial Intelligence at the Universidad Nacional de Educación a Distancia (UNED,
the Spanish National Distance Learning University). Furthermore, he is a member of the aDeNu research
group and the miniXmodular teaching innovation group at the same university. His main teaching and
research interests are in the area of accessible human-computer interaction, adaptive and open learning
resources, telecare and ICT mediated support for personal autonomy. Within these areas, he has taken
part in national and international research projects, and he has published works in international journals and
proceedings of international scientific conferences. He is teaching in related undergraduate, postgraduate
and open-learning programmes. Furthermore, he is active in national and international standardisation
activities in the field of digital accessibility and user experience. He is the convener of the Accessibility
Group of the Telecommunications Technical Committee of Spanish Standards (UNE). He has also been
member of several Specialist Task Forces of the European Telecommunications Standards Institute (ETSI).
Furthermore, he is a Spanish delegate for the ISO/IEC JTC 1 SC 35 “User interfaces”.

Marina Thuns is a researcher on innovation and entrepreneurship, with a focus on the economic effects
of standardization and exploitation of research results. She graduated in Media Management (M.Eng.)
at HTWK Leipzig and wrote her final thesis on the topic of the effects of standardization in young ICT
companies. Ms. Thuns received her bachelor’s degree as part of the University of Bremen’s international,
inter-university Digital Media (B.Sc.) program with a focus on Media Informatics. Ms. Thuns then acted
as a Research Associate and Doctoral Candidate at the Fraunhofer Centre for Innovation Management
and Knowledge Economy in the unit "Business Models: Engineering and Innovation" for two years. In
that position, she participated in the Project START-MIT-NORM, in which she co-developed a decision-
making tool for start-ups. The tool supports start-ups to make the right decision between formal standards,
informal standards, patents or a combination of the instruments. START-MIT-NORM was funded by DIN
(German Institute for Standardization) in the context of the INS-Programme “Innovation with Norms and
Standards”. Moreover, Ms. Thuns was co-author of the paper “To Standardize or to Patent? Development
of a Decision Making Tool and Recommendations for Young Companies,” which won the ISPIM Knut Holt
Best Paper Award in 2016.

239
About the authors

Dr. Michelle Wetterwald holds an engineering degree from Telecom Bretagne and doctorate from Telecom
ParisTech, France. She is a Networking and Mobile Systems expert at Netellany in Sophia Antipolis, France
with over thirty years of experience in various positions in academia and in the ICT industry. Her domain
of interest is the connectivity of mobile devices in wireless networks and the design and standardization
of Cooperative Intelligent Transport Systems (C ITS) and Internet of Things (IoT) solutions. Her recent
projects include standardization activities on Interoperability of standardised IoT Platforms, cooperation
of Agriculture and C ITS vertical domains using an M2M platform and IoT standards landscape and
gap analysis. She works as a part time lecturer in engineering schools in Sophia Antipolis and Paris and
contributes to technical analysis projects for ETSI and SMEs. She is an expert evaluator for the European
Commission (H2020) and research agencies across Europe (project evaluations and reviews). She is author
and co-author of 6 patents on early WLAN systems and 50+ papers on advanced wireless networking
mechanisms. She is a Senior Member of the IEEE.

240
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS

The authors would like to acknowledge the assistance they received from Theresa Stein, of Fraunhofer
IMW, and Ultan Mulligan and Hermann Brand, of ETSI.

The development of this book and accompanying teaching material was funded by the European
Commission and the EFTA Secretariat.

241
Answers to quiz questions

ANSWERS TO QUIZ QUESTIONS

CHAPTER 2 - INTRODUCTION TO STANDARDS - P. 46

1 - WHICH OF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS APPLY TO A "DE FACTO" STANDARD?


(See Section 2.1 for hints)
a) it usually has very little impact, as it is recognized only within a restricted community of users;
(wrong)
b) it is based on a winning technologic solution, which is widely and independently adopted by
different producers/providers within a market segment and products developed on such basis
are widely accepted by users/customers; (right)
c) it has been agreed through a formal process by members of an established organization. (wrong)

2 - WHICH OF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS APPLY TO A "FORMAL" STANDARD?


(See Section 2.1 for hints)
a) it has been developed through a fair process and by consensus by members of an established
organization; (right)
b) it establishes mandatory characteristics of a product to be put on the market; (wrong)
c) it strictly and fully rules the design of an item. (wrong)

3 - WHAT IS THE DIFFERENCE BETWEEN "REGULATIONS" AND "STANDARDS"?


(See Section 2.1 for hints)
a) none, as standards "regulate" the characteristics of products; (wrong)
b) regulations define a set of characteristics an item needs to have to access a regulated market,
while compliance with standards is on voluntary basis; (right)
c) standards only provide a set of best practices to design/develop a specific item and cannot
cover critical issues (such as safety or security) that are governed by regulatory bodies. (wrong)

4 - HOW ARE REGULATIONS AND STANDARDS RELATED?


(See Section 2.1 for hints)
a) standards and regulations are the same thing; (wrong)
b) standards are sometimes turned into regulations; (wrong)
c) standards are often referenced by regulations. (right)

5 - WHAT DO STANDARDS PROVIDE TO PRODUCT DEVELOPERS/DESIGNERS?


(See Section 2.1 for hints)
a) a thorough set of design rules they are forced to comply with; (wrong)
b) references for a high-quality design; (wrong)
c) a minimum set of requirements in order to make the product meet certain well-defined
objectives. (right)

242
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

6 - HOW DO STANDARDS BENEFIT INNOVATION?


(See Section 2.2 for hints)
a) by defining the products’ characteristics related to the most critical aspects, so as to reduce
design risks and time; (right)
b) by inspiring designers with innovative ideas; (wrong)
c) by constraining designers’ choices, so as to speed up the design phase. (wrong)

7 - HOW DO STANDARDS BENEFIT THE ENVIRONMENT?


(See Section 2.2 for hints)
a) by enforcing mandatory safety and sustainability characteristics for marketable products; (wrong)
b) by defining widely shared safety and sustainability requirements for products, often publicized to
customers through proper product labelling; (right)
c) by forcing designers to follow detailed design rules that ensure products meet determined safety
and sustainability requirements. (wrong)

8 - HOW DO STANDARDS BENEFIT THE ECONOMY?


(See Section 2.2 for hints)
a) by restricting market access to only standard-compliant, high-quality products; (wrong)
b) by enabling economies of scale, encouraging wider and fairer competition and facilitating trade
thanks to the definition of widely shared practices; (right)
c) by freezing technological evolution, so as to allow producers and customers to get the best
return from their past investments in established products. (wrong)

9 - HOW DO STANDARDS BENEFIT INDUSTRIES?


(See Section 2.2 for hints)
a) by facilitating the development of new technologies, by ensuring fair competition among
industries and by enlarging products’ market penetration opportunities; (right)
b) by ruling market access of new products, as they define a mandatory minimum set of
requirements that new products must comply with; (wrong)
c) by pacing the technological evolution, so as to consolidate market positions of established
industries. (wrong)

10 - HOW DO STANDARDS BENEFIT SOCIETY AND INDIVIDUALS?


(See Section 2.2 for hints)
a) by ruling the market introduction of innovative products, so as to guarantee safety and
environmental sustainability; (wrong)
b) by establishing a minimum level of performances for any new product entering the market;
(wrong)
c) by promoting innovation, a safer environment and a more competitive market. (right)

243
Answers to quiz questions

11 - COMPLETE THE TABLE BELOW BY DEFINING THE CHARACTERISTICS OF THE LISTED


SDOS ACCORDING TO THE CLASSIFICATION CRITERIA DEFINED IN THE FIRST ROW:
(See Section 2.3 for hints)

SDO GEOGRAPHICAL COVERAGE TYPE OF AFFILIATES MAIN TECHNICAL SCOPE

ISO International National SDOs ICT

National and regional SDOs, Industries,


ITU International Telecoms, ICT
Academia, Government bodies

National SDOs, Industries, Research


ETSI International Telecoms, ICT
institutes, Government bodies

SDOs, Industries, Research institutes,


3GPP International Mobile Telecommunications
Government bodies

IETF International Professionals ICT

ECMA International Industries ICT

12 - LIST THE MAIN PHASES OF THE GENERIC STANDARD LIFE CYCLE AND SUMMARIZE
WHAT THEY ARE FOR:
(See Section 2.4 for hints)

PHASE WHAT IT IS FOR (SCOPE, MAIN ACTIVITIES INCLUDED IN


PHASE NAME
NUMBER THE PHASE)

1 Inception Identification of needs for new standards

Start of standardization action;


- Official submission to a SDO of the proposal for a new
standardization work
2 Conception
- Definition of objectives
- Definition of action plan
- Assignment of SDO’s resources
Standard development:
3 Drafting • Document writing and internal reviewing
• Request for the formal approval of stable documents

4 Approval Stamp of approval for the new standards

5 Obsolescence Standard withdrawn

244
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

13 - IDENTIFY THE TWO CHARACTERISTICS, FROM THOSE LISTED BELOW, THAT DO NOT
DESCRIBE A NORMATIVE REQUIREMENT PART OF A STANDARD:
(See Section 2.4 for hints)
a) clear, concise and unambiguous; (wrong)
b) widely explained by means of extended examples; (right)
c) expressed by means of specialized notations; (wrong)
d) defined by means of references to other standards; (wrong)
e) well justified by means of an extended technical dissertation; (right)
f) testable: the description has to be worded so as to provide all needed information to implement
(possible) relevant tests. (wrong)

14 - DESCRIBE THE TYPICAL CONTENT OF THE VARIOUS BELOW-LISTED SECTIONS OF A


GENERIC STANDARD
(See Section 2.3 and 2.5 for hints)

SECTION CONTENT

SCOPE / ABSTRACT Brief description of the standard’s content and objectives.

REFERENCES List of reference documentation.

List of definitions that are necessary for the understanding of certain terms used in the
DEFINITIONS
recommendation.

BODY OF THE DOCUMENT It is the normative part of the standard.

ANNEXES They detail some specific matters; they may be either informative or normative.

245
Answers to quiz questions

CHAPTER 3 - THE STANDARDS ECOSYSTEM - P. 88

1 - RECOGNIZED SDOS ARE:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Organizations with a sole mission to publish standards that are referenced by regulation. (wrong)
b) Organizations that have been elected by the corresponding Parliament (e.g., National Parliament,
European Parliament, etc.). (wrong)
c) Public organizations that have been created by treaties. (wrong)
d) Officially recognized by regulation systems as providers of standards. (right)

2 - FORMAL STANDARDS:
(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Are also known as de facto standards. (wrong)
b) Are produced by SDOs. (right)
c) Are only published by officially recognized SDOs. (wrong)
d) Are documents that companies and public organizations must comply with. (wrong)

3 - STANDARDIZATION REQUESTS FROM THE EUROPEAN COMMISSION:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Are drafted by the European Commission after consulting social representatives. (right)
b) Can be refused by the European SDOs, but this situation is quite rare. (right)
c) Must be previously approved by each Member State. (wrong)
d) Need to be ratified by the European Parliament. (wrong)

4 - STANDARDIZATION REQUESTS FROM THE EUROPEAN COMMISSION:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Are translated into all the official languages of the European Union, and then approved as
directives. (wrong)
b) Are requests to the European Standardization Organizations to develop standards. (right)
c) Are transformed into de facto standards by non-official SDOs. (wrong)
d) Are transformed into de facto standards once their adoption is universal. (wrong)

5 - NON-OFFICIALLY RECOGNIZED SDOS:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) May have well-established procedures to ensure the quality of their standards. (right)
b) Only produce private standardization documents. (wrong)
c) Produce standards that may later be published by recognized SDOs. (right)
d) Approve regulatory documents. (wrong)

6 - DE FACTO STANDARDS:
(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Cannot ever become formal standards. (wrong)
b) Have been previously approved by a public SDO. (wrong)
c) Are conventions that have achieved a dominant position. (right)
d) Usually have the characteristic of having been validated by the market. (right)

246
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

7 - THE CONCEPT OF DOMINANT DESIGN:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Is the main topic of an ISO Guide that addresses the coordination of SDOs. (wrong)
b) Is related to the key technological features that transform a document into a de jure standard.
(wrong)
c) Is always based on the best user experience of technology. (wrong)
d) Is related to the key technological features that become a de facto standard. (right)

8 - EXAMPLES OF DE FACTO STANDARDS ARE:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) PDF. (right)
b) Asynchronous communication. (wrong)
c) ISO 9001. (wrong)
d) HTML. (right)

9 - REGARDING PUBLIC AND PRIVATE SDOS:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Only public SDOs may adopt de facto standards as formal standards. (wrong)
b) Public SDOs are usually created by treaties. (right)
c) Generally speaking, private SDOs are commercial companies that publish private standards.
(wrong)
d) Only public SDOs are eligible as recognized SDOs. (wrong)

10 - THE FOLLOWING ASPECTS REFLECT GOOD PRACTICES IN STANDARDIZATION


OPENNESS:
(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Consensus. (right)
b) Mandatory compliance with standards. (wrong)
c) Respect for the intellectual property of other SDOs. (right)
d) Transparent, well-documented standardization processes. (right)

11 - THE FOLLOWING ARE PROS OF OPENNESS IN STANDARDIZATION:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) Institutions putting open standardization into practice never need to involve proprietary
technologies when developing standards. (wrong)
b) Civil society will participate in the development of standards more effectively. (right)
c) More interoperability. (right)
d) It is an effective tool for public administrations to tackle ICT lock-in. (right)

12 - THE FOLLOWING ARE CONS OF OPENNESS IN STANDARDIZATION:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) It may be harder to reach consensus. (right)
b) At a certain point in time, SDOs developing open standards may need to involve proprietary
technology, which implies complex debates on how to do so. (right)
c) It increases the ICT lock-in effect in public administrations. (wrong)
d) Privacy issues are not duly considered. (wrong)

247
Answers to quiz questions

13 - INDICATE WHICH OF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS ARE TRUE, REGARDING THE


CLASSIFICATION OF ICT STANDARDS:
(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) The ITU-T Recommendation I.112. Vocabulary of terms for ISDNs belongs to the "terminology
standards" category. (right)
b) The standard ISO/IEC 24800-4 File format for metadata embedded in image data (JPEG and
JPEG 2000) belongs to the "System management standards" category. (wrong)
c) The UML specification belongs to the "Communication reference models" category. (wrong)
d) The 802.3 IEEE Standard for Ethernet belongs to the "software and networking" category. (right)

14 - REGARDING VERTICAL AND HORIZONTAL STANDARDS:


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) The ISO/IEC 27001 standards on information security management are vertical standards.
(wrong)
b) The ETSI GSM family of standards are an example of horizontal standards. (right)
c) The smart grid standards belong to the category of vertical standards. (wrong)
d) The standards applicable to the food and drink industry are horizontal standards. (wrong)

15 - REGARDING INTERNATIONAL, REGIONAL AND NATIONAL SDOS:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) Regional organizations may be represented in international SDOs. (right)
b) National SDOs may not be represented in international SDOs. (wrong)
c) Standards published by an official regional SDO cannot ever be adopted beyond the scope of
the region where that SDO is officially recognized. (wrong)
d) ISO and ITU are international organizations with a worldwide scope. (right)

16 - REGARDING COORDINATION AMONG DIFFERENT LEVELS OF STANDARDIZATION:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) International standardization takes precedence over regional standardization. (right)
b) National standardization takes precedence over regional standardization. (wrong)
c) Regional standardization takes precedence over national standardization. (right)
d) Regional standardization takes precedence over international standardization. (wrong)

17 - REGARDING COORDINATION AMONG DIFFERENT LEVELS OF STANDARDIZATION:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) Agreements among the corresponding SDOs make it possible for approved international
standards to be adopted as regional standards, and then as national standards. (right)
b) Agreements tend to recognize that standardization at a narrower scope may have particular
needs that need to be considered when adopting standards with a wider scope. (right)
c) Approved international standards are usually adopted as regional standards, and then as national
standards. (right)
d) Approved national standards are simultaneously adopted as regional standards, and then as
international standards. (wrong)

248
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

18 - ABOUT THE STANDSTILL CONCEPT:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) It is a process through which national standards are approved as international standards. (wrong)
b) It is the process through which SDOs are officially recognized by the European Commission.
(wrong)
c) It entails an obligation for national SDOs not to take any action that could prejudice European
standard harmonization. (right)
d) It is a tool to support coordination between European and national standardization activities.
(right)

19 - REGARDING THE PROCESS OF COORDINATION AMONG EUROPEAN AND NATIONAL


SDOS:
(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) Once a European standard is approved, conflicting national standards are withdrawn. (right)
b) First, national SDOs submit their contributions or national perspectives on the standard’s topic
and scope; these contributions inform the drafting of the first version of the European standard,
which is undertaken by the European SDO. (wrong)
c) European SDOs translate the approved EN into the languages of all of the nations where the
standard is adopted. (wrong)
d) First, a standardization group within a technical committee of a European SDO drafts the
document, then national SDOs submit their votes and comments about the draft. (right)

20 - THE VIENNA AGREEMENT:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) Establishes that international standards are simultaneously approved as European standards.
(right)
b) Establishes that any pre-existing conflicting national standards must be withdrawn. (right)
c) Recognizes that the European Single Market may have particular needs. (right)
d) Was signed between ITU and ETSI, and underlines the fact that international standardization
takes precedence over national standardization. (wrong)

21 - AS A RESULT OF THE FRANKFURT AGREEMENT:


(See Section 3.2 for hints)
a) Around 80% of all European electrotechnical standards are identical to or based on IEC
International Standards. (right)
b) New electrical standards projects are jointly planned between CENELEC and IEC. (right)
c) All European electrotechnical standards are identical to or based on IEC International Standards.
(wrong)
d) All European electrotechnical standards are identical to or based on ISO International Standards.
(wrong)

249
Answers to quiz questions

22 - WHAT IS THE PROCEDURE USED TO RELEASE AN INDUSTRIAL SPECIFICATION AS A


FORMAL STANDARD?
(See Section 3.3 for hints)
a) Adoption. (wrong)
b) Transposition. (wrong)
c) Publicly available specification. (right)
d) Regulation. (wrong)

23 - WHAT IS THE AVERAGE PROPORTION OF EUROPEAN STANDARDS IN AN EU COUNTRY?


(See Section 3.3 for hints)
a) Less than 10%. (wrong)
b) Between 10% and 50%. (wrong)
c) Between 50% and 90%. (wrong)
d) More than 90%. (right)

24 - REGARDING NORMATIVE AND INFORMATIVE STANDARDIZATION DOCUMENTS:


(See Section 3.4 for hints)
a) Normative documents contain requirements, which must be met in order to claim compliance
with the standard. (right)
b) Requirements in a standard are usually worded with the term "must". (wrong)
c) Informative documents contain information and requirements. (wrong)
d) The term "should" is used to include recommendations. (right)

25 - THE NAME ETSI ES 201 873-11 V4.7.1 (2017-06) GIVES THE READER THE FOLLOWING
INFORMATION ABOUT THE STANDARDIZATION DOCUMENT:
(See Section 3.5 for hints)
a) It is part of a family of standards. (right)
b) It is a European Standard. (wrong)
c) It needs to be revised before June 2019. (wrong)
d) It has been approved by ETSI. (right)

26 - THE NAME NF EN ISO/IEC 15416 AUGUST 2003 GIVES THE READER THE FOLLOWING
INFORMATION ABOUT THE STANDARDIZATION DOCUMENT:
(See Section 3.5 for hints)
a) It has been previously approved by ISO/IEC. (right)
b) The document was originally approved as an International Standard, then as a European
Standard, and then as a National Standard. (right)
c) It is document 416 within the 15000 family of standards. (wrong)
d) It was published in 2003. (right)

250
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

CHAPTER 4 - THE PRODUCTION OF STANDARDS - P. 139

1 - WHICH PRINCIPLE BELOW IS NOT A FUNDAMENTAL PRINCIPLE OF THE


STANDARDIZATION PROCESS?
(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) Openness (wrong)
b) Abstraction (right)
c) Transparency (wrong)
d) Impartiality (wrong)

2 - WHAT IS THE NAME OF THE DEVELOPMENT PHASE TAKING PLACE AFTER INCEPTION?
(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) Conception (wrong)
b) Approval (wrong)
c) Drafting (right)
d) Maintenance (wrong)

3 - WHICH GROUP OF STAKEHOLDERS DOES NOT TAKE PART IN THE PROCESS OF


DEVELOPING ICT STANDARDS?
(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) Biology faculty members (right)
b) Consulting company staff (wrong)
c) Certification laboratory engineers (wrong)
d) Users involved in environmental organizations (wrong)

4 - DOES THE CHAIRMAN OF A TECHNICAL COMMITTEE BELONG TO THE SECRETARIAT


OF THE SDO?
(See Section 4.3 for hints)
a) Yes (wrong)
b) No (right)

5 - WHICH OF THE FOLLOWING IS NOT A SOFT SKILL?


(See Section 4.3 for hints)
a) Active listening (wrong)
b) Fluency in English (wrong)
c) Problem solving (right)
d) Word processing proficiency (wrong)

6 - IS MATHEMATICAL EXPERTISE REQUIRED TO BECOME A STANDARDIZATION EXPERT?


(See Section 4.3 for hints)
a) Yes (wrong)
b) No (right)

251
Answers to quiz questions

7 - THE STANDARDIZATION EXPERT ESTABLISHES THE COMPANY STANDARDS STRATEGY


WITH:
(See Section 4.4 for hints)
a) the marketing team (wrong)
b) management (right)
c) the product development leader (wrong)

8 - THE STANDARDIZATION EXPERT HAS TO TRAVEL TO ATTEND ALL HIS MEETINGS


(See Section 4.4 for hints)
a) True (wrong)
b) False (right)

9 - NATIONAL DELEGATES REPRESENT THE POINTS OF VIEW OF THEIR COUNTRIES AS


PRESCRIBED BY:
(See Section 4.4 for hints)
a) the company CEO (wrong)
b) the network operators (wrong)
c) the national administration (wrong)
d) the national mirror committee (right)

10 - THE IETF RFC PROCESS IS:


(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) a top-down process (wrong)
b) a bottom-up process (right)
c) an integrative design process (wrong)
d) a standardization technical committee (wrong)

11 - A TYPICAL SDO IS GOVERNED ACCORDING TO:


(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) a cooperation agreement (wrong)
b) a hierarchical structure (right)
c) a horizontal model (wrong)

12 - 3GPP IS:
(See Section 4.5 for hints)
a) a national SDO (wrong)
b) a European SDO (wrong)
c) an international SDO (wrong)
d) a partnership project among telecommunications SDOs (right)

252
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

CHAPTER - 5 STANDARDIZATION AND INNOVATION - P. 169

1 - WHAT IS INNOVATION?
(See Section 5.2.1 for hints)
a) Innovation is a new invention. (wrong)
b) Innovation happens only at the product and service level. (wrong)
c) Innovation is the combination of invention and commercialization. (right)
d) Innovation is incremental when there is a considerable improvement of performance within a
short period of time. (wrong)

2 - AN ENTERPRISE RESOURCE PLANNING (ERP) SYSTEM THAT IS ALREADY USED BY


OTHER COMPANIES IN A SECTOR, BUT ACTUALLY IMPLEMENTED FOR THE FIRST TIME
BY A PARTICULAR COMPANY IS A …
(See Section 5.2.1 for hints)
a) New-To-the-Market (NTM) innovation (wrong)
b) New-To-the-Firm (NTF) innovation (right)
c) New-To-the-World (NTW) innovation (wrong)
d) Disruptive innovation (wrong)

3 - QWERTY IS…
(See Section 5.2.2 for hints)
a) superior to DVORAK. (wrong)
b) a formal standard. (wrong)
c) a committee standard. (wrong)
d) a de facto standard. (right)

4 - THE ANALOGY BETWEEN STANDARDIZATION AND TREE PRUNING ILLUSTRATES…


(See Section 5.2.2 for hints)
a) the potential of standards in supporting innovation and growth. (right)
b) how standards inhibit innovation. (wrong)
c) that standards lead to a waste of innovation resources. (wrong)
d) the chaotic nature of the innovation process. (wrong)

5 - AT WHICH PHASE IN THE TECHNOLOGY LIFE CYCLE DOES A DOMINANT DESIGN


EMERGE?
(See Section 5.2.3 for hints)
a) Introduction (wrong)
b) Growth (wrong)
c) Maturity (right)
d) Decline (wrong)

253
Answers to quiz questions

6 - ANTICIPATORY STANDARDS…
(See Section 5.2.3 for hints)
a) proceed in parallel with market growth and improvement of technology. (wrong)
b) are "forward-looking" answers to expected interoperability problems. (right)
c) are created at the end of technology development (wrong)
d) are not conducive to innovation, as they inhibit creativity. (wrong)

7 - THE INNOVATION PROCESS CONSISTS OF…


(See Section 5.3.3 for hints)
a) Pure basic research, oriented basic research, applied research, and experimental development
(wrong)
b) Pure basic research, oriented basic research, applied research, and diffusion (wrong)
c) Pure basic research, oriented basic research, applied research, experimental development and
diffusion (right)
d) Pure basic research, applied research, experimental development, and diffusion (wrong)

8 - INNOVATION IS SUPPORTED…
(See Section 5.4 for hints)
a) only by standards. (wrong)
b) neither by standards nor by standardization. (wrong)
c) only by the standardization process. (wrong)
d) by standards and by standardization. (right)

9 - EXCEEDING THE REQUIREMENTS OF STANDARDS IS…


(See Section 5.4.3 for hints)
a) an innovation potential, as it provides impulses for the improvement of products and
technologies. (right)
b) a cost-increasing factor. (wrong)
c) not an innovation potential, as competitors will strive to do the same. (wrong)
d) not allowed because of regulations. (wrong)

254
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

CHAPTER 6 - A STRATEGIC PERSPECTIVE ON STANDARDIZATION - P. 187

1 - WHEN IS AN ORGANIZATION PARTICIPATING IN STANDARDIZATION CONSIDERED A


"LEADER"?
(See Section 6.2 for hints)
a) When it develops more standards than others (wrong)
b) When other organizations use its ideas (wrong)
c) When standardization is business critical for the organization (right)
d) When it pays the highest membership fees (wrong)

2 - WHAT IS THE FORMAL STATUS OF MOST STANDARDIZATION ORGANIZATIONS?


(See Section 6.2 for hints)
a) They are part of the ministry of internal affairs (wrong)
b) They are part of the ministry for trade and foreign affairs (wrong)
c) They are, non-governmental organizations (NGOs) registered as legal entities, like non-profits
(right)
d) They are part of United Nations organizations, like the IMF and WHO (wrong)

3 - CAN AN ORGANIZATION BE A MEMBER OF BOTH CEN/CENELEC AND ETSI?


(See Section 6.2 for hints)
a) No, CEN/CENELEC has national organizations as members, ETSI only accepts companies
(wrong)
b) Yes, but only national standards organizations can be a member of both CEN/CENELEC and
ETSI (right)
c) No, because ETSI only accepts commercial organizations that pay a membership fee (wrong)
d) Yes, because commercial organizations can be members of both CEN/CENELEC and ETSI
(wrong)

4 - WHICH STANDARDS ORGANIZATIONS HAVE A "ONE MAN, ONE VOTE" RULE?


(See Section 6.3 for hints)
a) CEN/CENELEC, because each member organization can vote only once (wrong)
b) ETSI, as only one person can vote from each organization (wrong)
c) IEEE and the IETF, as votes are given to individuals with regular attendance (right)
d) ITU, as only the Director is allowed to vote (wrong)

5 - IS IT EASIER TO OBTAIN A LARGE VOTING RIGHT IN ETSI THAN IN THE IETF?


(See Section 6.3 for hints)
a) Yes, because you can "buy" votes by accumulating high membership fees (wrong)
b) No, because in the IETF an organization can send many people to a few meetings (wrong)
c) They are about the same, as both require resources: in the IETF an organization could send more
people, in ETSI an organization would need a significant amount of revenue and fees (right)
d) Yes, because in the IETF an organization gets disqualified if it sends too many people (wrong)

255
Answers to quiz questions

6 - WHAT MAKES A STANDARD PROPRIETARY?


(See Section 3.1 for hints)
a) It is widely used (wrong)
b) An organization holds an essential patent limiting its use by others (wrong)
c) It is very comprehensive and comes with a complete test suite (wrong)
d) It has been developed in isolation by a single or a closed group of organizations (right)

7 - WHO IS RESPONSIBLE FOR THE MAINTENANCE OF STANDARDS?


(See Section 4.2 for hints)
a) In the EU, the European Commission (wrong)
b) ETSI and CEN/CENELEC (wrong)
c) Strictly speaking, nobody: there is a moral but no legal obligation for the organization that has
developed and/or adopted and published a standard to maintain the standard (right)
d) The users, as they represent the biggest test environment (wrong)

8 - TO TEST INTEROPERABILITY, IS ONE-TO-ONE TESTING SUCH AS "PLUGTEST" BETTER


THAN CONFORMANCE AND INTEROPERABILITY TESTING?
(See Section 6.5 for hints)
a) One-to-one testing, such as "plugtest", and interoperability testing are equivalent (wrong)
b) One-to-one testing, such as "plugtest", and interoperability are complementary (right)
c) One-to-one testing, such as "plugtest", is better because it tests two systems connected to each
other (wrong)
d) Interoperability testing is better as it tests against a reference implementation (wrong)

256
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

CHAPTER 7 - A BUSINESS PERSPECTIVE: IPR AND STANDARDIZATION - P. 209

1 - WHICH ONE OF THE FOLLOWING INSTRUMENTS IS NOT CONSIDERED A TYPE OF IPR?


(See Section 7.2.1 for hints)
a) Patents (wrong)
b) Trademarks (wrong)
c) Standards (right)
d) Copyright (wrong)

2 - STANDARD ESSENTIAL PATENTS ARE…


(See Section 7.2.3 for hints)
a) Patents that are standardized. (wrong)
b) Patented standards. (wrong)
c) Patents that compete with standards. (wrong)
d) Patents that are required for the implementation of the standards. (right)

3 - PATENTS SHOULD BE LICENSED UNDER FRAND CONDITIONS. WHAT DOES THE


ABBREVIATION FRAND STAND FOR?
(See Section 7.2.1 for hints)
a) Free, Rational and Non-Discriminatory (wrong)
b) Fair, Rational and Non-Discriminatory (wrong)
c) Free, Reasonable and Non-Discriminatory (wrong)
d) Fair, Reasonable and Non-Discriminatory (right)

4 - PARTICIPATION IN COMMITTEE STANDARDS…


(See Section 7.2.2 for hints)
a) is only active. (wrong)
b) can be active or passive. (right)
c) is only passive. (wrong)
d) is neither active nor passive. (wrong)

5 - THE STANDARD WAR BETWEEN VHS AND BETAMAX RESULTED IN…


(See Section 7.2.2 for hints)
a) Betamax winning the battle because it had better performance. (wrong)
b) VHS winning the battle because it was supported by an SDO. (wrong)
c) Betamax losing the battle because VHS had the technological superiority. (wrong)
d) VHS becoming a de facto standard. (right)

6 - A PUBLICLY AVAILABLE SPECIFICATION (PAS)…


(See Section 7.2.1 for hints)
a) is a de facto standard. (wrong)
b) is a committee standard. (right)
c) has a maximum life of 10 years. (wrong)
d) is not relevant for companies operating in areas of rapidly evolving technologies. (wrong)

257
Answers to quiz questions

7 - WHICH OF THE FOLLOWING STATEMENTS DENOTES A PATENT RISK?


(See Section 7.2.3 for hints)
a) Patents grant their owner a temporary monopoly/exclusive rights for about 20 years. (wrong)
b) The easier a patent can be bypassed, the more limited is its efficiency. (right)
c) A patent serves as a form of signalling for potential customers and investors. (wrong)
d) Patenting protects IP in the standardization process. (wrong)

8 - SECRECY IS A FORM OF IP PROTECTION THAT IS SUITABLE FOR…


(See Section 7.2.4 for hints)7
a) Products that can be easily imitated. (wrong)
b) Process technologies that are not visible to competitors. (right)
c) Technologies that are visible to competitors. (wrong)
d) Most high-tech products. (wrong)

9 - THE FOLLOWING CRITERIA ARE IMPORTANT IN ORDER FOR A COMPANY TO CHOOSE


WHETHER TO STANDARDIZE, PATENT, OR FOLLOW A MIXED STRATEGY.
(See Section 7.3.2 for hints)
a) Patentability, importance of protection of internal know-how, need for an additional network of
partners, and the pace of innovation (right)
b) Patentability, the ownership of standards essential patents, need for an additional network of
partners, and the pace of innovation (wrong)
c) Patentability, importance of protection of internal know-how, need for additional investments, and
the pace of innovation (wrong)
d) Importance of protection of internal know-how, need for an additional network of partners, and
the pace of innovation in a given industry (wrong)

10 - THE APPROPRIABILITY REGIME DENOTES…


(See Section 7.3.2 for hints)
a) The ability of a company to acquire resources (wrong)
b) The ability of a company to accommodate innovations from the outside and integrate new
technologies (wrong)
c) The ability of a company to capture value from its innovation (right)
d) The ability of company to patent its technologies (wrong)

258
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

CHAPTER 8 - AN ECONOMIC PERSPECTIVE ON STANDARDIZATION - P. 230

1 - TO WHAT EXTENT DID STANDARDS CONTRIBUTE TO GERMANY’S GDP BETWEEN 2002


AND 2006?
(See Section 8.2.1 for hints)
a) Between 0.07 and 0.08% (wrong)
b) There is no evidence that standards contributed to the GDP (wrong)
c) Between 0.7 and 0.8% (right)
d) Between 7 and 8% (wrong)

2 - TOTAL FACTOR PRODUCTIVITY (TFP) IS AN ESSENTIAL PARAMETER THAT DETERMINES


THE QUANTITY OF ECONOMIC OUTPUT PRODUCED IN A COUNTRY. IT PLAYS AN
IMPORTANT ROLE IN ESTIMATING THE CONTRIBUTION OF STANDARDS TO THE GDP.
ON WHICH FACTORS DOES THE TFP DEPEND?
(See Section 8.2.1 for hints)
a) Technological knowledge generated in a country (number of patents), (right)
b) Technological knowledge imported from abroad (number of technological licence payments
abroad) (right)
c) The level of diffusion of this technological knowledge (number of standards) (right)
d) Technological knowledge generated in a country (number of papers) (wrong)

3 - WHO BEARS THE COSTS OF DEVELOPING, UPDATING AND DISTRIBUTING


STANDARDS?
(See Section 8.2.2 for hints)
a) Standardization is financed by governments as the resulting standards contribute to the economy
as a whole (wrong)
b) The costs are generally incurred by companies, academia and other organizations by
participating in the standard-setting process, or by purchasing standards (right)
c) 50% of the costs are covered by the state and the remaining 50% are covered by companies
participating in standard setting (wrong)
d) SDOs cover the costs via crowdfunding initiatives and voluntary donations (wrong)

4 - VARIETY-REDUCING STANDARDS REDUCE THE VARIABILITY OF KEY PRODUCT


CHARACTERISTICS. WHICH ECONOMIC EFFECTS ARE MAINLY ASSOCIATED WITH THIS
TYPE OF STANDARD?
(See Section 8.3.3 for hints)
a) They support economies of scale (right)
b) They support network effects (wrong)
c) They prevent lock-ins into old technologies (wrong)
d) They can prevent market fragmentation (right)

5 - HOW DOES A FORMAL STANDARD DIFFER FROM A DE FACTO STANDARD?


(See Section 8.3.1 for hints)
a) It is developed by recognized SDOs (right)
b) The standard is proprietary and not open to the public (wrong)
c) All interested parties are invited to participate in the standard-setting process (right)
d) It is developed by a single company (wrong)

259
Answers to quiz questions

6 - WHAT ARE THE RISKS OF PROPRIETARY STANDARDS FROM A MACROECONOMIC


PERSPECTIVE?
(See Section 8.3.1 for hints)
a) They bear the risk of inferior knowledge being disseminated, as most proprietary standards are of
poor quality (wrong)
b) There might be high costs imposed by the owner of the proprietary standard, which could hinder
its wide diffusion in the market (right)
c) When a standard is proprietary, lock-ins are more likely to happen, which can result in
monopolies that are not conducive to competition (right)
d) Proprietary standards are not recognized at an international level and therefore hinder
international trade (wrong)

7 - WHAT ARE THE MAIN POSITIVE EFFECTS OF VARIETY-REDUCING STANDARDS FROM A


MACROECONOMIC PERSPECTIVE?
(See Section 8.3 for hints)
a) They reduce choice (wrong)
b) They foster economies of scale (right)
c) They help achieve a critical mass (right)
d) They help achieve a focus in the market (right)

8 - THE GLOBALIZATION OF THE COMPUTER INDUSTRY HAS ONLY BEEN POSSIBLE


BECAUSE OF INTERNATIONALLY ACCEPTED COMPATIBILITY STANDARDS. HOW DO
COMPATIBILITY STANDARDS SUPPORT THE DIVISION OF LABOUR IN THE COMPUTER
INDUSTRY?
(See Section 8.3.1 for hints)
a) They stipulate the exact tasks for all market players in the value chain (wrong)
b) Through predefined interfaces, the production of computer components can be outsourced to
suppliers all over the world (right)
c) Suppliers can focus on small portions of the value chain to achieve economies of scale and sell
computer components to an international market (right)
d) They describe which activity of the value chain should be conducted in a certain geographic area
for environmental protection reasons (wrong)

9 - MINIMUM QUALITY STANDARDS REFER TO THE MINIMUM ACCEPTABLE LEVEL OF


REQUIREMENTS. WHAT ARE THE EFFECTS OF MINIMUM QUALITY STANDARDS FROM
THE CUSTOMER/CONSUMER PERSPECTIVE?
(See Section 8.3.2 for hints)
a) They make it easy to assess which product is best suited for their purposes (right)
b) They make it harder to distinguish between different product variants (wrong)
c) They help in assessing if a certain product is worth a certain price (right)
d) They foster information asymmetries between buyers and sellers (wrong)

260
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

10 - WHICH STATEMENTS ARE TRUE?


(See Sections 8.3.1 and 8.3.2 for hints)
a) Open standards attract producers of complementary products who want to avoid dependence
on one company (right)
b) Open standards are especially attractive for enterprises seeking first-mover advantage (wrong)
c) Open standards make it more likely for the market to get locked-in in inferior technology (wrong)
d) Open standards enhance the market power of a single producer, leading to a monopoly (wrong)

11 - HOW DO DIFFERENT TYPES OF STANDARDS POSITIVELY INFLUENCE TRADE?


(See Section 8.3 for hints)
a) Minimum quality standards can foster trust between trading partners (right)
b) Information standards that provide codified knowledge can facilitate trade (right)
c) Minimum quality standards help reduce the level of risk felt by buyers (right)
d) Measurement standards can lead to lower transaction costs and less risk between trading
partners (right)

12 - WHY DO GOVERNMENTS REFER TO STANDARDS IN OPEN TENDERS?


(See Section 8.4 for hints)
a) To limit the number of applications to a manageable number, as only companies complying with
the standard can apply (wrong)
b) To improve the quality of public services and infrastructures (right)
c) So that they can diffuse innovations to the private sector (right)
d) They are legally obliged to refer to standards whenever possible (wrong)

13 - WHAT IS THE MAJOR DEMAND-SIDE EFFECT ON INNOVATION OF COMPATIBILITY


STANDARDS?
(See Section 8.3.5 for hints)
a) Achievement of economies of scale (wrong)
b) Reduction of information asymmetries (wrong)
c) Generation of network effects (right)
d) Lowering uncertainty and risk (wrong)

14 - HOW CAN A TECHNOLOGY ACHIEVE DOMINANCE IN THE MARKET?


(See Section 8.3.1 for hints)
a) By natural selection (right)
b) By winning a standard race (right)
c) By being released by an SDO officially recognized by a government (wrong)
d) Only a technology defined in a patent can achieve dominance in a market (wrong)

15 - WHAT ARE THE MAIN NEGATIVE EFFECTS OF MINIMUM QUALITY STANDARDS?


(See Section 8.3 for hints)
a) Reduced choice (wrong)
b) Regulatory capture (right)
c) Raising rivals’ costs (right)
d) Avoiding adverse selection (wrong)

261
UNDERSTANDING ICT STANDARDIZATION: PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE

NOTES

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................

............... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..........................................................................................................................................................................................
ETSI
06921 Sophia Antipolis CEDEX
France
+33 4 92 94 43 88
[email protected]
www.etsi.org
This textbook was written with the support of the European Commission and the EFTA Secretariat.

You might also like